Aficio 2015 2018 - SM PDF
Aficio 2015 2018 - SM PDF
Aficio 2015 2018 - SM PDF
001874MIU
RICOH GROUP COMPANIES
001874MIU
It is the reader's responsibility when discussing the information contained within this document to maintain a level of confidentiality that is in the best interest of Ricoh Corporation and its member companies. NO PART OF THIS DOCUMENT MAY BE REPRODUCED IN ANY FASHION AND DISTRIBUTED WITHOUT THE PRIOR PERMISSION OF RICOH CORPORATION. All product names, domain names or product illustrations, including desktop images, used in this document are trademarks, registered trademarks or the property of their respective companies. They are used throughout this book in an informational or editorial fashion only and for the benefit of such companies. No such use, or the use of any trade name, or web site is intended to convey endorsement or other affiliation with Ricoh products.
WARNING
The Service Manual contains information regarding service techniques, procedures, processes and spare parts of office equipment distributed by Ricoh Corporation. Users of this manual should be either service trained or certified by successfully completing a Ricoh Technical Training Program. Untrained and uncertified users utilizing information contained in this service manual to repair or modify Ricoh equipment risk personal injury, damage to property or loss of warranty protection. Ricoh Corporation
LEGEND
PRODUCT CODE B121 B122 B123 GESTETNER DSm 615 DSm 618 DSm 618d COMPANY LANIER RICOH LD115 Aficio 2015 LD118 Aficio 2018 LD118d Aficio 2018d SAVIN 4015 4018 4018d
DOCUMENTATION HISTORY
REV. NO. * DATE 2/04 COMMENTS Original Printing
B121/B122/B123
TABLE OF CONTENTS
INSTALLATION
1. INSTALLATION............................................................................ 1-1
1.1 INSTALLATION REQUIREMENTS ...........................................................1-1 1.1.1 ENVIRONMENT ...............................................................................1-1 1.1.2 MACHINE LEVEL .............................................................................1-2 1.1.3 MINIMUM SPACE REQUIREMENTS...............................................1-3 1.1.4 POWER REQUIREMENTS ..............................................................1-3 1.2 COPIER INSTALLATION ..........................................................................1-4 1.2.1 POWER SOCKETS FOR PERIPHERALS .......................................1-4 1.2.2 ACCESSORY CHECK......................................................................1-4 1.2.3 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ........................................................1-5 1.3 PLATEN COVER INSTALLATION ............................................................1-8 1.3.1 ACCESSORY CHECK......................................................................1-8 1.3.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ........................................................1-8 1.4 ARDF INSTALLATION ..............................................................................1-9 1.4.1 ACCESSORY CHECK......................................................................1-9 1.4.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ........................................................1-9 1.5 ADF INSTALLATION...............................................................................1-12 1.5.1 ACCESSORY CHECK....................................................................1-12 1.5.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ......................................................1-12 1.6 TWO-TRAY PAPER TRAY UNIT INSTALLATION ..................................1-15 1.6.1 ACCESSORY CHECK....................................................................1-15 1.6.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ......................................................1-15 1.7 ONE-TRAY PAPER TRAY UNIT INSTALLATION...................................1-19 1.7.1 ACCESSORY CHECK....................................................................1-19 1.7.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ......................................................1-19 1.8 ONE-BIN TRAY INSTALLATION.............................................................1-22 1.8.1 ACCESSORY CHECK....................................................................1-22 1.8.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ......................................................1-22 1.9 ANTI-CONDENSATION HEATER INSTALLATION ................................1-25 1.10 TRAY HEATERS ...................................................................................1-26 1.10.1 UPPER TRAY HEATER ...............................................................1-26 1.10.2 LOWER TRAY HEATER (TWO-TRAY MODEL ONLY)................1-27 1.10.3 TRAY HEATERS FOR THE OPTIONAL PAPER FEED UNITS ...1-28 1.11 KEY COUNTER INSTALLATION ..........................................................1-31 1.12 MFP EXPANSION .................................................................................1-33 1.12.1 ACCESSORY CHECK..................................................................1-34 1.12.2 INSTALLING EXPANSION COMPONENT...................................1-35 Step 1Controller Box.........................................................................1-35 Step 2Printer/Scanner.......................................................................1-36 Step 3PostScript ...............................................................................1-36
SM i B121/B122/B123
Step 4Fax .........................................................................................1-37 Step 5Reassembling.........................................................................1-37 1.12.3 INSTALLING PANELS AND KEYS...............................................1-37 Step 6Panel ......................................................................................1-37 Step 7Printer/Scanner Keys..............................................................1-38 Step 8Fax Keys ................................................................................1-38 Step 9Printer/Scanner and Fax Keys................................................1-39 1.12.4 SETTINGS....................................................................................1-40 Step 10MFP Settings and Time Settings ..........................................1-40 Step 11Fax Settings..........................................................................1-40 1.13 IEEE1284/IEEE1394 INTERFACE ........................................................1-41 1.13.1 ACCESSORY CHECK..................................................................1-42 1.13.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ....................................................1-42 UP Mode Settings for Wireless LAN ...................................................1-44 SP Mode Settings for IEEE 802.11b Wireless LAN ............................1-45 1.14 BLUETOOTH.........................................................................................1-46 1.14.1 ACCESSORY CHECK..................................................................1-46 1.14.2 INSTALLATION PROCEDURE ....................................................1-46
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE
2. PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE.................................................... 2-1
2.1 PM TABLES ..............................................................................................2-1 Optics....................................................................................................2-1 Drum Area ............................................................................................2-1 Paper Feed ...........................................................................................2-1 Fusing Unit............................................................................................2-2 ADF/ARDF............................................................................................2-2 Paper Tray Unit.....................................................................................2-2 2.2 HOW TO RESET THE PM COUNTER......................................................2-3
B121/B122/B123
ii
SM
3.3.4 UPPER COVERS .............................................................................3-5 3.3.5 LEFT COVER ...................................................................................3-6 3.3.6 FRONT COVER................................................................................3-6 3.3.7 FRONT RIGHT COVER ...................................................................3-7 3.3.8 RIGHT REAR COVER......................................................................3-7 3.3.9 RIGHT DOOR (B121/B122)/DUPLEX UNIT (B123) .........................3-8 3.3.10 BY-PASS TRAY..............................................................................3-9 3.3.11 LEFT LOWER COVER (TWO-TRAY MODELS ONLY)................3-10 3.3.12 RIGHT LOWER COVER (TWO-TRAY MODELS ONLY) .............3-10 3.3.13 PLATEN COVER SENSOR..........................................................3-10 3.4 SCANNER UNIT......................................................................................3-11 3.4.1 EXPOSURE GLASS/DF EXPOSURE GLASS ...............................3-11 Exposure Glass ..................................................................................3-11 DF Exposure Glass.............................................................................3-11 3.4.2 LENS BLOCK .................................................................................3-12 3.4.3 LAMP STABILIZER BOARD AND EXPOSURE LAMP...................3-12 3.4.4 ORIGINAL WIDTH/LENGTH SENSOR ..........................................3-13 Sensor Positions .................................................................................3-13 3.4.5 SCANNER MOTOR........................................................................3-14 3.4.6 SCANNER HOME POSITION SENSOR ........................................3-14 3.4.7 ADJUSTING SCANNER POSITIONS ............................................3-15 Overview.............................................................................................3-15 Adjusting the First Scanner Contact Points.........................................3-16 Adjusting the Second Scanner Contact Points ...................................3-17 3.5 LASER UNIT ...........................................................................................3-18 3.5.1 LOCATION OF CAUTION DECAL .................................................3-18 3.5.2 TONER SHIELD GLASS ................................................................3-19 3.5.3 LASER UNIT ..................................................................................3-19 3.5.4 LD UNIT..........................................................................................3-20 3.5.5 POLYGONAL MIRROR MOTOR....................................................3-20 3.5.6 LASER UNIT ALIGNMENT ADJUSTMENT....................................3-21 3.6 PCU SECTION ........................................................................................3-22 3.6.1 PCU ................................................................................................3-22 3.6.2 PICK-OFF PAWLS AND TONER DENSITY SENSOR...................3-22 3.6.3 OPC DRUM ....................................................................................3-23 3.6.4 CHARGE ROLLER AND CLEANING BRUSH................................3-24 3.6.5 CLEANING BLADE.........................................................................3-24 3.6.6 DEVELOPER..................................................................................3-25 3.6.7 AFTER REPLACEMENT OR ADJUSTMENT.................................3-26 3.7 TONER SUPPLY MOTOR.......................................................................3-27 3.8 PAPER FEED SECTION .........................................................................3-27 3.8.1 PAPER FEED ROLLER..................................................................3-27 3.8.2 FRICTION PAD ..............................................................................3-27 3.8.3 PAPER END SENSOR...................................................................3-28 3.8.4 EXIT SENSOR ...............................................................................3-28 Non-duplex Models .............................................................................3-28 Duplex Models ....................................................................................3-28 3.8.5 BY-PASS FEED ROLLER AND PAPER END SENSOR ................3-29 3.8.6 REGISTRATION ROLLER .............................................................3-30
SM iii B121/B122/B123
3.8.7 BY-PASS PAPER SIZE SWITCH ...................................................3-31 3.8.8 REGISTRATION CLUTCH .............................................................3-31 3.8.9 REGISTRATION SENSOR.............................................................3-32 3.8.10 UPPER PAPER FEED CLUTCH AND BY-PASS FEED CLUTCH3-32 3.8.11 RELAY CLUTCH ..........................................................................3-33 3.8.12 RELAY SENSOR..........................................................................3-33 3.8.13 LOWER PAPER FEED CLUTCH (TWO-TRAY MODELS ONLY) 3-33 3.8.14 VERTICAL TRANSPORT SENSOR (TWO-TRAY MODELS ONLY) .....................................................3-34 3.8.15 PAPER SIZE SWITCH .................................................................3-34 3.9 IMAGE TRANSFER.................................................................................3-35 3.9.1 IMAGE TRANSFER ROLLER ........................................................3-35 3.9.2 IMAGE DENSITY SENSOR ...........................................................3-35 3.10 FUSING .................................................................................................3-36 3.10.1 FUSING UNIT...............................................................................3-36 3.10.2 THERMISTOR ..............................................................................3-36 3.10.3 FUSING LAMPS ...........................................................................3-37 3.10.4 HOT ROLLER STRIPPER PAWLS ..............................................3-37 3.10.5 HOT ROLLER...............................................................................3-38 3.10.6 THERMOSTAT .............................................................................3-38 3.10.7 PRESSURE ROLLER AND BUSHINGS ......................................3-39 3.10.8 NIP BAND WIDTH ADJUSTMENT ...............................................3-41 3.10.9 CLEANING ROLLER ....................................................................3-41 3.11 DUPLEX UNIT (DUPLEX MODELS ONLY) ..........................................3-42 3.11.1 DUPLEX EXIT SENSOR ..............................................................3-42 3.11.2 DUPLEX ENTRANCE SENSOR...................................................3-42 3.11.3 DUPLEX INVERTER SENSOR ....................................................3-43 3.11.4 DUPLEX TRANSPORT MOTOR ..................................................3-44 3.11.5 DUPLEX INVERTER MOTOR ......................................................3-44 3.11.6 DUPLEX CONTROL BOARD .......................................................3-44 3.12 OTHER REPLACEMENTS....................................................................3-45 3.12.1 QUENCHING LAMP .....................................................................3-45 3.12.2 HIGH-VOLTAGE POWER SUPPLY BOARD ...............................3-45 3.12.3 BICU (BASE-ENGINE IMAGE CONTROL UNIT) .........................3-46 3.12.4 MAIN MOTOR ..............................................................................3-46 3.12.5 REAR EXHAUST FAN (B123 ONLY) ...........................................3-47 3.12.6 LEFT EXHAUST FAN...................................................................3-47 3.12.7 PSU (POWER SUPPLY UNIT) .....................................................3-47 3.12.8 GEARBOX....................................................................................3-48 Replacement Procedure .....................................................................3-48 Gear Arrangement in the Gearbox......................................................3-50 3.13 COPY ADJUSTMENTS: PRINTING/SCANNING ..................................3-51 3.13.1 PRINTING ....................................................................................3-51 Registration - Leading Edge/Side-to-Side...........................................3-51 Blank Margin.......................................................................................3-52 Main Scan Magnification.....................................................................3-52 3.13.2 SCANNING...................................................................................3-53 Registration: Platen Mode...................................................................3-53 Magnification.......................................................................................3-53
B121/B122/B123 iv SM
Standard White Density Adjustment ...................................................3-53 3.13.3 ADF IMAGE ADJUSTMENT .........................................................3-54 Registration and Blank Margin............................................................3-55 Sub-scan Magnification.......................................................................3-55
TROUBLESHOOTING
4. TROUBLESHOOTING ................................................................. 4-1
4.1 SERVICE CALL CONDITIONS .................................................................4-1 4.1.1 SUMMARY .......................................................................................4-1 4.1.2 SC CODE DESCRIPTIONS .............................................................4-2 4.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT DEFECTS ................................................4-12 4.2.1 SENSORS ......................................................................................4-12 4.2.2 SWITCHES.....................................................................................4-14 4.3 BLOWN FUSE CONDITIONS .................................................................4-14 4.4 LED DISPLAY .........................................................................................4-15 4.4.1 BICU ...............................................................................................4-15
SERVICE TABLES
5. SERVICE TABLES....................................................................... 5-1
5.1 SERVICE PROGRAM MODE....................................................................5-1 5.1.1 USING SP MODE.............................................................................5-1 Starting SP Mode..................................................................................5-1 Starting SSP Mode ...............................................................................5-2 Selecting Programs...............................................................................5-2 Specifying Values .................................................................................5-2 Activating Copy Mode ...........................................................................5-2 Quitting Programs/Ending (S)SP Mode ................................................5-2 5.1.2 SP MODE TABLESBASIC..............................................................5-3 SP1-XXX (Feed) ...................................................................................5-3 SP2-XXX (Drum)...................................................................................5-6 SP4-XXX (Scanner) ............................................................................5-11 SP5-XXX (Mode) ................................................................................5-16 SP6-XXX (Peripherals) .......................................................................5-19 SP7-XXX (Data Log)...........................................................................5-20 SP8-XXX (History) ..............................................................................5-24 5.1.3 SP MODE TABLESMFP...............................................................5-27 SP1-XXX (Feed) .................................................................................5-27 SP2-XXX (Drum).................................................................................5-30 SP4-XXX (Scanner) ............................................................................5-34 SP5-XXX (Mode) ................................................................................5-41 SP6-XXX (Peripherals) .......................................................................5-54 SP7-XXX (Data Log)...........................................................................5-55 SP8-XXX (History) ..............................................................................5-60 SP9-XXX (Etc.) ...................................................................................5-71 5.1.4 ADJUSTING REGISTRATION AND MAGNIFICATION..................5-73
SM
B121/B122/B123
Rev. 08/2004
5.1.5 ID SENSOR ERROR ANALYSIS (SP2-221) ..................................5-74 5.1.6 DISPLAY APS DATA (SP4-301-1) .................................................5-75 Sensor Positions .................................................................................5-75 Reading the Data ................................................................................5-75 5.1.7 MEMORY CLEAR...........................................................................5-76 Basic Machine and MFP Machine.......................................................5-76 Exceptions ..........................................................................................5-76 With Flash Memory Card (Basic Machine Only) .................................5-77 Without Flash Memory Card ...............................................................5-77 5.1.8 INPUT CHECK (SP5-803) ..............................................................5-78 Conducting an Input Check.................................................................5-78 Input Check Table...............................................................................5-78 5.1.9 OUTPUT CHECK (SP5-804) ..........................................................5-80 Conducting an Output Check..............................................................5-80 Output Check Table ............................................................................5-80 5.1.10 SERIAL NUMBER INPUT (SP5-811) ...........................................5-81 Specifying Characters.........................................................................5-81 Serial Number and NVRAM ................................................................5-81 5.1.11 NVRAM DATA UPLOAD/DOWNLOAD (SP5-824/825) ................5-82 Overview.............................................................................................5-82 NVRAM Upload (SP5-824-1) ..............................................................5-82 NVRAM Download (SP5-825-1) .........................................................5-83 5.1.12 FIRMWARE UPDATE PROCEDURE FOR BASIC MACHINES...5-84 5.1.13 TEST PATTERN PRINT (SP5-902-1)...........................................5-85 Executing Test Pattern Printing ..........................................................5-85 Test Patterns ......................................................................................5-85 5.1.14 COUNTEREACH PAPER JAM (SP7-504) .................................5-86 5.1.15 SMC PRINT (SP5-990).................................................................5-87 5.1.16 ORIGINAL JAM HISTORY DISPLAY (SP7-508) ..........................5-88 Viewing the Copy Jam History ............................................................5-88 Jam History Code ...............................................................................5-88 5.1.17 ADF APS SENSOR OUTPUT DISPLAY (SP6-901) .....................5-89 Sensor Positions .................................................................................5-89 Reading Data......................................................................................5-89 5.2 FIRMWARE UPDATE PROCEDURE FOR MFP MACHINES.................5-90 5.2.1 BEFORE YOU BEGIN ................................................................5-90 5.2.2. SD CARD PREPARATION .............................................................5-91 5.2.3 FIRMWARE UPDATE PROCEDURE FOR MFP MACHINES ........5-92 5.2.4 NVRAM DATA UPLOAD/DOWNLOAD ..........................................5-96 Uploading Content of NVRAM to an SD card .....................................5-96 Downloading an SD Card to NVRAM..................................................5-96
DETAILED DESCRIPTIONS
6. DETAILED SECTION DESCRIPTIONS ...................................... 6-1
6.1 OVERVIEW ...............................................................................................6-1 6.1.1 COMPONENT LAYOUT ...................................................................6-1 6.1.2 PAPER PATH...................................................................................6-3
B121/B122/B123 vi SM
6.2 BOARD STRUCTURE...............................................................................6-5 6.2.1 BLOCK DIAGRAM............................................................................6-5 1. BICU (Base Engine and Image Control Unit)......................................6-6 2. SBU (Sensor Board Unit)....................................................................6-6 6.3 COPY PROCESS OVERVIEW..................................................................6-7 6.4 SCANNING................................................................................................6-9 6.4.1 OVERVIEW ......................................................................................6-9 Lamp Stabilizer Fuse ............................................................................6-9 6.4.2 SCANNER DRIVE ..........................................................................6-10 6.4.3 ORIGINAL SIZE DETECTION IN PLATEN MODE.........................6-11 6.5 IMAGE PROCESSING ............................................................................6-13 6.5.1 OVERVIEW ....................................................................................6-13 6.5.2 SBU (SENSOR BOARD UNIT).......................................................6-14 6.5.3 IPU (IMAGE PROCESSING UNIT).................................................6-15 Overview.............................................................................................6-15 Image Processing Modes ...................................................................6-16 Image Processing Path.......................................................................6-17 Original Modes....................................................................................6-18 SP Modes for Each Image Processing Step .......................................6-18 Auto Shading ......................................................................................6-20 White Line Erase.................................................................................6-21 Black Line Erase .................................................................................6-21 Auto image density (ADS)...................................................................6-22 Scanner Gamma () Correction ..........................................................6-23 Main Scan Magnification.....................................................................6-24 Mirroring for ADF Mode ......................................................................6-24 Filtering ...............................................................................................6-25 ID Gamma () Correction ....................................................................6-26 Gradation Processing .........................................................................6-27 6.5.4 VIDEO CONTROL UNIT (VCU)......................................................6-28 Fine Character and Image (FCI) .........................................................6-28 Printer Gamma Correction ..................................................................6-28 6.6 LASER EXPOSURE................................................................................6-29 6.6.1 OVERVIEW ....................................................................................6-29 6.6.2 AUTO POWER CONTROL (APC) ..................................................6-30 6.6.3 LD SAFETY SWITCH .....................................................................6-31 6.7 PHOTOCONDUCTOR UNIT (PCU) ........................................................6-32 6.7.1 OVERVIEW ....................................................................................6-32 6.7.2 DRIVE.............................................................................................6-33 6.8 DRUM CHARGE .....................................................................................6-34 6.8.1 OVERVIEW ....................................................................................6-34 6.8.2 CHARGE ROLLER VOLTAGE CORRECTION ..............................6-35 Correction for Environmental Conditions ............................................6-35 6.8.3 ID SENSOR PATTERN PRODUCTION TIMING............................6-36 6.8.4 DRUM CHARGE ROLLER CLEANING ..........................................6-37 6.9 DEVELOPMENT .....................................................................................6-38 6.9.1 OVERVIEW ....................................................................................6-38 6.9.2 DRIVE.............................................................................................6-39 6.9.3 DEVELOPER MIXING ....................................................................6-39
SM vii B121/B122/B123
6.9.4 DEVELOPMENT BIAS ...................................................................6-40 6.9.5 TONER SUPPLY ............................................................................6-41 Toner Bottle Replenishment Mechanism ............................................6-41 Toner Supply Mechanism ...................................................................6-42 6.9.6 TONER DENSITY CONTROL ........................................................6-43 Overview.............................................................................................6-43 Toner Density Sensor Initial Setting....................................................6-45 Toner Concentration Measurement ....................................................6-45 Vsp/Vsg Detection ..............................................................................6-45 Toner Supply Reference Voltage (Vref) Determination.......................6-45 Toner Supply Determination ...............................................................6-45 Toner Supply Motor On Time Determinations.....................................6-46 6.9.7 TONER SUPPLY IN ABNORMAL SENSOR CONDITIONS...........6-47 ID Sensor............................................................................................6-47 TD Sensor...........................................................................................6-47 6.9.8 TONER NEAR END/END DETECTION AND RECOVERY............6-48 Toner Near End Detection ..................................................................6-48 Toner Near End Recovery ..................................................................6-48 Toner End Detection ...........................................................................6-48 Toner End Recovery ...........................................................................6-48 6.10 DRUM CLEANING AND TONER RECYCLING.....................................6-49 6.10.1 DRUM CLEANING........................................................................6-49 6.10.2 TONER RECYCLING ...................................................................6-49 6.11 PAPER FEED........................................................................................6-50 6.11.1 OVERVIEW ..................................................................................6-50 6.11.2 PAPER FEED DRIVE MECHANISM ............................................6-51 6.11.3 PAPER FEED AND SEPARATION MECHANISM........................6-51 6.11.4 PAPER LIFT MECHANISM ..........................................................6-52 6.11.5 PAPER END DETECTION ...........................................................6-52 6.11.6 PAPER SIZE DETECTION...........................................................6-53 Paper Tray ..........................................................................................6-53 By-pass Tray.......................................................................................6-54 6.11.7 SIDE FENCES..............................................................................6-55 6.11.8 PAPER REGISTRATION..............................................................6-55 6.12 IMAGE TRANSFER AND PAPER SEPARATION .................................6-56 6.12.1 OVERVIEW ..................................................................................6-56 6.12.2 IMAGE TRANSFER CURRENT TIMING......................................6-57 6.12.3 TRANSFER ROLLER CLEANING................................................6-58 6.12.4 PAPER SEPARATION MECHANISM...........................................6-58 6.13 IMAGE FUSING AND PAPER EXIT......................................................6-59 6.13.1 OVERVIEW ..................................................................................6-59 6.13.2 FUSING UNIT DRIVE AND RELEASE MECHANISM ..................6-60 Fusing Unit Drive ................................................................................6-60 Drive Release Mechanism ..................................................................6-60 Contact/Release Control.....................................................................6-60 Drive Release Solenoid ......................................................................6-61 6.13.3 FUSING ENTRANCE GUIDE SHIFT............................................6-62 6.13.4 PRESSURE ROLLER...................................................................6-62 6.13.5 FUSING TEMPERATURE CONTROL..........................................6-63
B121/B122/B123 viii SM
Overview.............................................................................................6-63 Temperature Control...........................................................................6-64 6.13.6 OVERHEAT PROTECTION .........................................................6-66 6.14 DUPLEX UNIT.......................................................................................6-67 6.14.1 OVERALL .....................................................................................6-67 6.14.2 DRIVE MECHANISM....................................................................6-68 6.14.3 BASIC OPERATION.....................................................................6-69 Larger than A4 Short-edge/LT Short-edge..........................................6-69 Up to A4 Short-edge/LT Short-edge ...................................................6-70 6.14.4 FEED IN AND EXIT MECHANISM ...............................................6-71 6.15 ENERGY SAVER MODES OF BASIC MACHINES...............................6-72 Overview.............................................................................................6-72 AOF ....................................................................................................6-72 Timers.................................................................................................6-73 Recovery.............................................................................................6-73 6.16 ENERGY SAVER MODES OF MFP MACHINES..................................6-74 Overview.............................................................................................6-74 AOF ....................................................................................................6-74 Timers.................................................................................................6-75 Recovery.............................................................................................6-75
SPECIFICATIONS
SPECIFICATIONS............................................................................. 7-1
1. GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS.....................................................................7-1 Duplex Unit (B123 only) ........................................................................7-5 2. SUPPORTED PAPER SIZES......................................................................7-6 2.1 ORIGINAL SIZE DETECTION.............................................................7-6 North America, Europe, Asia, Taiwan ...................................................7-6 China, Korea.........................................................................................7-7 2.2 PAPER FEED AND EXIT ....................................................................7-8 Main Frame, Duplex..............................................................................7-8 Optional Paper Tray, One-Bin Tray, By-pass Tray .............................7-10 3. MACHINE CONFIGURATION ...................................................................7-12 4. OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT ..........................................................................7-15 ARDF ..................................................................................................7-15 ADF.....................................................................................................7-16 ONE-TRAY PAPER TRAY UNIT ........................................................7-17 TWO-TRAY PAPER TRAY UNIT........................................................7-18 One-Bin Tray ......................................................................................7-18
PRINTER/SCANNER B622
SEE SECTION B622 FOR DETAILED TABLE OF CONTENTS
B121/B122/B123
SM
LASER SAFETY
The Center for Devices and Radiological Health (CDRH) prohibits the repair of laser-based optical units in the field. The optical housing unit can only be repaired in a factory or at a location with the requisite equipment. The laser subsystem is replaceable in the field by a qualified Customer Engineer. The laser chassis is not repairable in the field. Customer engineers are therefore directed to return all chassis and laser subsystems to the factory or service depot when replacement of the optical subsystem is required.
!WARNING
Use of controls, or adjustment, or performance of procedures other than those specified in this manual may result in hazardous radiation exposure.
ADF/ARDF B616/B617
FAX OPTION B620 INTERNET FAX (IFAX)
PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE
TAB POSITION 8
TAB POSITION 7
SPECIFICATIONS
TAB POSITION 6
DETAILED DESCRIPTIONS
TAB POSITION 5
TAB POSITION 4
TROUBLESHOOTING
TAB POSITION 3
TAB POSITION 2
TAB POSITION 1
INSTALLATION
INSTALLATION
INSTALLATION REQUIREMENTS
!CAUTION
Before installing options, please do the following: 1. If there is a fax unit in the machine, print out all messages stored in the memory, the lists of user-programmed items, and the system parameter list. 2. If there is a printer option in the machine, print out all data in the printer buffer. 3. Turn off the main switch and disconnect the power cord, the telephone line, and the network cable.
15%
10C (50F)
Temperature
B121I920.WMF
SM
1-1
B121/B122/B123
Installation
1. INSTALLATION
INSTALLATION REQUIREMENTS
1. Temperature Range: 10C to 32C (50F to 89.6F) 2. Humidity Range: 3. Ambient Illumination: 4. Ventilation: 5. Ambient Dust: 15% to 80% RH Less than 1,500 lux (do not expose to direct sunlight) 3 times/hr/person or more Less than 0.075 mg/m3 (2.0 x 10-6 oz/yd3)
6. Avoid areas exposed to sudden temperature changes: 1) Areas directly exposed to cool air from an air conditioner. 2) Areas directly exposed to heat from a heater. 7. Do not place the machine where it is exposed to corrosive gases. 8. Do not install the machine at any location over 2,000 m (6,500 ft.) above sea level. 9. Place the copier on a strong and level base. (Inclination on any side should be no more than 5 mm.) 10. Do not place the machine where it is subjected to strong vibrations.
B121/B122/B123
1-2
SM
INSTALLATION REQUIREMENTS
[B]
[D] A (front): 750 mm (30") B (left): 150 mm (6") C (rear): 50 mm (2") D (right): 250 mm (10")
[A]
B121I901.WMF
NOTE: The recommended 750 mm front space is sufficient to allow the paper tray to be pulled out. Additional front space is required to allow operators to stand at the front of the machine.
!CAUTION
1. Make sure that the wall outlet is near the machine and easily accessible. After completing installation, make sure the plug fits firmly into the outlet. 2. Avoid multi-wiring. 3. Be sure to ground the machine. 1. Input voltage: North and South America, Taiwan: 110 120 V, 60 Hz, 12 A Europe, Asia: 220 240 V, 50/60 Hz, 7 A
SM
1-3
B121/B122/B123
COPIER INSTALLATION
!CAUTION
Rated voltage for peripherals Make sure to plug the cables into the correct sockets.
Paper Tray Unit Rated voltage output connector for accessory Max. DC24 V
B121I905.WMF
B121/B122/B123
1-4
SM
COPIER INSTALLATION
!CAUTION
Unplug the machine power cord before starting the following procedure.
B121I904.WMF
2. Open the front door and remove the toner bottle holder [A].
[A]
B121I912.WMF
3. Open the right door [B], and remove the PCU (photoconductor unit) [C]. NOTE: The PCU is locked when the right door is closed. [B]
[C]
B121I913.WMF
SM
1-5
B121/B122/B123
Installation
COPIER INSTALLATION
4. Separate the PCU into the upper part and the lower part (! x 5). 5. Put a sheet of paper on a level surface and place the upper part on it. NOTE: This prevents foreign material from getting on the sleeve rollers.
B121I903.WMF
6. Distribute a pack of developer [A] to all openings equally. NOTE: 1) Do not spill the developer on the gears [B]. If you have spilled it, remove the developer by using a magnet or magnetized screwdriver. 2) Do not turn the gear [B] too much. The developer may spill.
[A] [B]
B121I914.WMF
7. Reassemble the PCU and reinstall it. 8. Shake the toner bottle [C] several times. NOTE: Do not remove the bottle cap [D] before you shake the bottle. 9. Remove the bottle cap [D] and install the bottle on the holder. NOTE: Do not touch the inner cap [E]. 10. Set the holder (with the toner bottle) in the machine. [E] [D]
[C]
B121I915.WMF
B121/B122/B123
1-6
SM
COPIER INSTALLATION
11. Pull out the paper tray [A] and turn the paper size dial to the appropriate size. Adjust the positions of the end and side guides. NOTE: To move the side guides, release the green lock on the rear side guide.
[A] 12. Install the optional ARDF, ADF, or platen cover (! 1.3/1.4/1.5). 13. Plug in the main power cord and turn on the main switch. 14. Activate the SP mode and execute "Devlpr Initialize" (SP2-214-001). 15. Wait until the message "Completed" is displayed (about 45 seconds). 16. Activate the User Tools and select the menu "Language." 17. Specify a language. This language is used for the operation panel.
B121I916.WMF
18. Load the paper in the paper tray and make a full size copy, and check if the side-to-side and leading edge registrations are correct. If they are not, adjust the registrations (! 3.13).
SM
1-7
B121/B122/B123
Installation
!CAUTION
Unplug the machine power cord before starting the following procedure. 1. Install the platen cover [A] (! x 2).
[A]
B121I910.WMF
B121/B122/B123
1-8
SM
ARDF INSTALLATION
6 3 5 7
B379I901.WMF
!CAUTION
Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure.
B379I101.WMF
SM
1-9
B121/B122/B123
Installation
ARDF INSTALLATION
2. Remove the left scale [A] (! x 2). 3. Place the DF exposure glass [B] on the glass holder. Make sure that the white mark [C] is on the bottom at the front end. 4. Peel off the backing [D] of the double-sided tape attached to the rear side of the scale guide [E], then install the scale guide (! x 2 [removed in step 2]). 5. Install the two stud screws [F].
[D] [C]
[E]
[B]
[F]
[A] [F]
B379I902.WMF
6. Mount the ARDF on the copier, then slide it to the front. 7. Secure the ARDF unit with the knob screws [G]. 8. Connect the cable [H] to the copier. [G] [H]
B379I104.WMFWMF
[I]
B379I501.WMF
B121/B122/B123
1-10
SM
ARDF INSTALLATION
10. Attach an attention decal [A] to the top cover. NOTE: The attention decals in the package are written in different languages. 11. Turn the main power switch on. 12. Check that the document feeder works properly.
B379I502.WMF
13. Make a full size copy, and check that the side-to-side and leading edge registrations are correct. If they are not, adjust the side-to-side and leading edge registrations. (! 3.13.3)
SM
1-11
B121/B122/B123
Installation
[A]
ADF INSTALLATION
B387I901.WMF
!CAUTION
Unplug the machine power cord before starting the following procedure.
B387I151.WMF
B121/B122/B123
1-12
SM
ADF INSTALLATION
2. Remove the left scale [A] (! x 2). 3. Place the DF exposure glass [B] on the glass holder. Make sure that the white mark [C] is on the bottom at the front end. 4. Peel off the backing [D] of the double-sided tape attached to the rear side of the scale guide [E], then install the scale guide (! x 2 [removed in step 2]). 5. Install the two stud screws [F]. 6. Mount the ADF on the copier, then slide it to the front. 7. Secure the ADF unit with the fixing screws [G]. 8. Connect the cable [H] to the copier.
[D] [C]
[B]
[F]
[A] [F]
B387I902.WMF
[G] [H]
B387I104.WMFWMF
[I]
B387I501.WMF
SM
1-13
B121/B122/B123
Installation
[E]
ADF INSTALLATION
10. Attach an attention decal [A] to the top cover. NOTE: The attention decals in the package are written in different languages. 11. Turn the main power switch on. Then check if the document feeder works properly.
[A]
B387I903.WMF
12. Make a full size copy, and check that the side-to-side and leading edge registrations are correct. If they are not, adjust the side-to-side and leading edge registrations. (! 3.13.3).
B121/B122/B123
1-14
SM
B384I500.WMF
!CAUTION
1. If the optional fax unit is installed: Print out all messages stored in the memory. Print out the lists of user-programmed items. Print out the system parameter list. Disconnect the telephone line. 2. If the optional printer unit is installed: Print out all data in the printer buffer. Disconnect the network cable. 3. Unplug the machine power cord before starting the following procedure.
1. Remove the strips of tape. Make sure that you have removed all the strips of tape and all the pieces of cardboard.
B384I158.WMF
SM
1-15
B121/B122/B123
Installation
Rev. 04/2004
2. Attach the adjuster [A] to the base plate as shown. NOTE: If a cabinet is installed, this step is unnecessary. However, you must: Remove the casters and the bracket around the casters before attaching to a stand.
[A]
B384I001.WMF
[B]
CAUTION: Before placing the copier on the paper tray unit, make sure that the harness [C] is safe. The paper tray unit does not function properly if the harness is damaged.
B384I901.WMF
[C]
B384I117.WMF
B121/B122/B123
1-16
SM
5. One-tray copier model (B121): Remove the 1st tray cassette [A]. Two-tray copier models (B122/B123): Remove the 2nd tray cassette [A]. 6. Install the two screws [B]. 7. Reinstall the tray cassette. [A] [B]
B384I106.WMF
8. Install the two brackets [C] (1 screw each). 9. Connect the connecting harness [D] to the copier. NOTE: There are cutouts in the plug on both sides. The left side has one cutout, and the right side has two. 10. Reinstall the cover removed in step 3 (1 rivet).
[C]
[D]
B384I902.WMF
11. Install the four brackets [E] (2 screws each). NOTE: If a cabinet is installed, this step is unnecessary. [E]
B384I007.WMF
SM
1-17
B121/B122/B123
Installation
12. Rotate the adjuster [A] to fix the machine in place. NOTE: If a cabinet is installed, this step is unnecessary. [A]
B384I002.WMF
13. Load the paper in the paper trays and make full size copies from each tray. Check if the side-to-side and leading edge registrations are correct. If they are not, adjust the registrations (! 3.13).
B121/B122/B123
1-18
SM
B385I500.WMF
!CAUTION
1. If the optional fax unit is installed: Print out all messages stored in the memory. Print out the lists of user-programmed items. Print out the system parameter list. Disconnect the telephone line. 2. If the optional printer unit is installed: Print out all data in the printer buffer. Disconnect the network cable. 3. Unplug the machine power cord before starting the following procedure.
1. Remove the strips of tape. Make sure that you have removed all the strips of tape and all the pieces of cardboard.
B385I159.WMF
SM
1-19
B121/B122/B123
Installation
[A] CAUTION: Before placing the copier on the paper tray unit, make sure that the harness [B] is safe. The paper tray unit does not function properly if the harness is damaged. 3. Set the copier on the paper tray unit.
B385I901.WMF
[B]
B385I112.WMF
4. One-tray copier model (B121): Remove the 1st tray cassette [C]. Two-tray copier models (B122/B123): Remove the 2nd tray cassette [C].
[C]
B385I120.WMF
B121/B122/B123
1-20
SM
[A]
B385I118.WMFWMF
7. Install the two brackets [B]. (1 stepped screw each). 8. Connect the connecting harness [C] to the copier. NOTE: There are cutouts in the plug on both sides. The left side has one cutout, and the right side has two. 9. Reinstall the cover removed in step 2.
[B]
B385I902.WMF
[C]
10. Load the paper in the paper tray and make full size copies from tray. Check if the side-to-side and leading edge registrations are correct. If they are not, adjust the registrations (! 3.13).
SM
1-21
B121/B122/B123
Installation
Rev. 04/2004
CAUTION
Unplug the machine power cord before starting the following procedure.
The One Bin Tray cannot be installed on the B121 For B123 only (For B122, go to step 3.) 1. Remove the inverter tray [A]. 2. Remove the rail [B] (2 knob screws). 3. Remove the cover [C] (1 screw). [B]
[C]
[A]
B621I902.WMF
B121/B122/B123
1-22
SM
4. Open the front cover [A]. 5. Remove the front right cover [B] (! x 1). 6. Disconnect the connector [C]. 7. Cut the front cover as shown, to make an opening [D] for the 1-bin tray.
[D]
[B]
[A]
B621I002.WMF
[G] 8. Install the 1-bin tray [E]. 9. Make sure the connectors [F] are connected firmly. 10. Fasten the screw. 11. Connect the connector [G] that you removed in step 6. NOTE: Make sure that the connector is connected. [E] [F]
B621I904.WMF
SM
1-23
B121/B122/B123
Installation
[C]
"
[A]
[B]
[E] 12. Reattach the front right cover [A]. 13. Close the front cover [B]. 14. Install the exit tray [C] as follows: " Keep the front end higher than the rear end. # Push the left hook into the opening in the copier. $ Push the right hook into the opening in the copier. 15. Pull the support [D] out of the left end of the exit tray. [D] [C]
B621I903.WMF
16. Insert the support into the left end of the paper exit tray [E] (of the copier). 17. Turn the main switch on. 18. Check the operation.
B121/B122/B123
1-24
SM
!CAUTION
Unplug the machine power cord before starting the following procedure. [A] [B] [C]
[E]
[D]
B121I127.WMF
1. Remove the exposure glass (! 3.4.1). 2. Remove the left cover (! 3.3.8). 3. Pass the connector [A] through the opening [B]. 4. Install the anti-condensation heater [C], as shown. 5. Join the connectors [A, D]. 6. Clamp the harness with the clamp [E]. 7. Reinstall the left cover and exposure glass.
SM
1-25
B121/B122/B123
Installation
TRAY HEATERS
[A] 3. Pass the connector [B] through the opening [C] and install the tray heater [D] (! x 1).
B121I020.WMF
[D]
[B] [C]
4. Install the relay cable [E]. 5. Fix the cable with the clamp [F]. 6. Reinstall the 1st tray cassette and the rear cover.
B121I121.WMF
[F] [E]
B121/B122/B123 1-26
B121I126.WMF
SM
TRAY HEATERS
[A]
[G]
[E]
[B]
B121I122.WMF
1. Remove the 2nd tray cassette [A]. 2. Remove the rear lower cover (! 3.3.2). 3. B123 only: Remove the DCB [B] with bracket (! x 4, " x 3). 4. Pass the connector [C] through the opening [D] and install the tray heater [E] (! x 1). 5. Join the connectors [F, G]. 6. Reinstall the 2nd tray cassette, DCB, and rear lower cover.
SM
1-27
B121/B122/B123
TRAY HEATERS
[A]
B121I202.WMF
2. Two-tray unit only: Remove the cable guide [B] (! x 1). 3. Install the clamps [C].
[C]
B121I007.WMF
[B]
[C]
B121I004.WMF
B121/B122/B123
1-28
SM
TRAY HEATERS
4. Pass the connector [A] through the opening [B]. 5. Install the tray heater [C] (! x 1).
[B]
[A]
[C]
B121I009.WMF
[B]
[A]
[C]
B121I005.WMF
SM
1-29
B121/B122/B123
Installation
TRAY HEATERS
6. Clamp the cables [A], as shown. 7. Join the connectors [B]. 8. Two-tray unit only: Reinstall the cable guide. 9. One-tray copier model (B121): Remove the 1st tray cassette. Two-tray copier models (B122/B123): Remove the 2nd tray cassette.
[B] [A]
[B]
B121I008.WMF
B121I006.WMF
10. Remove the two screws [C] and install the two hexagonal socket screws [D]. 11. Reinstall the 1st tray and rear cover.
[D]
[C]
B121I003.WMF
B121/B122/B123
1-30
SM
!CAUTION
Unplug the machine power cord before starting the following procedure.
[B]
[C]
B121I906.WMF
[A] [D]
[E]
[F]
B121I100.WMF
1. Remove the left cover (! 3.3.8). 2. Remove the rear cover (! 3.3.1). 3. Remove the cap [A] with nippers. 4. Punch out the small hole [B] using a screwdriver. 5. Hold the key counter plate nuts [C] on the inside of the key counter bracket [D] and insert the key counter holder [E]. 6. Secure the key counter holder to the bracket (! x 2). 7. Install the key counter cover [F] (! x 2).
SM
1-31
B121/B122/B123
Installation
[D] [C]
[A]
B121I908.WMF
8. Connect the connector [A] to CN126 on the BICU. 9. Install the clamps [B]. 10. Hold the cable with the clamps [B][C][D]. NOTE: The relay cable is not included in the key counter bracket accessories. 11. Join the relay cable [E] with the connector [F]. 12. Reinstall the rear cover. 13. Pass the relay cable through the opening [G] and reinstall the left cover. 14. Install the stepped screw [H]. 15. Join the connectors [I][J].
B121I909.WMF
[H]
[K]
16. Pass the joined connectors through the opening of the key counter holder assembly [K], and put the connectors inside the assembly. 17. Hook the key counter holder assembly onto the stepped screw [H]. Check that the cable is not caught between the left cover and the key counter holder assembly. 18. Secure the key counter holder assembly with the screw [L]. 19. Go to SP5-113. Change setting to 11. 20. Enter User Tools. Go to Systems Settings> Key Operator Tools> Extended Charge Unit Management. Change to 1.
B121/B122/B123
1-32
SM
MFP EXPANSION
!CAUTION
The controller box and the fax unit contain lithium batteries. The danger of explosion exists if a battery of this type is incorrectly replaced. Replace only with the same or an equivalent type recommended by the manufacturer. Discard batteries in accordance with the manufacturers instructions and local regulations. This section (1.12) includes the installation procedures for the optional controller box, optional printer scanner, and optional fax. See each step as necessary.
Machine Configuration Printer/scanner Printer/scanner + PostScript 3 Fax Printer/scanner + Fax Printer/scanner + PostScript 3 + Fax Component Steps 1 2 5 Steps 1 2 3 5 Steps 1 4 5 Steps 1 2 4 5 Steps 1 2 3 4 5 Reference Panel and Key Steps 6 7 Steps 6 7 Steps 6 8 Steps 6 9 Steps 6 9 Settings Steps 10 Steps 10 Steps 10 11 Steps 10 11 Steps 10 11
SM
1-33
B121/B122/B123
Installation
MFP EXPANSION
Printer Scanner
Fax
PostScript 3
B121/B122/B123
1-34
SM
MFP EXPANSION
!CAUTION
Unplug the machine power cord before starting the following procedure.
[A]
B658I901.WMF
[I] 4. Connect the controller box [D] to the BICU. Make sure that the BICU is not damaged [E] and that the three openings [F][G][H] hold the controller box. 5. Fasten the screws (! x 7 [including the screw [C]]). 6. Remove the FCU cover [I] (! x 3). [E] [H] [D]
B658I902.WMF
[F]
[G]
SM
1-35
B121/B122/B123
Installation
MFP EXPANSION
Step 2Printer/Scanner
1. Remove the controller-box cover [A] (! x 7) 2. Install the RAM DIMM [B]. 3. Remove the SD-card cover [C] (! x 1). 4. Install the SD card [D] in the upper slot. NOTE: The lower slot is for service work. 5. Install the SD-card cover. 6. Remove the slot cover [E] (! x 2) 7. Install the USB board [F] (! x 2). 8. Attach the ferrite core [G] to the network cable [H]. The end of the ferrite core must be about 15 cm (6") from the end of the cable [I]. 9. USA model only: Attach the FCC label [J] at the right-hand side of the [H] USB connector on the controller box. [B] [F]
B658I903.WMF
[A]
[D] [C]
[E]
[I]
[J]
B658I912.WMF
[G]
B658I904.WMF
Step 3PostScript
Install the PS3 card [A] in the DIMM socket [B]. [A]
[B]
B681I903.WMF
B121/B122/B123
1-36
SM
MFP EXPANSION
1. Install the FCU [A] into the slot (! x 3 [including the screw [B] removed in Step 1]). 2. Short the jumper [C]. NOTE: This jumper is the battery switch. 3. Attach the connector cover [D] if you do not connect a LAN able. 4. Attach the ferrite core [E] to the telephone cable [F]. The end of the ferrite core must be about 5 cm (2") from the end of the cable [G]. [D]
[B]
[C]
B658I906.WMF [A] When you press the Fax key for the first time after installation, an error occurs. This is not a functional problem. Press OK. The fax starts its initialization program. [G] NOTE: If another error occurs after initialization, this can be a functional problem. [F]
Step 5Reassembling
1. Reassemble the controller box. 2. Install the rear cover.
[E]
B658I907.WMF
[A]
SM
1-37
B121/B122/B123
Installation
Step 4Fax
MFP EXPANSION
[E]
[e]
Pri n t er
Scanner
[C]
[B]
B658I909.WMF
[c]
1. Remove the dummy cover (from the basic operation panel) and install the copy key [A] or [a]. 2. Remove the dummy panel (from the basic operation panel) and install the printer panel [B]. 3. Install the scanner key [C] or [c] on the optional operation panel. 4. Install the dummy panel [D] on the optional operation panel. 5. Install the printer key [E] or [e] on the basic operation panel.
[A]
[a]
Copy
[B]
[D]
[C]
B658I910.WMF
1. Remove the dummy cover (from the basic operation panel) and install the copy key [A] or [a]. 2. Remove the dummy panel (from the basic operation panel) and install the fax panel [B]. 3. Install the dummy cover [C] on the optional operation panel. 4. Install the fax panel [D] on the optional operation panel. 5. Install the fax key [E] or [e] on the optional operation panel.
B121/B122/B123
1-38
SM
MFP EXPANSION
[E]
[e]
Facsimile
[A]
[a]
Copy
[G]
[g]
Printer
[D]
Scanner
[C]
[c]
[F]
[B]
B658I911.WMF
1. Remove the dummy cover (from the basic operation panel) and install the copy key [A] or [a]. 2. Remove the dummy panel (from the basic operation panel) and install the fax panel [B]. 3. Install the scanner key [C] or [c] on the optional operation panel. 4. Install the fax panel [D] on the optional operation panel. 5. Install the fax key [E] or [e] on the optional operation panel. 6. Remove the dummy panel (from the basic panel) and install the printer panel [F]. 7. Install the printer key [G] or [g] on the basic operation panel.
SM
1-39
B121/B122/B123
Installation
MFP EXPANSION
Rev. 04/2004
1.12.4 SETTINGS
Step 10MFP Settings and Time Settings
1. Turn the main switch on. 2. Start the SP mode. 3. Select SP5-801-001 and execute the initialization. 4. Turn the main switch off and on. 5. Start the SP mode. Select SP5-302-002 and specify the time zone. For example, EST = -300, CST = -360, MST = -420 or PST = -480.
6.
7. Select SP5-307-001, 003, and 004 and specify the daylight-saving-time settings. ( 5.1.18)
5.1.7. When installing to MFP Expansion, the BICU (Engine) NVRAM NOTE: settings are moved from SP5-801 to SP5-998-001. After adding the MFP Expansion performing SP5-801-001 will not RAM CLEAR the BICU settings.
B121/B122/B123
1-40
SM
IEEE1284/IEEE1394 INTERFACE
!CAUTION
Unplug the machine power cord before starting the following procedure. NOTE: 1) Before installing the IEEE1284 interface, install the optional printer scanner. 2) One slot is available. You can install ONLY one of the following options at one time: IEEE1284 interface, IEEE1394 interface, wireless LAN interface, or Bluetooth interface. 1. Remove the slot cover [A] (! x 2). 2. Install the interface board [B] (! x 2).
[A]
[B]
B682I905.WMF
SM
1-41
B121/B122/B123
Installation
IEEE1284/IEEE1394 INTERFACE
!CAUTION
Unplug the machine power cord before starting the following procedure. NOTE: 1) Before installing the optional wireless LAN (IEEE 802.11b), install the optional printer scanner. 2) One slot is available. You can install ONLY one of the following options at one time: IEEE1284 interface, IEEE1394 interface, wireless LAN interface, or Bluetooth interface.. 1. Remove the slot cover [A] (! x 2). 2. Install the wireless LAN (IEEE 802.11b) board [B] (! x 2). 3. Reattach the rear cover.
[A]
[B]
B682I901.WMF
B121/B122/B123
1-42
SM
Rev. 6/2004
IEEE1284/IEEE1394 INTERFACE
4.
With the card label facing the front of the machine, insert the card [A] into the PCI slot.
[B]
B682I902.WMF
6. If reception is poor, you may need to move the machine: Make sure that the machine is not located near an appliance or any type of equipment that can generate a strong magnetic field. Position the machine as close as possible to the access point.
SM
1-43
B121/B122/B123
Installation
IEEE1284/IEEE1394 INTERFACE
B121/B122/B123
1-44
SM
IEEE1284/IEEE1394 INTERFACE
11. Transmission Speed. Press the Next button to display more settings, then select the transmission speed for the mode: Auto, 11 Mbps, 5.5 Mbps, 2 Mbps, 1 Mbps (default: Auto). This setting should match the distance between the closest machine or access point, depending on which mode is selected. NOTE: For the Ad Hoc Mode, this is the distance between the machine and the closest PC in the network. For the Infrastructure Mode, this is the distance between the machine and the closest access point. 11 Mbps 5.5 Mbps 2 Mbps 1 Mbps 140 m (153 yd.) 200 m (219 yd.) 270 m (295 yd.) 400 m (437 yd.)
12. To initialize the wireless LAN settings, use page 2/2. Press Execute to initialize the following settings: Transmission mode Channel Transmission Speed WEP SSID WEP Key
SM
1-45
B121/B122/B123
Installation
BLUETOOTH
1.14 BLUETOOTH
1.14.1 ACCESSORY CHECK
Check the quantity and condition of the accessories.
No. 1 2 3 Description Bluetooth card Bluetooth card cover Bluetooth board Qty 1 1 1
!CAUTION
Unplug the machine power cord before starting the following procedure. NOTE: 1) Before installing the optional Bluetooth, install the optional printer scanner. 2) One slot is available. You can install ONLY one of the following options at one time: IEEE1284 interface, IEEE1394 interface, wireless LAN interface, or Bluetooth interface. 1. Remove the slot cover [A] (! x 2). 2. Install the Bluetooth board [B] on the controller board (! x 2). 3. Reattach the rear cover.
[A]
[B]
B682I901.WMF
B121/B122/B123
1-46
SM
Rev. 6/2004
BLUETOOTH
4.
With the Bluetooth card label facing the front of the machine, insert the card [A] into the PCI slot.
[B]
5. Press the antenna [B] to extend it. 6. Attach the antenna cap [C].
[A] [C]
B682I903.WMF
SM
1-47
B121/B122/B123
Installation
PREVENTIVE MAINTENAMCE
PM TABLES
2. PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE
2.1 PM TABLES
NOTE: 1) After preventive maintenance work, reset the PM counter (SP7-804001). 2) PM intervals (60k, 80k, and 120K) indicate the number of prints. Key: AN: As necessary C: Clean R: Replace L: Lubricate I: Inspect
Optics
Reflector 1st mirror 2nd mirror 3rd mirror Scanner guide rails Platen cover Exposure glass Toner shield glass APS sensors EM C C C C C I C C C 60k
120k
AN C C C C C
NOTE Optics cloth Optics cloth Optics cloth Optics cloth Do not use alcohol. Replace the platen sheet if necessary. Blower brush or alcohol Blower brush or alcohol Blower brush Blower brush
Drum Area
EM PCU Drum Developer Charge roller Cleaning brush (charge roller) Cleaning blade (OPC drum) Pick-off pawls Transfer roller ID sensor 60k I R R R R R R
120k
AN
NOTE
R C C Blower brush
Paper Feed
EM Paper feed roller (each tray) Friction pad (each tray) Bottom-plate pad (each tray) Paper feed roller (bypass tray) Friction pad (bypass tray) Bottom-plate pad (by-pass tray) Registration rollers Relay rollers Paper feed guides Paper-dust Mylar 60k C C C C C C C C C C
120k R R
AN C C C C C C C C C C
NOTE Clean with water or alcohol. Clean with water or alcohol. Clean with water or alcohol. Clean with water or alcohol. Clean with water or alcohol. Clean with water or alcohol. Clean with water or alcohol. Clean with water or alcohol. Clean with water or alcohol. Clean with water or alcohol.
SM
2-1
B121/B122/B123
Preventive Maintenance
PM TABLES
Fusing Unit
EM Hot roller Pressure roller Pressure roller cleaning roller Hot roller bushings Pressure-roller bushing Hot roller stripper pawls Thermistor 60k
120k R R R I R R
AN
NOTE
C C
ADF/ARDF
Feed belt Separation roller Pick-up roller Stamp White plate DF exposure glass Platen cover 80k R R R AN C C C R C C C NOTE Clean with water or alcohol. Clean with water or alcohol. Clean with water or alcohol. Replace when necessary. Clean with water or alcohol. Clean with water or alcohol. Clean with water or alcohol.
Dry cloth
B121/B122/B123
2-2
SM
B121P901.WMF
[A]
4. Press the button [B] below the message "Execute." The messages "Execute?" followed by "Cancel" and "Execute" are displayed.
B121P901.WMF
[B]
COPY(Class3) 7.804.001 Reset-PM Counter Execute? Cancel Execute
5. To reset the PM counter, press the button [C] below the message "Execute."
B121P901.WMF
[C]
COPY(Class3) 7.804.001 Reset-PM Counter Completed
B121P901.WMF
SM
2-3
B121/B122/B123
Preventive Maintenance
GENERAL CAUTIONS
SM
3-1
B121/B122/B123
GENERAL CAUTIONS
3.1.7 IMPORTANT
1. After installing a new PCU, you must run SP2-214 to initialize the TD sensor. After starting initialization, be sure to wait for it to reach completion (wait for the motor to stop) before re-opening the front cover or turning off the main switch. 2. If the optional tray heater or optics anti-condensation heater is installed, keep the copier's power cord plugged in even while the main switch is off, so that the heater(s) remain energized.
B121/B122/B123
3-2
SM
SM
3-3
B121/B122/B123
[A]
[B]
B121R901.WMF
[A]
[B]
B121R902.WMF
B121/B122/B123
3-4
SM
[A]
B121R903.WMF
[B]
[C]
[D]
B121R904.WMF
1. Platen cover, ARDF, or ADF (if installed) 2. Rear cover (! 3.3.1) 3. Left upper cover [A] (! x 2) 4. Front upper left cover [B] (! x 3) 5. Operation panel [C] (! x 4, " x 1) 6. Right upper cover [D] (! x 1, 3 hooks) NOTE: Push the cover to the rear side to release the hooks. 7. Top rear cover [E] (! x 1)
SM
3-5
B121/B122/B123
Replacement Adjustment
[A]
B121R906.WMF
[B]
[A]
B121R945.WMF
B121/B122/B123
3-6
SM
[B]
B121R946.WMF
B121R947.WMF
SM
3-7
B121/B122/B123
Replacement Adjustment
[A]
[B]
[A]
B121R917.WMF
1. Right rear cover (! 3.3.8) 2. Open the right door [A]. 3. Open the clamps [B] and disconnect the two connectors (B121/B122) [C] or three connectors (B123). 4. Right Door.
B121/B122/B123
3-8
SM
B121R907.WMF
1. Right rear cover (! 3.3.8) 2. Open the right door (! 3.3.9). 3. Release the by-pass tray cable from the clamps (see [C] on the preceding page) and disconnect the connector (5-pin connector with colored wires). 4. Cable holder [A] (B123 only) 5. Front-side clip ring [B] 6. Front-side pin [C] NOTE: You can push the pin from behind the right door. 7. Front-side tray holder arm [D] 8. Remove the rear-side clip ring, pin, and tray holder arm in the same manner. 9. By-pass tray [E]
SM
3-9
B121/B122/B123
Replacement Adjustment
[A]
B121R908.WMF
[A]
B121R949.WMF
B121R909.WMF
B121/B122/B123
3-10
SM
SCANNER UNIT
[A]
[B]
[D]
Replacement Adjustment
[E] [C]
B121R950.WMF
Exposure Glass
1. Front upper left cover (! 3.3.4) 2. Left scale [A] (! x 2) 3. Rear scale [B] (! x 3) 4. Exposure glass [C] NOTE: When reinstalling, make sure that the mark is at the rear left corner, and that the left edge is aligned to the support on the frame.
DF Exposure Glass
1. Front upper left cover (! 3.3.4) 2. Left scale [A] 3. DF exposure glass [D] NOTE: When reinstalling, make sure that the mark [E] is on the bottom.
SM
3-11
B121/B122/B123
SCANNER UNIT
[B]
B121R951.WMF
[A]
B121R910.WMF
B121/B122/B123
3-12
SM
SCANNER UNIT
B121R952.WMF
Sensor Positions
Sensor positions vary according to regions as shown below.
Asia (including Taiwan; excluding China), Europe America
B121R954.WMF
B121R953.WMF
B121R955.WMF
SM
3-13
B121/B122/B123
Replacement Adjustment
SCANNER UNIT
[B]
B121R911.WMF
[C]
B121R958.WMF
B121/B122/B123
3-14
SM
SCANNER UNIT
!CAUTION
Grasp the front and rear ends (not the middle) of the first scanner when you manually move it. The first scanner may be damaged if you press, push, or pull its middle part.
Overview
Adjust the scanner positions when the first scanner [C] and second scanner [B] are not parallel with the side frames [A] or when you have replaced one or more of the scanner belts. To adjust the scanner positions, do either of the following:
[A]
[B]
[C]
B121R959.WMF
To adjust the belt contact points on the first scanner (! Adjusting the First Scanner Contact Points) To adjust the belt contact points on the scanner bracket (! Adjusting the Second Scanner Contact Points) [G] [H]
[J]
[I]
B121R913.WMF
The two actions above have the same objectivesto align the following holes and marks: The adjustment holes [H][J] in the first scanner The adjustment holes [H][J] in the second scanner The alignment marks [G][I] on the frames The scanner positions are correct when these holes and marks are aligned.
SM
3-15
B121/B122/B123
Replacement Adjustment
SCANNER UNIT
[E]
1. A(R)DF or platen cover 2. Operation panel, top rear cover (! 3.3.4). 3. Exposure glass (! 3.4.1) 4. Loosen the 2 screws [A][F]. 5. Slide the 1st and 2nd scanners, or one of them, to align the following holes and marks (! Overview): The adjustment holes in the first scanner The adjustment holes in the second scanner The alignment marks on the frames 6. Insert the positioning tools [D][E] through the holes and marks. 7. Check that the scanner belts [B][C][G][H] are properly set between the bracket and the 1st scanner. 8. Tighten the screws [A][F]. 9. Remove the positioning tools. 10. Reassemble the machine and check the operation.
B121/B122/B123
3-16
SM
SCANNER UNIT
[A]
[D]
[E]
[B]
[C]
B121R915.WMF
[H]
[G]
B121R961.WMF
9. Loosen the 2 screws [F]. 10. Slide the 2nd scanner to align the following holes and marks (! Overview): The adjustment holes in the first scanner The adjustment holes in the second scanner The alignment marks on the frames 11. Insert the positioning tools [G][H] through the holes and marks. 12. Check that the scanner belts are properly set in the brackets. 13. Remove the positioning tools. 14. Reassemble the machine and check the operation.
SM
3-17
B121/B122/B123
LASER UNIT
B121R962.WMF
B121R963.WMF
B121/B122/B123
3-18
SM
LASER UNIT
[A]
[C]
B121R964.WMF
[D]
B121R965.WMF
SM
3-19
B121/B122/B123
LASER UNIT
3.5.4 LD UNIT
CAUTION: Do not touch the paint-locked screw [A]. The LD position is adjusted before shipment. 1. Laser unit (! 3.5.3) 2. LD unit [A] (! x 1) NOTE: Do not screw the LD unit in too tightly when installing it.
[A]
[B]
B121R916.WMF
[A]
B121R966.WMF
B121/B122/B123
3-20
SM
LASER UNIT
!WARNING
Reinstall the copy exit tray before turning the main switch on. The laser beam may exit the copier chassis when the copy exit tray is not installed. The laser beam can seriously damage your eyes. 1. Start the SP mode. 2. Select SP5-902-1 and output the Trimming Area pattern (pattern 10). 3. Check that the four corners of the pattern make right angles: If they make right angles, you do not need to adjust the laser unit alignment. If they do not make right angles, go on to the next step. 4. Check the screw position on the lever [A]. If the screw is in the hole [C], go on to the next step. If the screw is in the slot [D], loosen the screw on the lever, loosen the four screws on the laser unit, and go on to step 9. NOTE: The initial position of the screw is in hole [C]. 5. Four screws in the laser unit (! 3.5.3) 6. Remove the lever (! x 1), confirm the position of the hole beneath the slot [D], and reinstall the lever. [C] [D]
B121R967.WMF
[A]
[B]
7. Install the screw (through the slot [D]) loosely into the hole beneath the slot (do not tighten the screw). 8. Install the four screws for the laser unit loosely (do not tighten the screws). 9. When you rotate the lever clockwise or counterclockwise by one notch of the lever, the corners of the pattern shift by 0.4 mm (from the leading and trailing edges). See the trim pattern made in step 2, and find how much the corners should be shifted. 10. Tighten the screw [A]. 11. Tighten the screws on the laser unit. 12. Reinstall the copy tray. 13. Print the trim pattern and check the result. If further adjustment is required, repeat this procedure.
B121R968.WMF
SM
3-21
B121/B122/B123
Replacement Adjustment
PCU SECTION
[B] 3. Press the latch [B] and pull out the PCU [C]. NOTE: Do not touch the OPC drum surface with bare hands. 4. Load new developer (! 3.6.6). 5. When reassembling, execute SP2-214 to reinitialize the TD sensor. [C]
B121R918.WMF
B121R969.WMF
[B]
B121R970.WMF
B121/B122/B123
3-22
SM
PCU SECTION
[F]
B121R971.WMF
1. PCU (! 3.6.1) 2. Front side piece [A] (! x 1) 3. Rear side piece [B] (! x 2, 1 coupling) 4. Separate the drum section [C] from the developer section [D]. NOTE: To ensure that the left-side gears line up, keep the drum cover [E] closed when reinserting the front side piece. 5. Pry out the drum retaining clip [F]. NOTE: When reassembling, install the clip in the same orientation (with the lip facing away from the drum shaft). 6. OPC drum [G] 7. When reassembling, adjust the image quality (! 3.6.7).
SM
3-23
B121/B122/B123
Replacement Adjustment
PCU SECTION
[B]
[A]
[E]
B121R973.WMF
1. OPC Drum (! 3.6.3) 2. Holding pin [A] 3. Stepped screw [B] 4. Charge roller [C] and cleaning brush [D] (with the holders and springs) NOTE: Turn the gear [E] (as necessary) so that the rear holder [F] comes out. 5. When reassembling, adjust the image quality (! 3.6.7). [A]
Reassembling
When replacing the cleaning blade, apply toner to the edge of the new cleaning blade. This prevents possible damage to the OPC drum and blade. 1. After installing the cleaning blade, remove some of the toner from the old bottle with your finger. 2. Apply the toner to the edge [B] of the new cleaning blade. Make sure to apply the toner evenly along full length of the new cleaning blade.
B121R974.WMF
[A]
B121/B122/B123
3-24
SM
PCU SECTION
3.6.6 DEVELOPER
[A] [D]
[B]
[E]
B121R975.WMF
[C]
Replacement Adjustment
B121R976.WMF
1. PCU (! 3.6.1) 2. To let the toner fall to the development section, gently tap about eight different spots on the top of the PCU housing with a screwdriver. Each spot must be approximately at an equal distance from the next spot. 3. Reinstall the PCU in the copier. 4. Turn the main switch on. 5. Open and close the front door and wait for the machine to rotate the development roller for about 10 seconds. 6. Repeat the previous step two more times. 7. PCU (! 3.6.1) 8. Separate the developer section from the OPC drum section (! 3.6.3). 9. Top part [A] of the development unit (! x 5) NOTE: Release the hook [B]. 10. Set the coupling [C] back to the shaft. 11. Turn the coupling in the direction of the arrow [D] to remove developer from the roller. 12. Turn the bottom part [E] over and rotate the gears to remove the developer. 13. Load new developer (! 1.2.3). 14. When reassembling, execute SP2-214 to reinitialize the TD sensor. NOTE: 1) Check that no toner or developer is stuck on a gear. Clean the gears as necessary with a blower brush, etc. 2) Be sure to replace the Mylar at the rear side in the correct position. (The Mylar protects the gears at the rear side from falling toner).
SM
3-25
B121/B122/B123
PCU SECTION
B121/B122/B123
3-26
SM
[A]
B121R977.WMF
[C]
B121R979.WMF
SM
3-27
B121/B122/B123
Replacement Adjustment
[F]
B121R980.WMF
[B] [C]
B121R920.WMF
Duplex Models
1. Open the right door. 2. Front right cover (! 3.3.7) 3. Upper guide [D] (! x 2) 4. Exit sensor bracket [E] (! x 1) 5. Exit sensor [F] (" x 1) [F] [D] [E]
B121R919.WMF
B121/B122/B123
3-28
SM
[B]
[C]
B121R981.WMF
1. By-pass tray (! 3.3.10) NOTE: If you have a support to keep the by-pass tray within the reach of the connector cable, you do not need to disconnect the connector. When you do so, use caution not to place too much load on the cable. 2. Sensor holder [A] 3. By-pass paper end sensor [B] (" x 1) 4. By-pass feed roller [C]
SM
3-29
B121/B122/B123
Replacement Adjustment
[A]
[G] [F]
[A]
[I] [B]
B121R982.WMF
[H]
[C] [D] 1. PCU (! 3.6.1) 2. Front cover (! 3.3.6) 3. Right door (! 3.3.9) 4. Rear cover (! 3.3.1) 5. High-voltage power supply (! 3.12.2) 6. Registration clutch (! 3.8.8) 7. Unhook the springs [A] and [B] at the rear and front sides. 8. Guide support [C] and guide [D] (! x 1, " x 1) 9. Bushing [E] (# x 1) 10. Gear [F] and bushing [G] (# x 1) 11. Registration roller [H] with the image transfer unit [I]
B121/B122/B123 3-30 SM
B121R921.WMF
[B]
B121R983.WMF
[F]
B121R922.WMF
[G]
B121R984.WMF
1. Rear cover (! 3.3.1) 2. High-voltage power supply board (with the bracket) [F] (! x 4, all connectors) 3. Registration clutch [G] (# x 1, " x 1)
SM
3-31
B121/B122/B123
Replacement Adjustment
[A]
B121R985.WMF
[D]
B121R986.WMF
B121/B122/B123
3-32
SM
[A]
B121R987.WMF
[C]
[B]
B121R988.WMF
[D]
[E]
B121R923.WMF
SM
3-33
B121/B122/B123
Replacement Adjustment
[B]
[A]
B121R990.WMF
[D]
[C]
B121R991.WMF
B121/B122/B123
3-34
SM
IMAGE TRANSFER
B121R992.WMF
[G] [E]
B121R993.WMF
SM
3-35
B121/B122/B123
Replacement Adjustment
NOTE: Leave the springs under the holders. When reassembling, [A] ensure that the pegs [C] on the holders [D] engage with the springs.
FUSING
3.10 FUSING
3.10.1 FUSING UNIT
!CAUTION
The fusing unit can become very hot. Be certain that it has cooled down sufficiently before handling it. 1. Turn off the main switch, and unplug the machine. 2. Front right cover (! 3.3.7) 3. Open the right door. 4. Fusing unit [A] (! x 2, " x 4)
[A]
B121R924.WMF
3.10.2 THERMISTOR
1. Fusing unit (! 3.10.1) 2. Thermistors [A] (! x 1, " x 1)
B121R925.WMF
[A]
B121/B122/B123
3-36
SM
FUSING
[B]
B121R926.WMF
[C] [F] 1. Fusing unit (! 3.10.1) 3. Front holding plate [C] (! x 1) 4. Rear holding plate [D] (! x 1) 5. Fusing lamp with the connector (600W) [E] (! x 2) 6. Fusing lamp with the connector (550W) [F] (! x 2) When reassembling, check that the front ends of the two lamps fit in the front holding plate. They do not fit in there if you install the two lamps incorrectly. [E]
B121R927.WMF
2. Separate the hot roller section [A] from the pressure roller section [B] (! x 4).
[C]
B121R928.WMF
SM
3-37
B121/B122/B123
Replacement Adjustment
[D]
FUSING
[A]
B121R994.WMF
3.10.6 THERMOSTAT
1. Hot roller (! 3.10.5) 2. Thermostat [A] (! x 2 for each) [A]
B121R929.WMF
B121/B122/B123
3-38
SM
FUSING
[A]
[E]
[C]
Replacement Adjustment
[B] [D]
B121R995.WMF
1. Separate the hot roller section from the pressure roller section (! 3.10.3). 2. Fusing entrance guide [A] (! x 2) 3. 2 springs [B] 4. 2 pressure arms [C] 5. 2 Bushings [D] 6. Pressure roller [E]
SM
3-39
B121/B122/B123
FUSING
[B]
[A]
[A]: Pressure roller [B]: Hot roller [C] 1. Place an OHP sheet on the by-pass feed table. 2. Enter SP mode, and run SP1-109. 3. Press the "Execute" key. 4. Press ". The machine feeds the OHP sheet into the fusing section, stops it there for 20 seconds, then ejects it to the copy tray. 5. Press the "#" key. 6. Quit the SP mode. 7. Check that the nip band (the opaque stripe) across the ejected OHP sheet is symmetrical, with both ends slightly thicker than the center. NOTE: There is no standard value for the nip band on this machine. Make the adjustment based on the band's appearance. 8. If the band is not as described above, change the position of the spring hooks [C] (one on each side), and then check the band again. NOTE: The higher hook position produces greater tension.
B121R996.WMF
B121/B122/B123
3-40
SM
FUSING
B121R930.WMF
SM
3-41
B121/B122/B123
Replacement Adjustment
B121R997.WMF
B121R998.WMF
B121/B122/B123
3-42
SM
[D] [C]
[A]
[B]
B121R931.WMF
1. Copy tray [A] (! x 2) 2. Exit cover [B] (! x 1) 3. Sensor bracket [C] (! x 1, " x 1) 4. Duplex inverter sensor [D] (! x 1)
SM
3-43
B121/B122/B123
Replacement Adjustment
[B]
B121R942.WMF
B121R999.WMF
B121R501.WMF
B121/B122/B123
3-44
SM
OTHER REPLACEMENTS
[A]
B121R502.WMF
B121R932.WMF
SM
3-45
B121/B122/B123
Replacement Adjustment
OTHER REPLACEMENTS
B121R933.WMF
B121R503.WMF
[A]
B121/B122/B123
3-46
SM
OTHER REPLACEMENTS
Reassembling
When reassembling, ensure that the arrow on the fan [B] points the outside of the copier. The arrow indicates the direction of the air current.
B121R934.WMF
[A]
Replacement Adjustment
Reassembling
When reassembling, ensure that the arrow on the fan [C] points the outside of the copier. The arrow indicates the direction of the air current. [B]
B121R935.WMF
B121R943.WMF
SM
3-47
B121/B122/B123
OTHER REPLACEMENTS
3.12.8 GEARBOX
Replacement Procedure
1. Inverter tray [A] 2. Two screws [B] from the middle rear cover NOTE: This step releases the topmost part of the BICU bracket. 3. High-voltage power supply board (with the bracket) (! 3.8.8) [A]
[B] 4. BICU (with the bracket) [C] (! x 6) NOTE: If you have difficulty removing the bracket, remove the screw at the middle of the crosspiece (see step 6). 5. Main motor (! 3.12.4)
B121R936.WMF
[C]
B121R937.WMF
[D]
B121R938.WMF
B121/B122/B123
3-48
SM
OTHER REPLACEMENTS
8. PCU (! 3.6.1) NOTE: This step releases the gear (on the gearbox) that drives the PCU. 9. Ground plate [A] (! x 2) 10. Gearbox [B] (! x 5, 1 belt)
[B]
B121R504.WMF
B121R939.WMF B121R940.WMF
When reassembling, do not change the position of the spring [C], and check that the bushing [D] on the PCU drive shaft is in the correct position. You can adjust its position by rotating the gear [E] seen from the opening of the gearbox.
SM
3-49
B121/B122/B123
Replacement Adjustment
[A]
OTHER REPLACEMENTS
12 11
01 05 04 02 08 06 07 09 03 10
B121R944.WMF
The gears are numbered 1 to 12 in the order in which they are to be installed in the gearbox. These numbers appear both on the gearbox and on the front (exposed) surface of each gear. If the gears fall out, start by finding gear number 1 and installing it onto location number 1 (setting it into place so that the side with the printed number remains visible). Then install the remaining gears (2 to 12) in the same way.
B121/B122/B123
3-50
SM
3.13.1 PRINTING
NOTE: 1) Ensure the paper is installed correctly in each paper tray before you start these adjustments. 2) Use the Trimming Area Pattern (SP5-902, No.10) to print the test pattern for the printing adjustments below. 3) Set SP 5-902 to 0 again after completing these printing adjustments.
Specification 2 1.5 mm
B A
2 1.5 mm
SM
3-51
B121/B122/B123
Replacement Adjustment
Blank Margin NOTE: If the leading edge or side-to-side registration cannot be adjusted to within the specification, then adjust the leading-edge blank margin or the left-side blank margin.
1. Check the trailing edge and right side edge blank margins, and adjust them using the following SP modes.
Trailing edge Right edge Leading edge Left edge SP mode SP2-101-2 SP2-101-4 SP2-101-1 SP2-101-3 Specification 2 +2.5/1.5 mm 2 +2.5/1.5 mm 2 1.5 mm 2 1.5 mm
D C
A: Trailing Edge Blank Margin B: Right Edge Blank Margin C: Leading Edge Blank Margin D: Left Edge Blank Margin
A B
B121R506.WMF
B121/B122/B123
3-52
SM
3.13.2 SCANNING
NOTE: 1) Before doing the following scanner adjustments, check and adjust the printing leading-edge and side-to-side registrations and the printing blank margins (as described above). 2) Use an A3 test chart to perform the following adjustments.
2. Check the leading edge and side-to-side registration, and adjust as necessary using the following SP modes.
Leading edge Side-to-side SP mode SP4-010 SP4-011 Specification 2 1.5 mm 2 1.5 mm
Magnification
B121R507.WMF
A B
B121R508.WMF
SM
3-53
B121/B122/B123
Sub-scan Magnification
1. Place the OS-A3 test chart on the exposure glass and make a copy from one of the feed stations. 3. Check the magnification ratio. If necessary, adjust the magnification using the following SP mode.
Sub-scan magnification SP mode SP4-008 Specification 1.0%
B121/B122/B123
3-54
SM
B121R509.WMF
B121R510.WMF
NOTE: Make a temporary test chart as shown above, using A3/11" x 17" paper. 1. Place the temporary test chart on the ADF and make a copy from one of the feed stations. 2. Check the registrations, and adjust as necessary using the appropriate SP modes, as follows.
Side-to-side registration Leading edge registration Blank margin for the trailing edge Side-to-side registration (Duplex: rear) SP mode SP6-006-1 SP6-006-2 SP6-006-3 SP6-006-4
Sub-scan Magnification
A
B121R511.WMF
A: Sub-scan magnification
NOTE: Make a temporary test chart as shown above, using A3/11" x 17" paper. 1. Place the temporary test chart on the ADF and make a copy from one of the feed stations. 2. Check the registration, and if necessary adjust it using SP6-006-005. The specification is 1.0%.
SM
3-55
B121/B122/B123
TROUBLESHOOTING
4. TROUBLESHOOTING
4.1 SERVICE CALL CONDITIONS
4.1.1 SUMMARY
There are four levels of service call conditions.
Level A Definition To prevent damage to the machine, the main machine cannot be operated until the SC has been reset by a service representative (see the note below). If the SC was caused by incorrect sensor detection, the SC can be reset by turning the main power switch off and on. The main machine can be operated as usual, excluding the unit related to the service call. The SC history is updated. The machine can be operated as usual. Reset Procedure Enter SP mode, and then turn the main power switch off and on. Turn the main power switch off and on. Turn the main power switch off and on. The SC will not be displayed. Only the SC history is updated.
Troubleshooting
B C D
NOTE: 1) If the problem concerns electrical circuit boards, first disconnect then reconnect the connectors before replacing the PCBs. 2) If the problem concerns a motor lock, first check the mechanical load before replacing motors or sensors.
SM
4-1
B121/B122/B123
120
Scanner home position error 1 The scanner home position sensor does not detect the off condition during initialization or copying.
121
Scanner home position error 2 The scanner home position sensor does not detect the on condition during initialization or copying.
143
SBU white/black level correction error The automatic SBU adjustment has failed to correct the black level. The automatic SBU adjustment has failed to correct the white level twenty times consecutively.
144
Exposure lamp defective Dirty white plate Incorrect position or width of white plate scanning (! SP4-015) BICU board defective SBU board defective Communication Error between BICU and SBU The BICU board cannot detect the SBU The flat cable between the BICU connect signal. board and the SBU has a poor connection The flat cable between the BICU board and the SBU is damaged BICU board defective SBU defective
B121/B122/B123
4-2
SM
193
Image transfer error Scanned images are not transferred to the controller memory within 1 minute. Memory address error The BICU board does not receive memory addresses from the controller board. Charge roller current leak A current leak signal for the charge roller is detected. Polygonal mirror motor error The polygon mirror motor does not reach operating speed within 10 seconds after the motor ON signal is sent, or does not turn on within one of the 200 ms check intervals during operation. No laser writing signal (F-GATE) error The laser writing signal (F-GATE) fails to turn Low after the laser crosses 5 mm on the drum surface from the laser writing start position. Laser synchronization error The main scan synchronization detector board cannot detect the laser synchronization signal for more than 5 consecutive 100 ms intervals.
198
302
320
321
322
390
391
TD sensor error The TD sensor outputs less than 0.2 V or more than 4.0 V 10 times consecutively during copying. Development bias leak A development bias leak signal is detected.
SM
4-3
B121/B122/B123
401
Transfer roller leak error 1 A current leak signal for the transfer roller is detected. A current feedback signal for the transfer roller is not detected. Transfer roller leak error 2 A current leak signal for the transfer roller is detected. A current feedback signal for the transfer roller is not detected.
402
500
502
503
504
Main motor lock A main motor lock signal is not Too much load on the drive detected for more than 7 consecutive mechanism checks (700 ms) after the main motor Main motor defective starts to rotate, or the lock signal is not detected for more than 7 consecutive checks during rotation after the last signal. Tray 2 lift motor malfunction (Optional Paper Tray units) The paper lift sensor fails to activate Paper lift sensor defective twice continuously after the tray lift Tray lift motor defective motor has been on for 18 seconds. Too much load on the drive mechanism Poor tray lift motor connection Tray 3 lift motor malfunction (optional paper tray units) The paper lift sensor fails to activate Paper lift sensor defective twice continuously after the tray lift Tray lift motor defective motor has been on for 18 seconds. Too much load on the drive mechanism Poor tray lift motor connection Tray 4 lift motor malfunction (optional two-tray paper tray unit) The paper lift sensor fails to activate Paper lift sensor defective twice continuously after the tray lift Tray lift motor defective motor has been on for 18 seconds. Too much load on the drive mechanism Poor tray lift motor connection
B121/B122/B123
4-4
SM
541
542
543
545
546
547
551
552
SM
4-5
B121/B122/B123
Troubleshooting
544
Paper feed motor lock (optional paper tray units) A motor lock signal is not detected for Paper feed motor defective more than 1.5 s or the lock signal is not Too much load on the drive detected for more than 1.0 s during mechanism rotation. Fusing thermistor open (center) The fusing temperature detected by the Fusing thermistor defective or out of position thermistor is below 71C and is not corrected after the main power switch is Power supply board defective turned on. Loose connectors Fusing temperature warm-up error (center) The fusing temperature rises less than Fusing thermistor defective or out of 7 degrees in 2 seconds, and this position continues 5 times consecutively. Fusing lamp open The fusing temperature is not detected Power supply board defective in 25 or 35 seconds. Fusing overheat error (center) Fusing thermistor defective The fusing temperature is over 230C for 1 second (detected by the Power supply board defective thermistor). Fusing overheat error (center) 2 Fusing thermistor defective The fusing temperature is over 250C for 1 second (detected by the fusing Power supply board defective temperature monitor circuit). Fusing lamp overheat error (center) After the fusing temperature reaches Fusing thermistor defective or out of the target temperature, the fusing lamp position does not turn off for 12 consecutive Power supply board defective seconds. Unstable fusing temperature (center) Thermistor defective or out of The fusing temperature varies 50C or position more within 1 second, and this occurs 2 consecutive times. Power supply unit defective Zero cross signal malfunction Zero cross signals are not detected Power supply board defective within 5 seconds after the main power BICU defective switch is turned on, or are not detected within 1 second after operation begins. Fusing thermistor open (rear) The fusing temperature detected by the Fusing thermistor defective or out of position thermistor is below 71C and is not corrected after the main power switch is Power supply board defective turned on. Loose connectors Fusing temperature warm-up error (rear) The fusing temperature rises less than Fusing thermistor defective or out of 7 degrees in 2 seconds, and this position continues 5 times consecutively. Fusing lamp open The fusing temperature is not detected Power supply board defective in 25 or 35 seconds.
555
556
590
591
620
621
632
633
634
635
Loose connection of the exhaust fan motor Too much load on the motor drive Communication error between BICU and ADF The BICU does not receive a response Poor connection between the BICU from the ADF main board for 4 seconds and ADF main board (DF connector) or more. ADF main board defective The BICU receives a break signal from BICU defective the ADF main board. ADF connection error An incorrect ADF (an ADF for some ADF incorrect (The ADF for other copier) is detected. (for Basic and B039/B040/B043 is installed on a MFP machines) B121/B122/B123.) An ADF (including the correct ADF) is The connector of the ADF is removed installed while the copier is in the while the machine is in the energy energy saver mode. (for MFP machine saver mode. only) Accounting error 1 An error is detected during the Accounting device defective communication with the MF accounting Loose connection device. Accounting error 2 After communication is established with Accounting device defective the MF accounting device, a brake Loose connection signal is issued. Accounting RAM error An error is detected in the RAM that Accounting device defective saves the information on the MF accounting. Accounting battery error An error is detected in the battery that Accounting device defective is in the MF accounting device.
B121/B122/B123
4-6
SM
760
761
762
800
804
818
ADF gate abnormal 2 The FGATE signal is not issued from the ADF within 30 seconds after the ADF starts feeding. ADF gate abnormal 3 The FGATE signal is not terminated by the ADF within 60 seconds after the ADF starts feeding. Startup without video output end error Video transfer to the engine is started, but the engine did not issue a video transmission end command within the specified time. Startup without video input end A video transmission was requested from the scanner, but the scanner did not issue a video transmission end command within the specified time. Watchdog error The CPU does not access the watchdog register within a certain time. Kernel mismatch error Software bug Self-Diagnostic Error: CPU The central processing unit returned an error during the self-diagnostic test. Self-Diagnostic Error: ASIC The ASIC returned an error during the self-diagnostic test because the ASIC and CPU timer interrupts were compared and determined to be out of range. Self-diagnostic Error: Network Interface The network interface board returned an error during the self-diagnostic test. Self-diagnostic Error: NVRAM The resident non-volatile RAM returned an error during the self-diagnostic test.
Controller board defective Software malfunction download controller firmware again Download controller firmware again Controller board defective Download controller firmware again Controller board defective
819 820
B B
821
823
Network interface board defective Controller board defective Replace the NVRAM on the controller board Replace the controller board
824
SM
4-7
B121/B122/B123
Troubleshooting
827
828
Self-diagnostic Error: NVRAM/Optional NVRAM The NVRAM or optional NVRAM Replace the NVRAM on the controller returned an error during the selfboard diagnostic test. Self-diagnostic Error: RAM The resident RAM returned a verify Download controller firmware again error during the self-diagnostic test. Self-diagnostic Error: ROM The resident read-only memory Controller board defective returned an error during the self Download controller firmware again diagnostic test. Self-diagnostic Error: Optional RAM The optional RAM returned an error during the self-diagnostic test. Self-diagnostic Error: Clock Generator A verify error occurred when setting data was read from the clock generator via the I2C bus. Network I/F Abnormal NIB interface error. IEEE 1394 I/F Abnormal IEEE1394 interface error.
829
Replace the optional memory board Controller board defective Replace the controller board
838
850
851
853
854
855
856
857 866
C C
867
IEEE1394 interface board defective Controller board defective IEEE802.11b error - card not detected (power-on) Wireless LAN card not detected at Poor connection power-on. Defective wireless LAN card Defective controller IEEE802.11b error - card not detected (during operation) Wireless LAN card not detected during Poor connection operation. Defective wireless LAN card Defective controller IEEE802.11b error Wireless LAN card error detected. Poor connection Defective wireless LAN card Defective controller IEEE802.11b interface board error Wireless LAN interface board error Poor connection detected. Defective wireless LAN interface board USB I/F Error USB interface error detected. Defective controller SD card authentication error The SD card does not contain a correct Data corruption license code. SD card access error 1 After the program saved in the SD card SD card removed starts running, the SD card is removed from the slot.
B121/B122/B123
4-8
SM
870
871
Flash ROM device defective Replace flash ROM on the MBU NVRAM on the GW controller board defective Mechanical total counter defective BICU defective Disconnected mechanical total counter NVRAM on the BICU defective Printer application program defective Hardware configuration incorrect (including memory shortage) Font file not installed Data corruption Memory defective BICU defective Poor connection between BICU and memory IMAC on the GW controller board defective BICU defective Poor connection Application program defective
900
901
903
920
Engine total counter error The checksum of the total counter is not correct. Printer error A fatal error is detected in the printer application program Printer font error Necessary font files are not found. Net file error The net-file management-file contains a fatal error. Memory error The machine detects a discrepancy in the write/read data during its write/read test (done at power off/on and at recovery from low power or night/off mode). IMAC hardware error A memory control job is not completed within a certain period.
921 925
C C
928
929
954
955
Printer application program error The printer status does not become ready when the printer application program is necessary for image processing. Image transfer error The controller is not able to transfer images when the engine needs them.
SM
4-9
B121/B122/B123
Troubleshooting
981
NVRAM defective Poor connection between BICU and NVRAM NVRAM is not connected BICU defective First machine start after the NVRAM is replaced Incorrect localization setting NVRAM defective Controller defective BICU board defective Poor connection between controller and BICU Software defective Internal parameter incorrect Insufficient working memory When this SC occurs, the file name, address, and data will be stored in NVRAM. This information can be checked by using SP7-403. Note the above data and the situation in which this SC occurs. Then report the data and conditions to your technical control center.
982
984
990
991
992
997
Software continuity error The software attempted to perform an unexpected operation. However, unlike SC990, the object of the error is continuity of the software. Unexpected Software Error Software encountered an unexpected operation not defined under any SC code. Application function selection error The application selected by a key press on operation panel does not start or ends abnormally.
No operation required. This SC code does not appear on the panel, and is only logged.
Software defective An error undetectable by any other SC code occurred Download the firmware for the application that failed An option required by the application (RAM, DIMM, board) is not installed
B121/B122/B123
4-10
SM
999
SM
4-11
B121/B122/B123
Troubleshooting
110-2 (BICU)
113-6 (BICU)
Shorted Shorted
Open
Shorted Exit 124-2 (BICU) Toner Density Image Density 125-3 (BICU) 123-2 (BICU) Open Shorted Open Shorted Open Shorted
B121/B122/B123
NOTE: SC392 is activated when the CPU detects an ID sensor error during developer initialization (SP2-214). However, SC392 is not displayed on the LCD but simply logged in the SC log (SMC printout), unless the technician exits SP Mode as soon as an error message is displayed.
SM
4-13
B121/B122/B123
Troubleshooting
4.2.2 SWITCHES
Component Upper Paper Size Vertical Transport Door CN 1151,2,4 (BICU) 110-5 (BICU) 1131,2,4 (BICU) 1361,2,4,5 (BICU) 124-5 (BICU) Front/Right Cover Condition Open Shorted Open Shorted Open Shorted Open Open Shorted Open Shorted Open Shorted Symptom The CPU cannot detect the proper paper size, and misfeeds may occur when a copy is made from the 1st paper tray. The Cover Open indicator is lit even if the vertical transport door is closed. The Cover Open indicator is not lit even if the vertical transport door is opened. The CPU cannot detect the proper paper size, and misfeeds may occur when a copy is made from the 2nd paper tray. The CPU misdetects or is not able to detect the size of the paper set in the bypass tray, causing possible misfeeds when feeding from this tray. The Cover Open indicator is lit even if the right door is closed. The Cover Open indicator is not lit even if the right door is open. The Cover Open indicator is lit even if doors are closed. The Cover Open indicator is not lit even if doors are open. The machine does not turn on. The machine does not turn off.
Main
B121/B122/B123
4-14
SM
LED DISPLAY
SM
4-15
B121/B122/B123
Troubleshooting
SERVICE TABLES
5. SERVICE TABLES
5.1 SERVICE PROGRAM MODE
!IMPORTANT Do not let the user access the SP mode. Only service representatives but no other persons are allowed to access the SP mode. The machine quality or its operation is NOT guaranteed after any person other than service representatives accesses the SP mode.
[A]
[B]
[C]
[D]
[E]
[F]
B121S905.WMF
Starting SP Mode
1. Type the keys as follows: " # $ % 2. Press the & key and hold it down until the SP-mode menu is displayed (about 3 seconds).
SM
5-1
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
! "/OK
Selecting Programs When a blinking underscore (or several blinking underscores) is displayed, you can type a number from the numeric keypad [D]. When the sign "! "/OK" [A] is displayed upper right corner, you can scroll through the menu by pressing the left-arrow key [B] or the right-arrow key [C]. To select a program, press the OK key [F]. Specifying Values
1. After locating a program, press the OK key. A blinking underscore (or several blinking underscores) indicates which value you can change. The value in parentheses is the default value of the menu. 2. Type a necessary value from the numeric keypad. To switch between positive (plus) and negative (minus) values, press the # key. 3. To validate the value, press the OK key. To cancel the value, press the cancel key [E].
Quitting Programs/Ending (S)SP Mode Press the " key or the cancel key to quit the program. You can end the SP mode by pressing one of these keys several times.
B121/B122/B123 5-2 SM
SP1-XXX (Feed)
1001* 1001 1 1001 2 1001 3 1002* Leading Edge Registration Adjusts the printing leading-edge registration from paper trays. All Trays [9.0 ~ 9.0 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step] (! 3.13) By-pass Duplex Side-to-Side Registration Adjusts the printing side-to-side registration from each paper feed station, using the Trimming Area Pattern (SP5-902, No.10). Adjustments are supported for all 4 possible feed trays (including optional trays). The SP1-002-1 setting is applied to all trays, not just the 1st tray. Settings for trays 2 to 4 are offsets relative to the SP1-002-1 setting. For duplex copies, the value for the front side is determined by SP1-002-1 to -4, and the value for the rear side is determined by SP1-002-6. 1st tray [9.0 ~ 9.0 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step] (! 3.13) 2nd tray 3rd tray 4th tray By-pass Duplex Paper Feed Timing Adjusts the amount of buckle the paper feed clutch applies to the paper after the registration sensor is activated. A higher setting applies greater buckling. 1st tray [0 ~ 10 / 5 / 1 mm/step] 2nd tray (B122/B123 only) [0 ~ 10 / 5 / 1 mm/step] Optional tray [0 ~ 10 / 5 / 1 mm/step] By-pass feed [0 ~ 10 / 6 / 1 mm/step] Duplex [0 ~ 20 / 6 / 1 mm/step]
SM
5-3
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
1007 1007 1
1103*
1103 1
Fusing Idling This program decides the action of the Fusing Drive Release Mechanism (! 6.13.2). When you select "1," the contact/release control is disabled and the drive power is always transmitted to the fusing unit. As a result, the machine takes a longer time to warm up the fusing unit. Use SP1-103-001 if fusing quality is low even when the room temperature is not very low. Fusing Idling [0 = No / 1 = Yes]
1105*
1105 1 1105 2 1105 3 1105 4 1105 5 1105 6 1105 7 1105 8 1105 9 1105 10 1105 11 1105 12
Fusing Temperature Adjustment Adjusts the target fusing temperature. "Center" indicates the center of the roller; "End" indicates the front and rear ends. Warm Up-Center [140 ~ 180 / 160 / 1C/step] Warm Up-End Standby-Center [140 ~ 170 / 155 / 1C/step] Standby-End [140 ~ 165 / 150 / 1C/step] Copying-Center [140 ~ 185 / 160 / 1C/step] Copying-End Low Level 2-Center [0 ~ 80 / 60 / 1C/step] Low Level 2-End Thick-Center [140 ~ 185 / 175 / 1C/step] Thick-End Warm Up Low-Center [140 ~ 180 / 170 / 1C/step] Warm Up Low-End
1106 1106 1
1107*
1107 1 1107 2
Fusing Soft Start Adjusts the number of zero-cross cycles of the fusing lamp AC supply needed to bring the fusing lamp power to 100% while bringing the lamp up to the standby temperature or while copying. Increase this value if the machine is experiencing sudden power dropouts (! 6.13.5). Warm Up Soft Start [0 = 10 cycles / 1 = 20 cycles / 2 = 50 cycles] Other Soft Start [0 = 5 cycles / 1 = 10 cycles / 2 = 20 cycles]
1108* 1108 1
Set-Fusing Start [0 = 1s / 1 = 1.5s / 2 = 2s] Specifies the interval for fusing-temperature control (! 6.13.5).
1109 1109 1
B121/B122/B123
5-4
SM
1110* 1110 1
Fan Control Timer [30 ~ 60 / 30 / 1 s/step] Inputs the fan control time. The fan maintains normal speed for the specified time after occurrence of an SC or following entry into Warm-up mode, Low Power mode, or Night/Off mode.
1902 1902 1
Display-AC Freq. Displays the fusing lamp power control frequency (as detected by the zero cross signal generator). The displayed value is 1/5 the actual frequency: 10 = 50 Hz, 12 = 60 Hz.
1903*
1903 1 1903 2
Feed Clutch Boost Adjusts the amount of extra push that the feed clutch gives to the paper after the skew has been corrected at registration. This feature helps the registration roller feed certain types of paper (such as thick paper). Increase the value if thick paper is jamming after feeding from the registration roller. By-pass tray [0 ~ 10 / 6 / 1 mm/step] 2nd, 3rd, 4th tray [0 ~ 10 / 3 / 1 mm/step]
Optional Tray Adj. Adjusts the reverse time for the upper and lower paper lift motors. 1st optional [2 ~ +2 / 0 / 1/step] ! Detailed Descriptions Optional Paper Tray Unit 2nd optional
SM
5-5
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
1911* 1911 1
By-pass Envelope [0 = Disabled / 1= Enabled The program dedicated to envelope printing runs when you enable this program (SP1-911-001) and you select "Thick Paper" as the paper type of the by-pass tray ($ > System Settings > Tray Paper Settings > Paper Type: Bypass Tray).
SP2-XXX (Drum)
2001* 2001 1 Charge Roller Bias Adjustment Printing [2100 ~ 1500 / 1700 / 1 V/step] Adjusts the voltage applied to the charge roller when printing. The actually applied voltage changes automatically as charge roller voltage correction is carried out. The value you set here becomes the base value on which this correction is carried out. ID sensor pattern [0 ~ 400 / 300 / 1 V/step] Adjusts the voltage applied to the charge roller when generating the Vsdp ID sensor pattern (as part of charge roller voltage correction). The actual charge-roller voltage is obtained by adding this value to the value of SP2-001-1.
2001 2
2101* 2101 1
2101 2
2101 3
2101 4
[0.0 ~ 9.0 / 2.0 / 0.1 mm/step] (! 3.13.1) Specification: 2 1.5 mm Adjusts the leading edge erase margin. Trailing [0.0 ~ 9.0 / 3.0 / 0.1 mm/step] (! 3.13.1) Specification: 2 +2.5/1.5 mm Adjusts the trailing edge erase margin. The rear trailing edge is this value plus 1.2 mm. Left side [0.0 ~ 9.0 / 2.0 / 0.1 mm/step] (! 3.13.1) Specification: 2 1.5 mm Adjusts the left edge erase margin. The rear left edge is this value plus 0.3 mm. Right side [0.0 ~ 9.0 / 2.0 / 0.1 mm/step] (! 3.13.1) Specification: 2 +2.5/1.5 mm Adjusts the right edge erase margin. The rear right edge is this value plus 0.3 mm.
2201* 2201 1
2201 2
Development Bias Adjustment Printing [1500 ~ 200 / 650 / 1 V/step] Adjusts the voltage applied to the development roller when printing. This can be adjusted as a temporary measure if faint copies are being produced due to an aging drum. ID sensor pattern [2 = LL (220 V) / -1 = L (260 V) / 0 = N (300 V) / 1 = H (340 V) / 2 = HH (380 V)] Adjusts the voltage applied to the development roller when generating the ID sensor pattern. The actual voltage applied is this setting plus the value of SP2-2011. The setting affects ID sensor pattern density, which in turn affects the toner supply.
2213* 2213 1
Outputs after Near End [0 = 50 pages / 1 = 20 pages] Sets the number of copy/print/fax pages that can be made after toner near-end has been detected. Reduce the number of pages if the user normally makes copies with a high image ratio.
2214 2214 1
Developer Initialization Initializes both the TD sensor toner supply target voltage and the TD sensor gain value. Carry this out after replacing the developer or the TD sensor.
B121/B122/B123
5-6
SM
2220 2220 1
TD Sensor Output Value Display Displays: a) Vt: the current TD sensor output value and b) Vref: the target TD output value Vts (SP2-926) + correction for ID sensor output. The TD sensor output value changes every copy. If a > b, toner is supplied to the development unit.
ID Sensor Error Analysis (! 5.1.5) Vsg Displays the Vsg value. Vsp Displays the Vsp value. PWM Displays the PWM value. Vsdp Displays the Vsdp value. Vt Displays the Vt value. Vts Displays the Vts value.
2301* 2301 1
2301 2
2301 3
2301 4
[2 = 4 mA / 1 = 2 mA / 0 = 0 mA / 1 = 2 mA / 2 = +4 mA] Adjusts the current applied to the transfer roller when feeding from a paper tray. Use a high setting if the user normally feeds relatively thick paper (within spec) from a paper tray (! 6.12.2). Thick/Special paper [2 = 4 mA / 1 = 2 mA / 0 = 0 mA / 1 = 2 mA / 2 = +4 mA] Adjusts the current applied to the transfer roller when feeding from the by-pass tray. Use a high setting (a) if the user normally feeds relatively thick paper from the bypass tray, or (b) if waste toner is re-attracted from the drum (which can occur when using transparencies). ! 6.12.2 Duplex [2 = 4 mA / 1 = 2 mA / 0 = 0 mA / 1 = 2 mA / 2 = +4 mA] Adjusts the current applied to the transfer roller when carrying out a duplex job. Use this SP if there is poor image transfer on the rear side of duplex copies (! 6.12.2). Cleaning [10 ~ 0 / 1 / 1 mA/step] Adjusts the current applied to the transfer roller for roller cleaning. Increase the current if toner remains on the roller after cleaning. (Remaining toner may cause dirty background on the rear side.) (! 6.12.2)
2802 2802 1
Forced Developer Churning Initializes the developer and checks the TD sensor output (Vt). The machine mixes the developer for 2 minutes while reading and displaying the Vt value. The machine does not initialize the TD sensor output. If the machine has not been used for a long period of time, prints may have a dirty background. In this case, use this SP mode to mix the developer. The message "Completed" is displayed when the program ends normally.
SM
5-7
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
2906* 2906 1
2906 2
Tailing Correction Shift value [0.0 ~ 1.0 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step] Shifts the image writing position in intervals specified by SP2-906-2. When making many copies of an original that contains vertical lines (such as in tables), the paper may not separate correctly. This can cause tailing images (ghosts of the vertical lines continuing past the bottom of the table). This SP can be used to prevent this. Interval [1 ~ 10 / 1 / 1 page/step] Changes the interval for the image shift specified by SP2-906-1.
2908 2908 1
Forced Toner Supply Forces the toner bottle to supply toner to the toner supply unit. Press 1 to start. The machine continues to supply toner until the toner concentration in the development unit reaches the standard level, or for up to 2 minutes (whichever comes first).
2915* 2915 1
Polygon Mirror Motor Idling Time [0 = None / 1 = 15 s / 2 = 25 s] Selects the polygon mirror motor idling time. To increase the speed of the first copy, the mirror motor begins idling when the user sets an original, touches a key, or opens the platen cover or DF. If this setting is left at the default (15 s), the motor will stop if the user does nothing for 15s. If the setting is 0, the motor will not switch off during standby. (But note that regardless of the setting, the motor will switch off when the machine enters energy saver mode.)
2921* 2921 1
Toner Supply Mode [0 = Sensor 1 / 1 = Sensor 2 (DFU) / 2 = Fixed 1 (DFU) / 3 = Fixed 2] Selects the toner supply mode. Under normal conditions this should be set to 0. You can temporarily change this to 3 if the TD sensor is defective. Do not set to 1 or 2, as these are for design use only (! 6.9.6).
2922* 2922 1
Toner Supply Time [0.1 ~ 5.0 / 0.4 / 0.1 s/step] Adjusts the toner supply motor ON time for Sensor 1 and Sensor 2 toner supply mode. Accordingly, this setting is effective only if SP2-921 is set to 0 or 1 Raising this value increases the toner supply motor ON time. Set to a high value if the user tends to make many copies having high proportions of solid black image areas (! 6.9.6).
2923* 2923 1
Toner Recovery Time [3 ~ 60 / 30 / 1 s/step] Adjusts the toner supply motor ON time used during toner recovery from Toner Near End or Toner End. This setting is effective only if SP2-921 is set to 0 Since toner recovery is carried out in 3-second cycles, the input value should be a multiple of 3 (3, 6, 9...). ! 6.9.6
B121/B122/B123
5-8
SM
2925* 2925 1
Toner Supply Rate Adjusts the toner supply time for fixed toner supply mode. This setting is effective only if SP2-921 is set to 2 or 3.[0 ~ 7 / 0]t = 200ms, and settings are as follows 0=t 4 = 12t 1 = 2t 5 = 16t 2 = 4t 6 = on continuously 3 = 8t 7=0s Raising this value increases the toner supply motor ON time. Set to a high value if the user tends to make many copies having high proportions of solid black image areas (! 6.9.6).
2926* 2926 1
Standard Vt [0.00 ~ 5.00 / 2.50 / 0.01 V/step] DFU Adjusts Vts (the Vt value for new developer). The TD sensor output is adjusted to this value during the TD sensor initial setting process]. This SP is effective only when SP2-921 is 0, 1, or 2.
2927* 2927 1
ID Sensor Control [0 = No / 1 = Yes] Selects whether the ID sensor is or is not used for toner density control. This value should normally be left at 1. If the value is 0, dirty background may occur after long periods of non-use.
2928 2928 1
Toner End Clear Clears the toner end condition without adding new toner. The following are cleared: Toner end indicator (goes out) Toner near-end counter Toner near-end level This function should generally not be used. If you clear the toner end condition without adding new toner, there is a risk that the drum may eventually begin to attract carrier after many more copies are made and toner runs out. This attracted carrier may damage the drum.
Vref Limits Adjust the upper or lower Vref limit. Upper [0.50 ~ 3.50 / 3.20 / 0.01V/step] DFU Lower [0.50 ~ 3.50 / 0.70 / 0.01V/step] DFU
2994* 2994 1
ID Sensor Detection Temperature [30 ~ 90 / 30 / 1 C/step] While the machine is recovering from an energy saver mode, or while the machine starts, the controller ignores the ID-sensor signals if the fusing temperature is at the specified value or higher.
SM
5-9
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
2996* 2996 1
Transfer Roller Cleaning Selects whether the transfer roller is cleaned before each copy job. Set this to 1 if dirty background is appearing on the reverse side of the first page of copy jobs. Note that this will increase the time required to generate the first copy. If the setting is 0, the transfer roller is never cleaned (! 6.12.3).
2998* 2998 1
Main Scan Magnification [0.5 ~ +0.5 / 0.0 / 0.1%/step] Adjusts the magnification along the main scan direction, for all print modes (copy, fax, printing). The specification is 100 1.0% (! 3.13.1).
B121/B122/B123
5-10
SM
SP4-XXX (Scanner)
4008* 4008 1 Sub-Scan Magnification (Scanner) [-0.9 ~ +0.9 / 0.0 / 0.1%/step] Adjusts the actual sub-scan direction scanning magnification. The higher the setting, the lower the scanner motor speed (! 3.13.2).
4009* 4009 1
Main Scan Magnification (Scanner) [0.9 ~ +0.9 / 0.0 / 0.1%/step] Adjusts the magnification along the main scan direction, for scanning (! 3.13.2). The specification is 100 1.0% Main scan magnification is implemented in steps of 0.5. Accordingly, your input value should be a multiple of 0.5 (1.0, 0.5, 0, +0.5, or +1.0)
4010* 4010 1
Leading Edge Registration (Scanner) [5.0 ~ +5.0 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step] Adjusts the leading edge registration for scanning in platen mode (! 3.13.2). (): The image moves toward the leading edge. (+): The image moves toward the trailing edge The specification is 2 1.5 mm.
4011* 4011 1
Side-to-side Registration (Scanner) [4.2 ~ +4.2 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step] Adjusts the side-to-side registration for scanning in platen mode (! 3.13.2). Increasing the value shifts the image to the right The specification is 2 1.5 mm. Scan Erase Margin Adjusts the scanning margin individually for each of the four edges. It is generally best to adjust the scanning margin as little as possible, and use the printing margin for image adjustments. Leading edge [0 ~ 9.0 / 1.0 / 0.1 mm/step] Trailing edge Left Right
4012*
4013 4013 1
Scanner Free Run Performs a scanner free run with the exposure lamp on. Press ON or to start. Press OFF to stop.
4015* 4015 1
4015 2
White Plate Scanning Start position [3.0 ~ +6.0 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step] Adjusts the scanning start position on the white plate for auto shading. The base value stored in the machine is 15.2 mm toward the white plate from the scanner H.P. This SP setting specifies the offset from this base value. Scanning length [3.0 ~ +6.0 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step] Adjusts the length of the white plate scan, in the main scan direction. The scan begins at the start position set above [in SP4-015-1] and extends for the specified length. The base value stored in the machine is 4.76 mm. This SP setting specifies the offset from this base value.
SM
5-11
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
4303* 4303 1
APS Small Size Original [0 = No (not detected) / 1 = Yes (A5/HLT LEF)] Selects whether or not the copier will consider the original to be A5/HLT LEF when the APS sensors cannot detect its size. If Yes is selected, paper sizes that cannot be detected by the APS sensors are regarded as A5/HLT LEF. If No" is selected, Cannot detect original size will be displayed.
4305* 4305 1
APS Priority [0 = Normal / 1 = A4/LT / 2 = 8K/16K] 1. A4/LT North America model: When the ASP detects the LT size, the controller interprets it as the A4 size. Other models: When the ASP detects the A4 size, the controller interprets it as the LT size. 2. 8K/16K (for the China model only) When the ASP detects the A3/B4 SEF, the controller interprets it as the 8K SEF. When the ASP detects the B5/A4 SEF, the controller interprets it as the 16K SEF. When the ASP detects the B5/A4 LEF, the controller interprets it as the 16K LEF. The Europe model interprets undetected original sizes as A5 LEF under the following conditions: i. SP4-303-001 is "Yes," and ii. SP4-305-001 is "Normal" The Europe model interprets undetected original sizes as LT SEF under the following conditions: i. SP4-303-001 is "Yes," and ii. SP4-305-001 is "A4/LT"
4428 4428 1
Scan Auto-Adjustment Performs the automatic scanner adjustment. Use this SP mode after replacing the white plate.
B121/B122/B123
5-12
SM
4901 4901 1
4901 2
4901 3
4901 4
4901 9
SBU White Level Adjustment Black Display-Error [0 = Normal / 1 = Error] Displays the return code of the black-level adjustment. When an error is detected, SC143 or SC145 is generated. Black Feedback-EVEN [0 8191] Displays the feedback value of the even channels given by the SBU. Normally, the value is 1, 2, 3, ..., 8188, 8189, or 8190. However, machine may operate normally even when the value is 0 or 8191. Black Feedback-ODD [0 8191] Displays the feedback value of the odd channels given by the SBU. Normally, the value is 1, 2, 3, ..., 8188, 8189, or 8190. However, machine may operate normally even when the value is 0 or 8191. Black Display-Target [0 63 / 10 /step] Displays the target value for the black-level adjustment executed during machine initialization. Normally, the value is 10. Other values indicate that the adjustment has ended unsuccessfully. White Target [0 511 / 511 / 1/step] Displays the target value for the white-level adjustment. White Result [0 511 / 0 / 1/step] Displays the result of the white-level adjustment. White Display-Error [0 = Normal / 1 = Error] Displays the return code of the white-level adjustment. When an error is detected, SC143 is generated. White Display-Overflow [0 = Normal / 1 = Error] Displays a return code of the white-level adjustment. The code "1" (error) is returned if the adjustment result is not in the range of the values in SP4-901-6. Service Tables
4901 10
4901 11*
4901 12
4901 14
White Number of Attempt [0 20 / 0 / 1/step] Displays how many times the white-level adjustment is retried. The value does not include the first execution of the white adjustment. For example, if the value is "2", this indicates that the white-level adjustment has been executed three times. The white-level adjustment can be executed 20 times or less. Therefore, if the value is "20," this indicates that the white-level adjustment has ended abnormally (as described, the value "20" does not include the first execution). If the white-level adjustment is unsuccessful, the machine uses the result of the latest, successful white-level adjustment. Auto Adjustment Setting [222 281 / 256 / 1/step] Displays the parameter of the white-level adjustment. The value is based on the result of SP4-901-12. Auto Adjustment-Result [0 600 / 0 / 1/step] Displays the result of the white-level adjustment. Normally, the value is between 228 and 281 (including the both values). When the value is normal, it is stored as the value of SP4-901-11. Auto Adjustment-Error [0 = Normal / 1 = Error] Displays a return code of the white-level adjustment. The code "1" (error) is returned if the adjustment result value is less than 228 or larger than 281 (! SP4901-12).
SM
5-13
B121/B122/B123
4902* 4902 1
Exposure Lamp ON Turns the exposure lamp on or off. To turn off the exposure lamp, select OFF. (The exposure lamp shuts off automatically after 180 seconds.)
4903* 4903 1
4904* 4904 1
[0 255 / 80 / 1/step]
4905* 4905 1
ADS Level [0 = All / 1 = One] Checks the whole area (0 = All) or the area between 15 mm and 90 mm from the left edge (1 = One) to adjust the ADS level.
4921* 4921 1
Image Adj Selection (! 6.5.4) Image Adj Selection (Copy) [0 ~ 10 / 0 / 1] Selects which mode the settings from SP4-922 to SP4-932 are used for. 0 = None 1 = Text 1 2 =Text 2 3= Photo 1 4 = Photo 2 5 = Photo 3 6 = Special 1 7 = Special 2 8 = Special 3 9 = Special 4 10 = Special 5
4922*
4922 1
Scanner Gamma Selects text or photo as the priority output mode. This setting is applied to all image processing modes of SP4-921.* 6.5.4 IPU Scanner Gamma (Copy) [0=System default/1=Text/2=Photo]
4923*
4923 1
Notch Selection (! 6.5.4) Selects the value of the center ID adjustment notch for the ID adjustment LEDs. Normally the center notch is 3 (range 1-5). If 1 is selected, each notch shifts down (becomes lighter). If +1 is selected, each notch shifts up (becomes darker). This setting is applied to all image processing modes of SP4-921. Notch Selection (Copy) [1 = Light / 0 = Normal / +1 = Dark]
4926*
4926 1
Texture Removal (! 6.5.4) Adjusts the texture removal level that is used with error diffusion. 0: The default value for each mode is used. Text 1, Photo 2, Special 2, and Special 5 have a default of 3 and Photo 1, 3 have a default of 1. 1: No removal applied. 2 5: Removal applied at the level specified here. The higher the setting (level), the less clear the image will become (more texture removal). This setting is only applied to the originals in SP4-921. Texture Removal (Copy) [0 ~ 6 / 0 / 1/step]
B121/B122/B123
5-14
SM
4927*
4927 1
Line Width Correction Adjusts the line width correction algorithm. Positive settings produce thicker lines; negative settings produce thinner lines. This setting is only applied to the originals in SP4-921 (! 6.5.4). Line Width Correction (Copy) [2 ~ 2 / 0 / 1/step]
4928*
4928 1
Independent Dot Erase Selects the dot erase level. Higher settings provide greater erasure. This setting is only applied to the originals in SP4-921 (! 6.5.4). Independent Dot Erase (Copy) [2 ~ 2 / 0 / 1/step]
4929*
4929 1
Positive/Negative [0 = No, 1 = Yes] Inverts white and black. This setting is only applied to the originals in SP4-921 (! 6.5.4). Positive/Negative (Copy)
4930* 4930 1
Sharpness-Edge [2 ~ 2 / 0 / 1/step] Adjust the clarity. This setting is only applied to the originals in SP4-921 (! 6.5.4). Sharpness-Edge (Copy)
4931* 4931 1
Sharpness-Solid [2 ~ 2 / 0 / 1/step] Adjust the clarity. This setting is only applied to the originals in SP4-921 (! 6.5.4). Sharpness-Solid (Copy) Service Tables
4932* 4932 1
Sharpness-Low ID [2 ~ 2 / 0 / 1/step] Adjust the clarity. This setting is only applied to the originals in SP4-921 (! 6.5.4). Sharpness- Low ID (Copy)
4941* 4941 1
White Line Erase [0 ~ 2 / 1 / 1/step] Selects the white line erase level (! 6.5.4). 0: None 1: Weak 2: Strong This setting is effective only Photo 1, Photo 3, Special 3 or Special 4 mode. 0: White line erase is not used, and white level correction is used instead This setting is applied regardless of what mode has been selected in SP4-921. Black Line Erase [0 ~ 3 / 2 / 1/step] Selects the black line erase level. This setting is effective only when originals are scanned by the A(R)DF (! 6.5.4). [0 = No / 1 = Very weak / 2 = Weak / 3 = Strong] This setting is applied regardless of what mode has been selected in SP4-921.
4942* 4942 1
SM
5-15
B121/B122/B123
SP5-XXX (Mode)
5001 5001 1 All Indicators On All LEDs turn on. The LCD turns on or off every 3 seconds. Press the reset key to end this program.
5104* 5104 1
[0 = Enabled / 1 = Disabled / 2 = Disabled if the size is undetected] Selects whether the machine counts twice for each sheet of A3/11"x 17". If this is set to Yes is selected, the total (mechanical) counter and the current user counter will both increment by two for each A3/11" x 17" sheet.
5113* 5113 1
0: None 11: MF key card (Increment) 12: MF key card (Decrement) Selects the corresponding key for installed devices such as coin lock.
5120* 5120 1
Clr-OP Count Remv [0=Yes / 1=Standby only / 2=No] Determines under which conditions the copy job settings are reset when the key counter is removed. With 0, the settings are cleared if the counter is removed at the end of a job or midway through a job. With 1, they are only cleared if the counter is removed at the end of a job. With 2, they are not cleared at all, under either condition. With duplex copies, the job settings are always preserved, regardless of the setting of this SP mode.
5121* 5121 1
Count Up Timing [0 = Feed In / 1 = Exit] Selects whether the key counter increments at time of paper feed-in or at time of paper exit.
5127* 5127 1
5501* 5501 1
PM Alarm Interval (Printout) [0 ~ 9999 / 0 / 0K copies/step] Specifies when the PM alarm occurs.
5801 5801 2
5802 5802 1
Machine Free Run Starts a free run of both the scanner and the printer. Press "ON" to start; press "OFF" to stop.
B121/B122/B123
5-16
SM
5803
5804
5807* 5807 1
Area Selection Selects the display language group. 1 Japan 2 North America 3 Europe 4 Taiwan 5 Asia 6 China 7 Korea SP5-807-1 is not cleared by SP5-801-2 (! 5.1.7).
5811* 5811 1
5812* 5812 1
5812 2
Service TEL Service TEL (Telephone) Use this to input the telephone number of the service representative. (The number is displayed when a service call condition occurs.) To input a dash, press #. To delete the current telephone number, press &. Service TEL (Facsimile) Use this to input the fax number printed on user counter reports. To input a dash, press #. To delete the current fax number, press &. Service Tables 5-17 B121/B122/B123
5824 5824 1
5825 1
5901 5901 1
Printer Free Run Executes the free run. Press "ON" to start; press "OFF" to stop.
5902 5902 1
5907* 5907 1
Plug & Play Setting Selects the brand name and production name for the Plug and Play function. These names are registered in the NVRAM. If the NVRAM becomes defective, these names should be re-registered. Use the right-arrow or left-arrow key to scroll through the list of brand names. To select a brand name, press the OK key. An asterisk (*) indicates which manufacture is currently selected. ! 5.1.7
SM
5918* 5918 1
A3/DLT Counter Display [0 = Off / 1 = On] Sets the key press display for the counter key. This setting has no relation to (SSP) SP5-104 A3/DLT Double Count.
! 5.1.15
B121/B122/B123
5-18
SM
SP6-XXX (Peripherals)
6006* 6006 1 ADF Adjustment (! 3.13.3) NOTE: Available menus depend on the machine model and its configuration. ADF Adjustment (StoS/Front Regist) [5.0 ~ +5.0 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step] Adjusts the side-to-side registration for the front side of the original, for ADF mode. Use the # key to select + or before entering the value ADF Adjustment (Leading Regist) [5.0 ~ +5.0 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step] Adjusts the leading edge registration for ADF mode. Use the # key to select + or before entering the value. ADF Adjustment (Trailing Erase) [3.0 ~ +3.0 / 1.0 / 0.1 mm/step] Adjusts the trailing edge erase margin for ADF mode. Use the # key to select + or before entering the value. ADF Adjustment (StoS/Rear Regist) [5.0 ~ +5.0 / 0.0 / 0.5 mm/step] Adjusts the side-to-side registration for the rear side of duplex originals, for ADF mode. Use the # key to select + or before entering the value. ADF Adjustment (Sub-scan Magnif) [0.9 ~ +0.9 / 0.0 / 0.1 %/step] Adjust the sub-scan magnification for the ADF. ADF Adjustment (Original Curl Adj) [0 = No / 1 = Yes] Enables or disables the skew adjustment for the reverse sides of originals. When you enable SP6-006-6, adjust the distance of the skew adjustment (SP6-006-7). ADF Adjustment (Skew Correction) [20 ~ +20 / 0 / 1 mm/step] Specifies the distance of the skew adjustment. SP6-006-7 is effective when you enable SP6-006-6 (ADF Adjustment [Original Curl Adj]).
6006 2
6006 3
6006 4
6006 5 6006 6
6006 7
6009 6009 1
ADF Free Run Performs an ADF free run. Press "ON" to start; press "OFF" to stop. Service Tables B121/B122/B123
6901 6901 1
Display ADFAPS Displays the status of the ADF original size sensors (! 5.1.17).
6910* 6910 1
ADF Shading Time [0 ~ 60 / 10 / 1 s/step] Adjusts the interval used for the shading processing in the ADF mode. Light and heat in the room may affect the scanner response. Reduce this setting if copy quality indicates that the white level is drifting during ADF copy jobs.
SM
5-19
7401* 7401 1
CounterSC Total [0 ~ 9999 / 0 / 1/step] Displays how many times SC codes are generated.
7403* 7403 1
7502* 7502 1
CounterPaper Jam [0 ~ 9999 / 0 / 1/step] Displays the total number of copy paper jams.
7503* 7503 1
CounterOrgn Jam [0 ~ 9999 / 0 / 1/step] Displays the total number of original jams,
7504* 7504 1 7504 10 7504 11 7504 12 7504 21 7504 22 7504 31 7504 32 7504 50 7504 60
Counter-Each P Jam [0 ~ 9999 / 0 / 1/step] Displays the total number of the paper jams classified by timing and location. Counter-Each P Jam (At power on) Paper jam occurs at power on. Counter-Each P Jam (Off-Regist NoFeed) Paper does not reach the registration sensor (from a paper tray). Counter-Each P Jam (Off-1 Vertical SN) Paper does not reach the relay sensor. Counter-Each P Jam (On-1 Vertical SN) Paper is caught at the relay sensor. Counter-Each P Jam (Off-2 Vertical SN) Paper does not reach the vertical transport sensor. Counter-Each P Jam (On-2 Vertical SN) Paper is caught at the vertical transport sensor. Counter Each P Jam (Off-3 Vertical SN) Paper does not reach the vertical transport sensor in the optional paper feed unit. Counter Each P Jam (On-3 Vertical SN) Paper is caught at the vertical transport sensor in the optional paper feed unit. Counter-Each P Jam (Off-Regist Bypass) Paper does not reach the registration sensor (from the by-pass tray). Counter-Each P Jam (Off-Regist Duplex) Paper does not reach the registration sensor during reverse-side printing (for duplex printing). Counter-Each P Jam (On-Regist SN) Paper is caught at the registration sensor. Counter-Each P Jam (On-Exit SN) Paper is caught at the exit sensor (previous page). Counter-Each P Jam (Off-Exit SN) Paper does not reach the exit sensor. Counter-Each P Jam (On-Exit SN) Paper is caught at the exit sensor. 5-20 SM
B121/B122/B123
7504 123 7504 125 7504 126 7504 127 7504 128 7504 129
Counter-Each P Jam (Off-Dup Inverter) Paper does not reach the duplex inverter sensor (from the registration roller). Counter-Each P Jam (On-Dup Inverter) Paper is caught at the duplex inverter sensor. Counter-Each P Jam (Off-Dup Entrance) Paper does not reach the duplex entrance sensor. Counter-Each P Jam (Off-Dup Entrance) Paper is caught at the duplex entrance sensor. Counter-Each P Jam (Off-Duplex Exit) Paper does not reach the duplex exit sensor. Counter-Each P Jam (On-Duplex Exit) Paper is caught at the duplex exit sensor.
7505*
7505 210 7505 211 7505 212 7505 213 7505 214 7505 215 7505 216
Counter-Each O Jam [0 ~ 9999 / 0 / 1/step] Displays the total number of the original jams on the ADF that have occurred at a certain timing or at a certain location. Counter-Each O Jam (Off-Regist SN) The original does not reach the registration sensor. Counter-Each O Jam (On-Regist SN) The original is caught at the registration sensor. Counter-Each O Jam (Off-Relay SN) The original does not reach the exit sensor. Counter-Each O Jam (On-Relay SN) The original is caught at the exit sensor. Counter-Each O Jam (Off-Inverter SN) The original does not reach the reverse sensor. Counter-Each O Jam (On Inverter SN) The original is caught at the reverse sensor. Counter-Each O Jam (Insufficient gap) The distance between originals is not sufficient. This jam can occur when the original is not of the standard size.
7507* 7507 1
Dsply-P Jam Hist Displays the latest 10 paper-jam history. The list below shows the possible 22 codes: 1 10 11 12 21 22 31 32 50 60 70 120 121 122 123 125 126 127 128 129 130 131 The codes correspond to the menus of SP7-504. For example, the code 1 corresponds to SP7-504-1, and the code 10 corresponds to SP7-504-10.
7508* 7508 1
Dsply-O Jam Hist Displays the total number of the original-jams history. The list below shows the possible seven codes: 210 211 212 213 214 215 216 The codes correspond to the menus of SP7-505. For example, the code 210 corresponds to SP7-505-210, and the code 211 corresponds to SP7-505-211.
SM
5-21
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
Memory/Version/PN Memory/Version (BICU) Displays the version of the BICU board Memory/Version (ADF) Displays the P/N and suffix of the ADF ROM.
7803* 7803 1
7804 7804 1
ResetPM Counter Resets the PM counter (SP7-803-1). When the program ends normally, the message "Completed" is displayed.
7807 7807 1
ResetSC/Jam Counters Resets the SC, paper, original, and total jam counters. When the program ends normally, the message "Completed" is displayed. SP7-807-1 does not reset the following logs: SP7-507 (Display-Paper Jam History) and SP7-508 (Display-Original Jam History).
7808 7808 1
ResetCounters Resets all counters except for the management counters. The management counters are the counters that are not changed by NVRAM Download (SP5-825-1; ! NVRAM Download (SP5-825-1) in section 5.1.11). When the program ends normally, the message the message "Completed" is displayed.
7810 7810 1
ResetKey Op Code Resets the key operator code. Use SP7-810-1 when the customer has forgotten the key-operator code. When the program ends normally, the message "Completed" is displayed, if the program ends abnormally, an error message is displayed. If the customer forgets the key operator code. To specify a new key-operator code, use the User Tools: System Settings Key Operator Tools Key Operator Code On Enter Key Operator Code. Display-Self-Diag Displays the SC codes and the number of their occurrences. Each number is in the range of 0 to 9999.
7832* 7832 1
B121/B122/B123
5-22
SM
7991*
7991 1
DsplyInfo Count Displays the total operating time or the total number of operations. The time is displayed in the following format: day:hour:minute:second. DsplyInfo Count (Dsply-Timer Count) The total of the time when the main switch is kept on (excluding the time when the safety switch is off [! 6.6.3]). DsplyInfo Count (Dsply-APS Working) The total of the time when the APS is working. Dsply-Info Count (Dsply-ID S Work) The total of the time when the ID sensor is working. Dsply-Info Count (Dsply-Dev Counter) The total number of paper outputs. Dsply-Info Count (Dsply-ID Er Count) The total number of ID-sensor errors.
ResetInfo Count ResetInfo Count (Reset-Timer Count) Clears the counter of SP7-991-1. Reset-Info Count (Reset-ID Er Count) Clears the counter of SP7-991-5.
SM
5-23
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
SP8-XXX (History)
8192* 8192 1 C: Total Scan PGS [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the total number of scanned originals. The both sides are counted when the front and reverse sides of an original (fed from the ADF) are scanned.
ADF Org Feed [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] ADF Org Feed (Front) Displays the total number of scanned front sides of originals fed from the ADF. ADF Org Feed (Back) Displays the total number of scanned reverse sides of originals fed from the ADF.
8381* 8381 1
T: Total Prt PGS [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the print count of all application programs.
8382* 8382 1
C: Total Prt PGS [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the print count of the copier application program.
8391* 8391 1
L size Prt PGS (A3/DLT, Larger) [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the print count of the AS/DLT size or larger paper.
8411* 8411 1
Prints/Duplex [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the total count of the duplex printing.
B121/B122/B123
5-24
SM
8422*
8422 1
C: PrtPGS/Dup Comb [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the total print count of copier application classified by combination/duple type. C: PrtPGS/Dup Comb (Simplex > Duplex) Original Print
B121S909.WMF
8422 2
Original Print
B121S910.WMF
8422 4
Original Print
B121S911.WMF
8422 5
Original
B121S914.WM
8422 6
Original
B121S912.WMF
8422 7
C: PrtPGS/Dup Comb(4>)
Original
B121S913.WMF
SM
5-25
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
8442* 8442 1 8442 2 8442 3 8442 4 8442 5 8442 6 8442 7 8442 8 8442 9 8442 254 8442 255
C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the total print count classified by paper size. C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (A3) C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (A4) C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (A5) C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (B4) C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (B5) C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (DLT) C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (LG) C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (LT) C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (HLT) C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (Other (Standard)) C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (Other (Custom))
C: PrtPGS/Ppr Tray [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the total print count classified by paper source. C: PrtPGS/Ppr Tray (Bypass Tray) C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (Tray 1) C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (Tray 2) C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (Tray 3) C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (Tray 4)
C: PrtPGS/Ppr Type [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the total print count classified by paper size. C: PrtPGS/Ppr Type (Normal) C: PrtPGS/Ppr Type (Thick) C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (OHP) C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (Other)
8522* 8522 1
C: PrtPGS/FIN (Sort) [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the total number of printing classified by paper size.
B121/B122/B123
5-26
SM
SP1-XXX (Feed)
1001* 1001 1 1001 2 1001 3 Leading Edge Registration Adjusts the printing leading-edge registration from paper trays. All Trays [9.0 ~ 9.0 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step] (! 3.13) By-pass Duplex
1002*
Side-to-Side Registration Adjusts the printing side-to-side registration from each paper feed station, using the Trimming Area Pattern (SP5-902, No.10). Adjustments are supported for all 4 possible feed trays (including optional trays). The SP1-002-1 setting is applied to all trays, not just the 1st tray. Settings for trays 2 to 4 are offsets relative to the SP1-002-1 setting. For duplex copies, the value for the front side is determined by SP1-002-1 to -4, and the value for the rear side is determined by SP1-002-6. 1st tray [9.0 ~ 9.0 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step] (! 3.13) 2nd tray 3rd tray 4th tray By-pass Duplex
1003*
Paper Feed Timing Adjusts the amount of buckle the paper feed clutch applies to the paper after the registration sensor is activated. A higher setting applies greater buckling. 1st tray [0 ~ 10 / 5 / 1 mm/step] 2nd tray (B122/B123 only) [0 ~ 10 / 5 / 1 mm/step] Optional tray [0 ~ 10 / 5 / 1 mm/step] By-pass feed [0 ~ 10 / 6 / 1 mm/step] Duplex [0 ~ 20 / 6 / 1 mm/step]
SM
5-27
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
1007 1007 1
1103*
1103 1
Fusing Idling Selects whether or not fusing idling is performed. Normally disabled in this machine. However, enable this mode if fusing is incomplete on the 1st and 2nd copies, which may occur if the room is cold. Fusing Idling [0 = No / 1 = Yes]
1105*
1105 1 1105 2 1105 3 1105 4 1105 5 1105 6 1105 7 1105 8 1105 9 1105 10 1105 11 1105 12
Fusing Temperature Adjustment Adjusts the target fusing temperature. "Center" indicates the center of the roller; "End" indicates the front and rear ends. Warm Up-Center [140 ~ 180 / 160 / 1C/step] Warm Up-End Standby-Center [140 ~ 170 / 155 / 1C/step] Standby-End [140 ~ 165 / 150 / 1C/step] Copying-Center [140 ~ 185 / 160 / 1C/step] Copying-End Low Level 2-Center [0 ~ 80 / 60 / 1C/step] Low Level 2-End Thick-Center [140 ~ 185 / 175 / 1C/step] Thick-End Warm Up Low-Center [140 ~ 180 / 170 / 1C/step] Warm Up Low-End
Displays the fusing temperature on the center or on the ends of the hot roller.
1107*
1107 1 1107 2
Fusing Soft Start Adjusts the number of zero-cross cycles of the fusing lamp AC supply needed to bring the fusing lamp power to 100% while bringing the lamp up to the standby temperature or while copying. Increase this value if the machine is experiencing sudden power dropouts (! 6.13.5). Warm Up Soft Start [0 = 10 cycles / 1 = 20 cycles / 2 = 50 cycles] Other Soft Start [0 = 5 cycles / 1 = 10 cycles / 2 = 20 cycles]
1108* 1108 1
Set-Fusing Start [0 = 1s / 1 = 1.5s / 2 = 2s] Specifies the interval for fusing-temperature control (! 6.13.5).
1109 1109 1
B121/B122/B123
5-28
SM
1110* 1110 1
Fan Control Timer [30 ~ 60 / 30 / 1 s/step] Inputs the fan control time. The fan maintains normal speed for the specified time after occurrence of an SC or following entry into Warm-up mode, Low Power mode, or Night/Off mode.
1902 1902 1
Display-AC Freq. Displays the fusing lamp power control frequency (as detected by the zero cross signal generator). The displayed value is 1/5 the actual frequency: 10 = 50 Hz, 12 = 60 Hz.
1903*
1903 1 1903 2
Feed Clutch Boost Adjusts the amount of extra push that the feed clutch gives to the paper after the skew has been corrected at registration. This feature helps the registration roller feed certain types of paper (such as thick paper). Increase the value if thick paper is jamming after feeding from the registration roller. By-pass tray [0 ~ 10 / 6 / 1 mm/step] 2nd, 3rd, 4th tray [0 ~ 10 / 3 / 1 mm/step]
Optional Tray Adj. Adjusts the reverse time for the upper and lower paper lift motors. 1st optional [2 ~ +2 / 0 / 1/step] ! Detailed Descriptions Optional Paper Tray Unit 2nd optional
SM
5-29
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
1911* 1911 1
By-pass Envelope [0 = Disabled / 1= Enabled The program dedicated to envelope printing runs when you enable this program (SP1-911-001) and you select "Thick Paper" as the paper type of the by-pass tray ($ > System Settings > Tray Paper Settings > Paper Type: Bypass Tray).
SP2-XXX (Drum)
2001* 2001 1 Charge Roller Bias Adjustment Printing [2100 ~ 1500 / 1700 / 1 V/step] Adjusts the voltage applied to the charge roller when printing. The actually applied voltage changes automatically as charge roller voltage correction is carried out. The value you set here becomes the base value on which this correction is carried out. ID sensor pattern [0 ~ 400 / 300 / 1 V/step] Adjusts the voltage applied to the charge roller when generating the Vsdp ID sensor pattern (as part of charge roller voltage correction). The actual charge-roller voltage is obtained by adding this value to the value of SP2-001-1.
2001 2
2101* 2101 1
2101 2
2101 3
2101 4
[0.0 ~ 9.0 / 2.0 / 0.1 mm/step] (! 3.13.1) Specification: 2 1.5 mm Adjusts the leading edge erase margin. Trailing [0.0 ~ 9.0 / 3.0 / 0.1 mm/step] (! 3.13.1) Specification: 2 +2.5/1.5 mm Adjusts the trailing edge erase margin. The rear trailing edge is this value plus 1.2 mm. Left side [0.0 ~ 9.0 / 2.0 / 0.1 mm/step] (! 3.13.1) Specification: 2 1.5 mm Adjusts the left edge erase margin. The rear left edge is this value plus 0.3 mm. Right side [0.0 ~ 9.0 / 2.0 / 0.1 mm/step] (! 3.13.1) Specification: 2 +2.5/1.5 mm Adjusts the right edge erase margin. The rear right edge is this value plus 0.3 mm.
2201* 2201 1
2201 2
Development Bias Adjustment Printing [1500 ~ 200 / 650 / 1 V/step] Adjusts the voltage applied to the development roller when printing. This can be adjusted as a temporary measure if faint copies are being produced due to an aging drum. ID sensor pattern [2 = LL (220 V) / -1 = L (260 V) / 0 = N (300 V) / 1 = H (340 V) / 2 = HH (380 V)] Adjusts the voltage applied to the development roller when generating the ID sensor pattern. The actual voltage applied is this setting plus the value of SP2-2011. The setting affects ID sensor pattern density, which in turn affects the toner supply.
2213* 2213 1
Outputs after Near End [0 = 50 pages / 1 = 20 pages] Sets the number of copy/print/fax pages that can be made after toner near-end has been detected. Reduce the number of pages if the user normally makes copies with a high image ratio.
2214 2214 1
Developer Initialization Initializes both the TD sensor toner supply target voltage and the TD sensor gain value. Carry this out after replacing the developer or the TD sensor.
B121/B122/B123
5-30
SM
ID Sensor Error Analysis (! 5.1.5) Vsg Displays the Vsg value. Vsp Displays the Vsp value. PWM Displays the PWM value. Vsdp Displays the Vsdp value. Vt Displays the Vt value. Vts Displays the Vts value.
2301* 2301 1
2301 2
2301 3
2301 4
2802 2802 1
Forced Developer Churning Initializes the developer and checks the TD sensor output (Vt). The machine mixes the developer for 2 minutes while reading and displaying the Vt value. The machine does not initialize the TD sensor output. If the machine has not been used for a long period of time, prints may have a dirty background. In this case, use this SP mode to mix the developer. The message "Completed" is displayed when the program ends normally.
2906* 2906 1
2906 2
Tailing Correction Shift value [0.0 ~ 1.0 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step] Shifts the image writing position in intervals specified by SP2-906-2. When making many copies of an original that contains vertical lines (such as in tables), the paper may not separate correctly. This can cause tailing images (ghosts of the vertical lines continuing past the bottom of the table). This SP can be used to prevent this. Interval [1 ~ 10 / 1 / 1 page/step] Changes the interval for the image shift specified by SP2-906-1.
SM
5-31
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
[2 = 4 mA / 1 = 2 mA / 0 = 0 mA / 1 = 2 mA / 2 = +4 mA] Adjusts the current applied to the transfer roller when feeding from a paper tray. Use a high setting if the user normally feeds relatively thick paper (within spec) from a paper tray (! 6.12.2). Thick/Special paper [2 = 4 mA / 1 = 2 mA / 0 = 0 mA / 1 = 2 mA / 2 = +4 mA] Adjusts the current applied to the transfer roller when feeding from the by-pass tray. Use a high setting (a) if the user normally feeds relatively thick paper from the bypass tray, or (b) if waste toner is re-attracted from the drum (which can occur when using transparencies). ! 6.12.2 Duplex [2 = 4 mA / 1 = 2 mA / 0 = 0 mA / 1 = 2 mA / 2 = +4 mA] Adjusts the current applied to the transfer roller when carrying out a duplex job. Use this SP if there is poor image transfer on the rear side of duplex copies (! 6.12.2). Cleaning [10 ~ 0 / 1 / 1 mA/step] Adjusts the current applied to the transfer roller for roller cleaning. Increase the current if toner remains on the roller after cleaning. (Remaining toner may cause dirty background on the rear side.) (! 6.12.2)
2908 2908 1
Forced Toner Supply Forces the toner bottle to supply toner to the toner supply unit. Press 1 to start. The machine continues to supply toner until the toner concentration in the development unit reaches the standard level, or for up to 2 minutes (whichever comes first).
2915* 2915 1
Polygon Mirror Motor Idling Time [0 = None / 1 = 15 s / 2 = 25 s] Selects the polygon mirror motor idling time. To increase the speed of the first copy, the mirror motor begins idling when the user sets an original, touches a key, or opens the platen cover or DF. If this setting is left at the default (15 s), the motor will stop if the user does nothing for 15s. If the setting is 0, the motor will not switch off during standby. (But note that regardless of the setting, the motor will switch off when the machine enters energy saver mode.)
2921* 2921 1
Toner Supply Mode [0 = Sensor 1 / 1 = Sensor 2 (DFU) / 2 = Fixed 1 (DFU) / 3 = Fixed 2] Selects the toner supply mode. Under normal conditions this should be set to 0. You can temporarily change this to 3 if the TD sensor is defective. Do not set to 1 or 2, as these are for design use only (! 6.9.6).
2922* 2922 1
Toner Supply Time [0.1 ~ 5.0 / 0.4 / 0.1 s/step] Adjusts the toner supply motor ON time for Sensor 1 and Sensor 2 toner supply mode. Accordingly, this setting is effective only if SP2-921 is set to 0 or 1 Raising this value increases the toner supply motor ON time. Set to a high value if the user tends to make many copies having high proportions of solid black image areas (! 6.9.6).
2923* 2923 1
Toner Recovery Time [3 ~ 60 / 30 / 1 s/step] Adjusts the toner supply motor ON time used during toner recovery from Toner Near End or Toner End. This setting is effective only if SP2-921 is set to 0 Since toner recovery is carried out in 3-second cycles, the input value should be a multiple of 3 (3, 6, 9...). ! 6.9.6
2925* 2925 1
Toner Supply Rate Adjusts the toner supply time for fixed toner supply mode. This setting is effective only if SP2-921 is set to 2 or 3.[0 ~ 7 / 0]t = 200ms, and settings are as follows 0=t 4 = 12t 1 = 2t 5 = 16t 2 = 4t 6 = on continuously 3 = 8t 7=0s Raising this value increases the toner supply motor ON time. Set to a high value if the user tends to make many copies having high proportions of solid black image areas (! 6.9.6).
B121/B122/B123
5-32
SM
2926* 2926 1
Standard Vt [0.00 ~ 5.00 / 2.50 / 0.01 V/step] DFU Adjusts Vts (the Vt value for new developer). The TD sensor output is adjusted to this value during the TD sensor initial setting process]. This SP is effective only when SP2-921 is 0, 1, or 2.
2927* 2927 1
ID Sensor Control [0 = No / 1 = Yes] Selects whether the ID sensor is or is not used for toner density control. This value should normally be left at 1. If the value is 0, dirty background may occur after long periods of non-use.
2928 2928 1
Toner End Clear Clears the toner end condition without adding new toner. The following are cleared: Toner end indicator (goes out) Toner near-end counter Toner near-end level This function should generally not be used. If you clear the toner end condition without adding new toner, there is a risk that the drum may eventually begin to attract carrier after many more copies are made and toner runs out. This attracted carrier may damage the drum.
2994* 2994 1
ID Sensor Detection Temperature [30 ~ 90 / 30 / 1 C/step] While the machine is recovering from an energy saver mode, or while the machine starts, the controller ignores the ID-sensor signals if the fusing temperature is at the specified value or higher.
2996* 2996 1
Transfer Roller Cleaning Selects whether the transfer roller is cleaned before each copy job. Set this to 1 if dirty background is appearing on the reverse side of the first page of copy jobs. Note that this will increase the time required to generate the first copy. If the setting is 0, the transfer roller is never cleaned (! 6.12.3).
2998* 2998 1
Main Scan Magnification [0.5 ~ +0.5 / 0.0 / 0.1%/step] Adjusts the magnification along the main scan direction, for all print modes (copy, fax, printing). The specification is 100 1.0% (! 3.13.1).
SM
5-33
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
Vref Limits Adjust the upper or lower Vref limit. Upper [0.50 ~ 3.50 / 3.20 / 0.01V/step] DFU Lower [0.50 ~ 3.50 / 0.70 / 0.01V/step] DFU
SP4-XXX (Scanner)
4008* 4008 1 Sub-Scan Magnification (Scanner) [-0.9 ~ +0.9 / 0.0 / 0.1%/step] Adjusts the actual sub-scan direction scanning magnification. The higher the setting, the lower the scanner motor speed (! 3.13.2).
4009* 4009 1
Main Scan Magnification (Scanner) [0.9 ~ +0.9 / 0.0 / 0.1%/step] Adjusts the magnification along the main scan direction, for scanning (! 3.13.2). The specification is 100 1.0% Main scan magnification is implemented in steps of 0.5. Accordingly, your input value should be a multiple of 0.5 (1.0, 0.5, 0, +0.5, or +1.0)
4010* 4010 1
Leading Edge Registration (Scanner) [5.0 ~ +5.0 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step] Adjusts the leading edge registration for scanning in platen mode (! 3.13.2). (): The image moves toward the leading edge. (+): The image moves toward the trailing edge The specification is 2 1.5 mm.
4011* 4011 1
Side-to-side Registration (Scanner) [4.2 ~ +4.2 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step] Adjusts the side-to-side registration for scanning in platen mode (! 3.13.2). Increasing the value shifts the image to the right The specification is 2 1.5 mm. Scan Erase Margin Adjusts the scanning margin individually for each of the four edges. It is generally best to adjust the scanning margin as little as possible, and use the printing margin for image adjustments. Leading edge [0 ~ 9.0 / 1.0 / 0.1 mm/step] Trailing edge Left Right
4012*
4013 4013 1
Scanner Free Run Performs a scanner free run with the exposure lamp on. Press ON or to start. Press OFF to stop.
4015* 4015 1
4015 2
White Plate Scanning Start position [3.0 ~ +6.0 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step] Adjusts the scanning start position on the white plate for auto shading. The base value stored in the machine is 15.2 mm toward the white plate from the scanner H.P. This SP setting specifies the offset from this base value. Scanning length [3.0 ~ +6.0 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step] Adjusts the length of the white plate scan, in the main scan direction. The scan begins at the start position set above [in SP4-015-1] and extends for the specified length. The base value stored in the machine is 4.76 mm. This SP setting specifies the offset from this base value.
B121/B122/B123
5-34
SM
4303* 4303 1
APS Small Size Original [0 = No (not detected) / 1 = Yes (A5/HLT LEF)] Selects whether or not the copier will consider the original to be A5/HLT LEF when the APS sensors cannot detect its size. If Yes is selected, paper sizes that cannot be detected by the APS sensors are regarded as A5/HLT LEF. If No" is selected, Cannot detect original size will be displayed.
4305* 4305 1
APS Priority [0 = Normal / 1 = A4/LT / 2 = 8K/16K] 1. A4/LT North America model: When the ASP detects the LT size, the controller interprets it as the A4 size. Other models: When the ASP detects the A4 size, the controller interprets it as the LT size. 2. 8K/16K (for the China model only) When the ASP detects the A3/B4 SEF, the controller interprets it as the 8K SEF. When the ASP detects the B5/A4 SEF, the controller interprets it as the 16K SEF. When the ASP detects the B5/A4 LEF, the controller interprets it as the 16K LEF. The Europe model interprets undetected original sizes as A5 LEF under the following conditions: i. SP4-303-001 is "Yes," and ii. SP4-305-001 is "Normal" The Europe model interprets undetected original sizes as LT SEF under the following conditions: i. SP4-303-001 is "Yes," and ii. SP4-305-001 is "A4/LT" Service Tables
4428 4428 1
Scan Auto-Adjustment Performs the automatic scanner adjustment. Use this SP mode after replacing the white plate.
SM
5-35
B121/B122/B123
4901 4901 1
4901 2
4901 3
4901 4
4901 9
SBU White Level Adjustment Black Display-Error [0 = Normal / 1 = Error] Displays the return code of the black-level adjustment. When an error is detected, SC143 or SC145 is generated. Black Feedback-EVEN [0 8191] Displays the feedback value of the even channels given by the SBU. Normally, the value is 1, 2, 3, ..., 8188, 8189, or 8190. However, machine may operate normally even when the value is 0 or 8191. Black Feedback-ODD [0 8191] Displays the feedback value of the odd channels given by the SBU. Normally, the value is 1, 2, 3, ..., 8188, 8189, or 8190. However, machine may operate normally even when the value is 0 or 8191. Black Display-Target [0 63 / 10 /step] Displays the target value for the black-level adjustment executed during machine initialization. Normally, the value is 10. Other values indicate that the adjustment has ended unsuccessfully. White Target [0 511 / 511 / 1/step] Displays the target value for the white-level adjustment. White Result [0 511 / 0 / 1/step] Displays the result of the white-level adjustment. White Display-Error [0 = Normal / 1 = Error] Displays the return code of the white-level adjustment. When an error is detected, SC143 is generated. White Display-Overflow [0 = Normal / 1 = Error] Displays a return code of the white-level adjustment. The code "1" (error) is returned if the adjustment result is not in the range of the values in SP4-901-6.
B121/B122/B123
5-36
SM
4901 10
4901 11*
4901 12
4901 14
White Number of Attempt [0 20 / 0 / 1/step] Displays how many times the white-level adjustment is retried. The value does not include the first execution of the white adjustment. For example, if the value is "2", this indicates that the white-level adjustment has been executed three times. The white-level adjustment can be executed 20 times or less. Therefore, if the value is "20," this indicates that the white-level adjustment has ended abnormally (as described, the value "20" does not include the first execution). If the white-level adjustment is unsuccessful, the machine uses the result of the latest, successful white-level adjustment. Auto Adjustment Setting [222 281 / 256 / 1/step] Displays the parameter of the white-level adjustment. The value is based on the result of SP4-901-12. Auto Adjustment-Result [0 600 / 0 / 1/step] Displays the result of the white-level adjustment. Normally, the value is between 228 and 281 (including the both values). When the value is normal, it is stored as the value of SP4-901-11. Auto Adjustment-Error [0 = Normal / 1 = Error] Displays a return code of the white-level adjustment. The code "1" (error) is returned if the adjustment result value is less than 228 or larger than 281 (! SP4901-12).
4902* 4902 1
Exposure Lamp ON Turns the exposure lamp on or off. To turn off the exposure lamp, select OFF. (The exposure lamp shuts off automatically after 180 seconds.)
4904* 4904 1
[0 255 / 80 / 1/step]
4905* 4905 1
ADS Level [0 = All / 1 = One] Checks the whole area (0 = All) or the area between 15 mm and 90 mm from the left edge (1 = One) to adjust the ADS level.
SM
5-37
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
4903* 4903 1
4921* 4921 1
4921 2
4921 3
Image Adj Selection (! 6.5.4) Image Adj Selection (Copy) [0 ~ 10 / 0 / 1] Selects which mode the settings from SP4-922 to SP4-932 are used for. 0 = None 1 = Text 1 2 =Text 2 3= Photo 1 4 = Photo 2 5 = Photo 3 6 = Special 1 7 = Special 2 8 = Special 3 9 = Special 4 10 = Special 5 Image Adj Selection (Fax) [0 ~ 5 / 0 / 1] Selects which mode the settings from SP4-922 to SP4-932 are used for. 0 = None 1 = Text 1 2 =Text 2 3= Photo 1 4 = Photo 2 5 = Special 1 Image Adj Selection (Scanner) [0 ~ 4 / 0 / 1] Selects which mode the settings from SP4-922 to SP4-932 are used for. 0 = None 1 = Text 1 2 =Text 2 3= Photo 1 4 = Photo 2
4922*
Scanner Gamma Selects text or photo as the priority output mode. This setting is applied to all image processing modes of SP4-921.* 6.5.4 IPU Scanner Gamma (Copy) [0=System default/1=Text/2=Photo] Scanner Gamma (Fax) Scanner Gamma (Scanner)
4923*
Notch Selection (! 6.5.4) Selects the value of the center ID adjustment notch for the ID adjustment LEDs. Normally the center notch is 3 (range 1-5). If 1 is selected, each notch shifts down (becomes lighter). If +1 is selected, each notch shifts up (becomes darker). This setting is applied to all image processing modes of SP4-921. [1 = Light / 0 = Normal / +1 = Dark] Notch Selection (Copy) Notch Selection (Fax) Notch Selection (Scanner)
4926*
Texture Removal (! 6.5.4) Adjusts the texture removal level that is used with error diffusion. 0: The default value for each mode is used. Text 1, Photo 2, Special 2, and Special 5 have a default of 3 and Photo 1-3 have a default of 1. 1: No removal applied. 2 5: Removal applied at the level specified here. The higher the setting (level), the less clear the image will become (more texture removal). This setting is only applied to the originals in SP4-921. Texture Removal (Copy) [0 ~ 6 / 0 / 1/step] Texture Removal (Fax) Texture Removal (Scanner)
B121/B122/B123
5-38
SM
4927*
Line Width Correction Adjusts the line width correction algorithm. Positive settings produce thicker lines; negative settings produce thinner lines. This setting is only applied to the originals in SP4-921 (! 6.5.4). Line Width Correction (Copy) [2 ~ 2 / 0 / 1/step] Line Width Correction (Fax) Line Width Correction (Scanner)
4928*
Independent Dot Erase Selects the dot erase level. Higher settings provide greater erasure. This setting is only applied to the originals in SP4-921 (! 6.5.4). Independent Dot Erase (Copy) [2 ~ 2 / 0 / 1/step] Independent Dot Erase (Fax) Independent Dot Erase (Scanner)
4929*
4929 1 4929 2
Positive/Negative [0 = No, 1 = Yes] Inverts white and black. This setting is only applied to the originals in SP4-921 (! 6.5.4). Positive/Negative (Copy) Positive/Negative (Fax)
Sharpness-Solid [2 ~ 2 / 0 / 1/step] Adjust the clarity. This setting is only applied to the originals in SP4-921 (! 6.5.4). Sharpness-Solid (Copy) Sharpness-Solid (Fax) Sharpness-Solid (Scanner)
Sharpness-Low ID [2 ~ 2 / 0 / 1/step] Adjust the clarity. This setting is only applied to the originals in SP4-921 (! 6.5.4). Sharpness- Low ID (Copy) Sharpness- Low ID (Fax) Sharpness- Low ID (Scanner)
SM
5-39
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
Sharpness-Edge [2 ~ 2 / 0 / 1/step] Adjust the clarity. This setting is only applied to the originals in SP4-921 (! 6.5.4). Sharpness-Edge (Copy) Sharpness-Edge (Fax) Sharpness-Edge (Scanner)
4941* 4941 1
White Line Erase [0 ~ 2 / 1 / 1/step] Selects the white line erase level (! 6.5.4). 0: None 1: Weak 2: Strong This setting is effective only Photo 1, Photo 3, Special 3 or Special 4 mode. 0: White line erase is not used, and white level correction is used instead This setting is applied regardless of what mode has been selected in SP4-921. Black Line Erase [0 ~ 3 / 2 / 1/step] Selects the black line erase level. This setting is effective only when originals are scanned by the A(R)DF (! 6.5.4). [0 = No / 1 = Very weak / 2 = Weak / 3 = Strong] This setting is applied regardless of what mode has been selected in SP4-921.
4942* 4942 1
B121/B122/B123
5-40
SM
SP5-XXX (Mode)
5001 5001 1 All Indicators On All LEDs turn on. The LCD turns on or off every 3 seconds. Press the reset key to end this program.
SSP 5044*
[0 = Enabled / 1 = Disabled / 2 = Disabled if the size is undetected] Selects whether the machine counts twice for each sheet of A3/11"x 17". If this is set to Yes is selected, the total (mechanical) counter and the current user counter will both increment by two for each A3/11" x 17" sheet.
5113*
5113 1
0: None 5: MF key card (Peace) Japan Only 11: MF key card (Increment) 12: MF key card (Decrement) Selects the corresponding key for installed devices such as coin lock.
5118*
5120* 5120 1
Clr-OP Count Remv [0=Yes / 1=Standby only / 2=No] Determines under which conditions the copy job settings are reset when the key counter is removed. With 0, the settings are cleared if the counter is removed at the end of a job or midway through a job. With 1, they are only cleared if the counter is removed at the end of a job. With 2, they are not cleared at all, under either condition. With duplex copies, the job settings are always preserved, regardless of the setting of this SP mode.
5121* 5121 1
Count Up Timing [0 = Feed In / 1 = Exit] Selects whether the key counter increments at time of paper feed-in or at time of paper exit.
5127* 5127 1
5162* 5162 1
Application Switching Method [0 = Soft Key Set / 1 = Hard Key Set] Determines whether the application screen is switched with the hardware switch or the software switch.
5302* 5302 2
Set Time [-1440 +1440 / 0 / 1 minute/step] Species the difference between your local time and GMT.
SM
5-41
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
Rev. 04/2004
5307 3 5307 4
Summer Time Summer Time On/Off Enables or disables the daylight saving time settings in SP5-307-3 and 4. OFF = 0, ON = 1 Summer Time Start ( 5.1.18) Specifies the start of the daylight saving time. Summer Time End ( 5.1.18) Specifies the end of the daylight saving time.
5404* 5404 1
PM Alarm Interval PM Alarm Interval (Printout) [0 ~ 9999 / 0 / 0K copies/step] Specifies when the PM alarm occurs. PM Alarm Original Count Alarm [0 = Off / 1 = On] Enables or disables the original count alarm.
5504* 5504 1
Jam Alarm Sets the alarm to sound for the specified jam level (document misfeeds are not included). [0~3 / 3 / 1 step] 0: Zero (Off) 1: Low (2.5K jams) 2: Medium (3K jams) 3: High (6K jams)
5505* 5505 1
Error Alarm [0 ~ 255 / 20 / 1 hundred sheets/step] Specifies the number of paper (in hundred) used as the error alarm level. The error alarm starts if 5 SC codes (or more) are generated before the copier prints the specified number of paper. When the copier has printed the specified number of paper, the SC code counter (of this SP) is cleared to zero.
5507* 5507 1 5507 3 5507 128 5507 132 5507 133 5507 134 5507 141 5507 142 5507 160 5507 164 5507 166 5507 172
Supply Alarm Paper Supply Alarm Toner Supply Alarm Interval :Others Interval :A3 Interval :A4 Interval :A5 Interval :B4 Interval :B5 Interval :DLT Interval :LG Interval :LT Interval :HLT
0: Off, 1: On, DFU 0: Off, 1: On, DFU [00250 ~ 10000 / 1000 / 1 Step] DFU
B121/B122/B123
5-42
SM
5508 12*
5508 13*
CC Call Jam Remains 0: Disable, 1: Enable Enables/disables initiating a call for an unattended paper jam. Frequent Jams 0: Disable, 1: Enable Enables/disables initiating a call for consecutive paper jams. Continuous Door Open 0: Disable, 1: Enable Enables/disables initiating a call when the front door remains open. Low Call Mode 0: Normal mode, 1: Reduced mode Enables/disables the new call specifications designed to reduce the number of calls. Jam Detection: Time Length [03~30 / 10 / 1] Sets the time a jam must remain before it becomes an unattended paper jam. This setting is enabled only when SP5508 004 is set to 1. Jam Detection: Continuous [02~10 / 5 / 1] Count Sets the number of consecutive paper jams required to initiate a call. This setting is enabled only when SP5508 004 is set to 1. Door Open: Time Length [03~30 / 10 / 1] Sets the length of time the door remains open before the machine initiates a call. This setting is enabled only when SP5508 004 is set to 1. CC Call: Long Time Jam [0 = Auto call / 1 = Alarm] Selects the machine reaction to long time jams. CC Call: Continuous Jam [0 = Auto call / 1 = Alarm] Selects the machine reaction to continuous jams. CC Call: Door Open [0 = Auto call / 1 = Alarm] Selects the machine reaction to door open.
SM
5-43
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
5801 5801 1
Memory Clear All Clear Executes the following memory clears at the same time: SP5-801-2 through 12. SCS Initializes the system-control-service settings. IMH Memory Clear Initializes the image-memory-handler settings. MCS Initializes the memory-control-service settings. Copier application Initializes the copier-application settings. Fax application Initializes the fax-application settings. Printer application Initializes the printer-application settings. Scanner application Initializes the scanner-application settings. Web service/Network application Deletes the network file application management files and thumbnails, and initializes the job login ID.
Rev. 7/2004
5801 11
5801 12
5801 14 5801 15
NCS Initializes the network-control-service settings: the system defaults and interface settings (including IP addresses), Smart Net Monitor for Administrator, Web Status Monitor settings, and the TELNET settings. R-Fax Initializes the job log in ID, Smart Net Monitor for Administrator, job history, and local storage file numbers. Clear DCS Settings Clear UCS Settings
5802 5802 1
Machine Free Run Starts a free run of both the scanner and the printer. Press "ON" to start; press "OFF" to stop.
5803
5804
5807* 5807 1
Area Selection Selects the display language group. 1 Japan 2 North America 3 Europe 4 Taiwan 5 Asia 6 China 7 Korea SP5-807-001 is not cleared by SP5-801-001 and SP5-998-001 ( 5.1.7).
5811* 5811 1
5812* 5812 1
5812 2
Service TEL Service TEL (Telephone) Use this to input the telephone number of the service representative. (The number is displayed when a service call condition occurs.) To input a dash, press . To delete the current telephone number, press . Service TEL (Facsimile) Use this to input the fax number printed on user counter reports. To input a dash, press . To delete the current fax number, press .
B121/B122/B123
5-44
SM
5816* 5816 1
5816 2
[0=Remote diagnostics off/1=Serial (CSS or NRS) remote diagnostics on/2=Network remote diagnostics] Enables or disables the remote diagnostics function. CE Call Allows the customer representative to start or end the remote machine check using CSS or NRS by pressing the center report key. Function Flag [0 = Disabled / 1 = Enabled] Enables or disables remote diagnosis via the NRS network. Device Information Call Display [0 = Disabled / 1 = Enabled] Determines whether the device information call (NRS) is displayed. SSL Disable [0 = Disabled / 1 = Enabled] Determines whether the SSL sends the remote-communication-gate confirmation. RCG Connect Timeout [1 90 / 10 / 1 second/step] Sets the timer for the remote-communication-gate connection (NRS). RCG Write to Timeout [0 100 / 60 / 1 second/step] Sets the timer for writing data to the remote communication gate (NRS). RCG Read Timeout [0 100 / 60 / 1 second/step] Sets the timer for reading data from the remote communication gate (NRS). Port 80 Enable Determines whether permission is granted for access to the SOP via Port 80 (NRS).
Japan Only. Sets the PI device code. After changing this setting, you must switch the machine off and on. Sets the IP address of the RCG (Remote Communication Gate) destination for call processing at the remote service center. [00000000h ~ FFFFFFFFh/ 00000000h /
5824 5824 1
5825 1
Network Setting Delete Password Deletes the NCS (Network Control Service) password. Sets the Telnet, WSM (Web Status Monitor), and remote ROM update passwords to NULL (empty) Print Settings List Prints a list of the NCS parameter settings. TELNET (0:OFF 1:ON) [0 = Disabled / 1 = Enabled] Disables or enables Telnet operation. If this SP is disabled the Telnet port is closed. Web (0:OFF 1:ON) [0 = Disabled / 1 = Enabled] Disables or enables the Web operation.
SM
5-45
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
Enables and disables the operation panel read (dump) feature. After powering on the machine, set this option to 1 to enable this feature. To reset the machine to 0, the machine must be turned off and on again. Selecting 0 for this option without cycling the power off and on does not restore the default setting (0).
5839* 5839 4
5839 7* 5839 8*
5839 9*
5839 10*
5839 11*
5839 12*
5839 13*
IEEE 1394 Host Name Enter name Enter the name of the device used on the network. Example: RNP0000000000 Cycle Master OFF / ON Enables or disables the cycle master function for the 1394 bus standard. BCR mode Determines how BCR (Broadcast Channel Register) operates on the 1394 standard bus when the independent node is in any mode other than IRM. (NVRAM: 2bits) Always Effective: Writes from the IRM. Standard: Copies BCR of the IRM after no data is written from the IRM after the prescribed time has elapsed. IRM Color Copy: BCR normally enabled. IRM 1394a Check Conducts a 1394a check of IRM when the independent node is in any mode other than IRM. OFF: Checks whether IRM conforms to 1394a. ON: After IRM is checked, if IRM does not conform then independent node switches to IRM. Unique ID Lists the ID (Node_Unique_ID) assigned to the device by the system administrator. OFF: Does not list the Node_Unique_ID assigned by the system administrator. Instead, the Source_ID of the GASP header in the ARP is used. ON: The Node_Unique_ID assigned by the system administrator is used, and the Source_ID of the GASP header in the ARP is ignored. Also, when the serial bus is reset, extra bus transactions are opened for enumeration. Logout Handles the login request of the login initiator for SBP-2. (1bit) OFF: Disable (refuse login). Initiator retry during login. Login refusal on arrival of login request (standard operation) ON: Enable (force logout). Initiator retry during login. Login refusal on arrival of login request, and the initiator forces the login. Login Enables or disables the exclusive login feature (SBP-2 related). OFF: Disables. The exclusive login (LOGIN ORB exclusive it) is ignored. ON: Enables. Exclusive login is in effect. Login MAX [0~63 / 8 / 1], (0 and 63: Reserved) Sets the maximum number of logins from the initiator (6-bits)
B121/B122/B123
5-46
SM
5840* 5840 4*
5840 6*
5840 7*
5840 11*
5842 5842 1*
Net File Analysis Specifies the output mode for debugging of each net file process. The 8th bit is reserved. The 7th bit is the switch of debugging output for each module.
5843 5843 1*
Operation Panel Image Exposure [0: Off (disable) / 1: On (enable)] Enables and disables the operation panel read (dump) feature. After powering on the machine, set this option to 1 to enable this feature. To reset the machine to 0, the machine must be turned off and on again. Selecting 0 for this option without cycling the power off and on does not restore the default setting (0).
SM
5-47
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
5840 20*
IEEE 802.11b SSID Enter ID Enters a unique ID (up to 32 characters long) to identify the device when it is operating in an area with another wireless LAN network. Channel MAX JA [1~14/ 14 / 1] NA [1~11 / 11 / 1 EU [1~13 / 13 / 1] China, Taiwan (Same as NA) Sets the maximum number of channels available for data transmission via the wireless LAN. The number of channels available varies according to location. The default settings are set for the maximum end of the range for each area. Adjust the upper 4 bits to set the maximum number of channels. Displayed only when the option 802.11b for wireless LAN is installed. Channel MIN JA [1~14 / 1 / 1] NA [1~11 / 1 / 1 EU [1~13 / 1 / 1] China, Taiwan (Same as NA) Sets the minimum number of channels available for data transmission via the wireless LAN. The number of channels available varies according to location. The default settings are set for the minimum end of the range for each area. Adjust the lower 4 bits to set the minimum number of channels. Displayed only when the option 802.11b for wireless LAN is installed. WEP Key Select 00: Key #1 0000 0000 01: Key #2 (Reserved) 0000 0001 10: Key #3 (Reserved) 0000 0010 11: Key #4 (Reserved) 0000 0011 Selects the WEP key. [00~11 / 00 / 1 binary] WEP Mode 0: Max. 64-bit (10 characters) 1: Max. 128-bit (10, 26 characters) Determines the operation mode of the WEP key. Displayed only when the option 801.11b for wireless LAN is installed.
5844* 5844 1*
USB Transfer Rate Full Speed / Auto Change Sets the speed for USB data transmission. Full Speed: (12 Mbps fixed) Auto Change: 480 Mbps/12 Mbps auto adjust Vendor ID [0x0000~0xFFFF/ 0x05CA /1], DFU Sets the vendor ID: Initial Setting: 0x05CA Ricoh Company. Product ID [0x0000~0xFFFF/ 0x0403 /1], DFU Sets the product ID. Device Release Number [0000~9999/ 0100 /1], DFU Sets the device release number of the BCD (binary coded decimal) display. Enter as a decimal number. NCS converts the number to hexadecimal number recognized as the BCD.
5845 6*
5845 8*
5845 9*
5845 10*
Delivery Server Setting Provides items for delivery server settings. FTP Port No. [0~65535 / 3670 / 1] Sets the FTP port number used when image files to the Scan Router Server. IP Address (Primary) Range: 000.000.000.000 ~ 255.255.255.255 Use this SP to set the Scan Router Server address. The IP address under the transfer tab can be referenced by the initial system setting. Delivery Error Display Time [0~999 / 300 / 1] Netfiles: Use this setting to determine the length of time the prompt message is displayed when a test error occurs during document transfer with the NetFile application and an external device. IP Address (Secondary) Range: 000.000.000.000 ~ 255.255.255.255 Specifies the IP address assigned to the computer designated to function as the secondary delivery server of Scan Router. This SP allows only the setting of the IP address without reference to the DNS setting. Delivery Server Model [0~4/ 0 / 1] Allows changing the model of the delivery server registered by the I/O device. 0: Unknown 1: SG1 Provided 2: SG1 Package 3: SG2 Provided 4: SG2 Package Delivery Svr Capability [0~255 / 0 / 1] Bit7 = 1 Comment information exits Changes the capability of Bit6 = 1 Direct specification of mail address possible the Bit5 = 1 Mail RX confirmation setting possible registered Bit4 = 1 Address book automatic update function exists that the I/O Bit3 = 1 Fax RX delivery function exists device Bit2 = 1 Sender password function exists registered. Bit1 = 1 Function to link MK-1 user and Sender exists Bit0 = 1 Sender specification required (if set to 1, Bit6 is set to 0)
B121/B122/B123
5-48
SM
5846* 5846 1*
5846 2*
5846 3*
5846 4*
5846 5*
5846 6*
5846 7*
5846 8*
5846 50* 5846 51* 5846 52* 5846 80* 5846 90*
UCS Settings Machine ID (For Delivery Server) Displays ID Displays the unique device ID in use by the delivery server directory. The value is only displayed and cannot be changed. This ID is created from the NIC MAC or IEEE 1394 EUI. The ID is displayed as either 6-byle or 8-byte binary. Machine ID Clear (For Delivery Server) Clears ID Clears the unique ID of the device used as the name in the file transfer directory. Execute this SP if the connection of the device to the delivery server is unstable. After clearing the ID, the ID will be established again automatically by cycling the machine off and on. Maximum Entries [2000~50000/ 2000 /1] Changes the maximum number of entries that UCS can handle. If a value smaller than the present value is set, the UCS managed data is cleared, and the data (excluding user code information) is displayed. Delivery Server Model 0: Not used, 1:SG1 Provided, 2: SG1 Package, 3: SG2 Provided 4: SG2 Package Changes the model of the transfer server registered for the I/O device. Delivery Server Capability Bit 7 = 1 Comment information Bit 6 = 1 Address direct entry possible Bit 5 = 1 Mail Rx confirmation possible Bit 4 = 1 Address book auto update Bit 3 = 1 Fax Rx function [0~255 / 0 / 2] Changes the capability of the server registered for the I/O device. Delivery Server Retry Timer [0~255/ 0 /1] Sets the interval for retry attempts when the delivery server fails to acquire the delivery server address book. Delivery Server Retry Times [0~255/ 0 /1] Sets the number of retry attempts when the delivery server fails to acquire the delivery server address book. Delivery Server Maximum Entries [2000~50000 / 2000 / 1] Sets the maximum number account entries of the delivery server user information managed by UCS. Initialize All Directory Info. Clears all directory information managed by UCS, including all user codes. Upload All Directory Info. Uploads all directory information to the IC card. Download All Directory Info. Downloads all directory information from the IC card. Backup FCU Backs up all directory information to the FCU ROM. Plain Data Forbidden Allows you to prevent the address from plain data. This is a security function that prevents unauthorized access to address book data. 0: No check. Address book data not protected. 1: Check. Allows operation of UCS without data from SC card and without creating address book information with plain data. Bit SW Sets UCS debug output. DFU
SM
5-49
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
5848 1*
DFU DFU
Remote ROM Update [0 = Not allowed / 1 = Allowed] When set to 1 allows reception of firmware data via the local port (IEEE 1284) during a remote ROM update. This setting is reset to zero after the machine is cycled off and on.
5857* 5857 1*
5857 6 5857 12
5857 13 5857 14
5857 15
Debug Log Save Function On/Off (1:ON 0:OFF) 0: ON, 1: OFF Switches the debug log feature on and off. The debug log cannot be captured until this feature is switched on. Save to SD Card Specifies the decimal key number of the log to be written to the SD Card. Erase Debug Data From SD Card Erases all debug logs on the SD Card. If the card contains only debugging files generated by an event specified by SP5858, the files are erased when SP5857 010 or 011 is executed. To enable this SP, the machine must be cycled off and on. SD Card Space Available Displays the amount of space available on the SD card. SD to SD Latest Copies the latest 4 -MB logs to the SD card. The logs are written under the /log directory (this SP does not copy data from the SD card in one slot to the SD card in the other slot). The SP gives a unique name to the file newly saved file. You can save multiple logs from multiple machines in one SD card. SD to SD Any Copies the specified log to the SD card. The logs are written under the /log directory (this SP does not copy data from the SD card in one slot to the SD card in the other slot). This SP copies 4-MB data at the maximum, and gives a unique name to the newly saved file. You can save multiple logs from multiple machines in one SD card.
B121/B122/B123
5-50
SM
5857 17 Make SD Debug File Makes a 4-MB file on the SD to save logs. The file stores the contents of key number 2225 of SCS (for example, the information of NV usage in SCS). A file is made in the SD when the first log is saved in the SD even if you do not execute this SP. This processing, however, takes a long time; the user may turn the main switch off and on before completion (the user see no message that indicates the completion of the logging when logs are made on the occurrence of an event). The logging takes a shorter time if you have made a log file beforehand. If you try to make a log file on the SD where another log file has been already made, the contents of key number 2225 is added to the log file in the SD card. In a case like this, a new log file is not made. To make a new log file to supersede an old log file, you must execute SP5-857-012 before executing this SP.
5858*
5858 1* 5858 2* 5858 3* 5858 4* 5859* 5859 1* 5859 2* 5859 3* 5859 4* 5859 5* 5859 6* 5859 7* 5859 8* 5859 9* 5859 10* 5860* 5860 20*
Debug Save When These SPs select the content of the debugging information to be saved to the destination selected by SP5857 002. SP5858 3 stores one SC specified by number. Refer to Section 4 for a list of SC error codes. Engine SC Error Stores SC codes generated by copier engine errors. Controller SC Error Stores SC codes generated by GW controller errors. Any SC Error [0~65535 / 0 / 1] Jam Stores jam errors. Debug Log Save Function [-9999999~9999999 / 0 / 1] Key 1 These SPs allow you to set up to 10 keys for log files for functions that use common memory on the controller Key 2 board. Key 3 Key 4 Key 5 Key 6 Key 7 Key 8 Key 9 Key 10 SMTP/POP3/IMAP4 Partial Mail Receive Timeout [1~168 / 72 / 1] Sets the amount of time to wait before saving a mail that breaks up during reception. The received mail is discarded if the remaining portion of the mail is not received during this prescribed time. MDN Response RFC2298 Compliance [0 = No / 1 = Yes] Determines whether RFC2298 compliance is switched on for MDN reply mail. SMTP Auth. From Field Replacement [0 = No / 1 = Yes] Determines whether the FROM item of the mail header is switched to the validated account after the SMTP server is validated.
5869 5869 1
SM
5-51
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
5870 5870 1
SSP 5870 3
Common Key Info Common Key Info Writing Writes to flash ROM the common proof for validating the device for NRS specifications. Common Key Info Initialize Initializes the area for the key information.
SD Card Application SD Card Application Transport Transports the application programs. SD Card Application Transport Redo Nullifies the processing of SP5-873-1.
5902 5902 1
5907* 5907 1
Plug & Play Setting Selects the brand name and production name for the Plug and Play function. These names are registered in the NVRAM. If the NVRAM becomes defective, these names should be re-registered. Use the right-arrow or left-arrow key to scroll through the list of brand names. To select a brand name, press the OK key. An asterisk (*) indicates which manufacture is currently selected. ! 5.1.7 Switchover Permission Time [3~30 / 3 / 1 s] Sets the amount of time to elapse while the machine is in standby mode (and the operation panel keys have not been used) before another application can gain control of the display. Application Counter Display [0 = Off / 1 = On] Printer Counter Selects whether or not these total counters are displayed in the UP mode. Copy Counter
5913 5913 2
5918* 5918 1
A3/DLT Counter Display [0 = Off / 1 = On] Sets the key press display for the counter key. This setting has no relation to (SSP) SP5-104 A3/DLT Double Count.
[0 = Off / 1 = On]
Determines whether the debug information is output by the serial port when the machine is powered on.
5974* 5674 1
ScanRouter Server 0: Lite, 1: Full Switches writing between the Scan Router Lite application provided and the optional full (Professional) version.
B121/B122/B123
5-52
SM
5990 5990 1 5990 2 5990 3 5990 4 5990 5 5990 6 5990 7 5990 21 5990 22 5990 23
SMC Print All (Data List) SP (Mode Data List) User Program Logging Data Diagnostic Report Non-Default NIB Summary Copier User Program Scanner SP Scanner User Program
! 5.1.15
5998 5998 1
SM
5-53
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
SP6-XXX (Peripherals)
6006 6006 1 ADF Adjustment (! 3.13.3) NOTE: Available menus depend on the machine model and its configuration. ADF Adjustment (StoS/Front Regist) [5.0 ~ +5.0 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step] Adjusts the side-to-side registration for the front side of the original, for ADF mode. Use the # key to select + or before entering the value ADF Adjustment (Leading Regist) [5.0 ~ +5.0 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step] Adjusts the leading edge registration for ADF mode. Use the # key to select + or before entering the value. ADF Adjustment (Trailing Erase) [3.0 ~ +3.0 / 1.0 / 0.1 mm/step] Adjusts the trailing edge erase margin for ADF mode. Use the # key to select + or before entering the value. ADF Adjustment (StoS/Rear Regist) [5.0 ~ +5.0 / 0.0 / 0.5 mm/step] Adjusts the side-to-side registration for the rear side of duplex originals, for ADF mode. Use the # key to select + or before entering the value. ADF Adjustment (Sub-scan Magnif) [0.9 ~ +0.9 / 0.0 / 0.1 %/step] Adjust the sub-scan magnification for the ADF. ADF Adjustment (Original Curl Adj) [0 = No / 1 = Yes] Enables or disables the skew adjustment for the reverse sides of originals. When you enable SP6-006-6, adjust the distance of the skew adjustment (SP6-006-7). ADF Adjustment (Skew Correction) [20 ~ +20 / 0 / 1 mm/step] Specifies the distance of the skew adjustment. SP6-006-7 is effective when you enable SP6-006-6 (ADF Adjustment [Original Curl Adj]).
6006 2
6006 3
6006 4
6006 5 6006 6
6006 7
6009 6009 1
ADF Free Run Performs an ADF free run. Press "ON" to start; press "OFF" to stop.
6010 6010 1
Stamp Position Adjustment [10 ~ +10 / 0 / 1 mm/step] Adjusts the stamp position in the sub-scan direction. for the fax mode.
6901 6901 1
Display ADFAPS Displays the status of the ADF original size sensors (! 5.1.17).
6910 6910 1
ADF Shading Time [0 ~ 60 / 10 / 1 s/step] Adjusts the interval used for the shading processing in the ADF mode. Light and heat in the room may affect the scanner response. Reduce this setting if copy quality indicates that the white level is drifting during ADF copy jobs.
B121/B122/B123
5-54
SM
7401* 7401 1
CounterSC Total [0 ~ 9999 / 0 / 1/step] Displays how many times SC codes are generated.
7403* 7403 1 7403 2 7403 3 7403 4 7403 5 7403 6 7403 7 7403 8 7403 9 7403 10
SC History Latest Latest 1 Latest 2 Latest 3 Latest 4 Latest 5 Latest 6 Latest 7 Latest 8 Latest 9
7502* 7502 1
CounterPaper Jam [0 ~ 9999 / 0 / 1/step] Displays the total number of copy paper jams.
7503* 7503 1
CounterOrgn Jam [0 ~ 9999 / 0 / 1/step] Displays the total number of original jams, Service Tables
7504*
Counter-Each P Jam Displays the total number of the paper [0 ~ 9999 / 0 / 1/step] jams classified by timing and location. Counter-Each P Jam (At power on) Paper jam occurs at power on. Counter-Each P Jam (Off-Regist NoFeed) Paper does not reach the registration sensor (from a paper tray). Counter-Each P Jam (Off-1 Vertical SN) Paper does not reach the relay sensor. Counter-Each P Jam (On-1 Vertical SN) Paper is caught at the relay sensor. Counter-Each P Jam (Off-2 Vertical SN) Paper does not reach the vertical transport sensor. Counter-Each P Jam (On-2 Vertical SN) Paper is caught at the vertical transport sensor. Counter Each P Jam (Off-3 Vertical SN) Paper does not reach the vertical transport sensor in the optional paper feed unit. Counter Each P Jam (On-3 Vertical SN) Paper is caught at the vertical transport sensor in the optional paper feed unit. Counter-Each P Jam (Off-Regist Bypass) Paper does not reach the registration sensor (from the by-pass tray).
SM
5-55
B121/B122/B123
7504 70 7504 120 7504 121 7504 122 7504 123 7504 125 7504 126 7504 127 7504 128 7504 129 7504 130 7504 131
7505*
7505 1 7505 210 7505 211 7505 212 7505 213 7505 214 7505 215
Counter-Each O Jam [0 ~ 9999 / 0 / 1/step] Displays the total number of the original jams on the ADF that have occurred at a certain timing or at a certain location. Counter-Each O Jam (at Power On) The original jam occurs during the standby mode. Counter-Each O Jam (Off-Regist SN) The original does not reach the registration sensor. Counter-Each O Jam (On-Regist SN) The original is caught at the registration sensor. Counter-Each O Jam (Off-Relay SN) The original does not reach the exit sensor. Counter-Each O Jam (On-Relay SN) The original is caught at the exit sensor. Counter-Each O Jam (Off-Inverter SN) The original does not reach the reverse sensor. Counter-Each O Jam (On Inverter SN) The original is caught at the reverse sensor.
B121/B122/B123
5-56
SM
7506*
7506 5 7506 6 7506 14 7506 38 7506 44 7506 132 7506 133 7506 134 7506 141 7506 142 7506 160 7506 164 7506 166 7506 172 7506 255
Counter-Each P Jam Displays the total number of the paper jams classified by the paper sizes. Counter-Each P Jam (A4 LEF) Counter-Each P Jam (A5 LEF) Counter-Each P Jam (B5 LEF) Counter-Each P Jam (LT LEF) Counter-Each P Jam (HLT LEF) Counter-Each P Jam (A3 SEF) Counter-Each P Jam (A4 SEF) Counter-Each P Jam (A5 SEF) Counter-Each P Jam (B4 SEF) Counter-Each P Jam (B5 SEF) Counter-Each P Jam (DLT SEF) Counter-Each P Jam (LG SEF) Counter-Each P Jam (LT SEF) Counter-Each P Jam (HLT SEF) Counter-Each P Jam (Other)
[0 ~ 9999 / 0 / 1/step]
7507* 7507 1
7508* 7508 1
Dsply-O Jam Hist Displays the total number of the original-jams history. The list below shows the possible seven codes: 210 211 212 213 214 215 The codes correspond to the menus of SP7-505. For example, the code 210 corresponds to SP7-505-210, and the code 211 corresponds to SP7-505-211.
Memory/Version/PN Memory/Version (ADF ROM) Displays the serial number and the version of the BICU and the serial number and version of the ADF software.
7803* 7803 1
SM
5-57
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
Dsply-P Jam Hist Displays the latest 10 paper-jam history. The list below shows the possible 22 codes: 1 10 11 12 21 22 31 32 50 60 70 120 121 122 123 125 126 127 128 129 130 131 The codes correspond to the menus of SP7-504. For example, the code 1 corresponds to SP7-504-1, and the code 10 corresponds to SP7-504-10.
7804 7804 1
ResetPM Counter Resets the PM counter (SP7-803-1). When the program ends normally, the message "Completed" is displayed.
7807 7807 1
ResetSC/Jam Counters Resets the SC, paper, original, and total jam counters. When the program ends normally, the message "Completed" is displayed. SP7-807-1 does not reset the following logs: SP7-507 (Display-Paper Jam History) and SP7-508 (Display-Original Jam History).
7808 7808 1
ResetCounters Resets all counters except for the management counters. The management counters are the counters that are not changed by NVRAM Download (SP5-825-1; ! NVRAM Download (SP5-825-1) in section 5.1.11). When the program ends normally, the message the message "Completed" is displayed.
7810 7810 1
ResetKey Op Code Resets the key operator code. Use SP7-810-1 when the customer has forgotten the key-operator code. When the program ends normally, the message "Completed" is displayed, if the program ends abnormally, an error message is displayed. If the customer forgets the key operator code. To specify a new key-operator code, use the User Tools: System Settings Key Operator Tools Key Operator Code On Enter Key Operator Code. MF Device Error Count MF Device Error Count Clear For Japan Only For Japan Only
7826* 7827
7832* 7832 1
Display-Self-Diag Displays the SC codes found during the self-diagnostics test, and the number of their occurrences. Each number is in the range of 0 to 9999.
7901*
Assert Info. DFU These SP numbers display the results of the occurrence of the most recent SC code generated by the machine. Source File Name Module name Line Number Number of lines Result Value
B121/B122/B123
5-58
SM
7991
DsplyInfo Count Displays the total operating time or the total number of operations. The time is displayed in the following format: day:hour:minute:second. DsplyInfo Count (Dsply-APS Working) The total of the time when the APS is working. Dsply-Info Count (Dsply-ID S Work) The total of the time when the ID sensor is working. Dsply-Info Count (Dsply-Dev Counter) The total number of paper outputs. Dsply-Info Count (Dsply-ID Er Count) The total number of ID-sensor errors.
7992 7992 5
ResetInfo Count Reset-Info Count (Reset-ID Er Count) Clears the counter of SP7-991-5.
SM
5-59
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
SP8-XXX (History)
8191* 8191 1 T: Total Scan PGS [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the total number of scanned originals. The both sides are counted when the front and reverse sides of an original (fed from the ADF) are scanned.
8192* 8192 1
C: Total Scan PGS [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the total number of scanned originals. The both sides are counted when the front and reverse sides of an original (fed from the ADF) are scanned.
8193* 8193 1
F: Total Scan PGS [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the total number of scanned originals. The both sides are counted when the front and reverse sides of an original (fed from the ADF) are scanned.
8195* 8195 1
S: Total Scan PGS [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the total number of scanned originals. The both sides are counted when the front and reverse sides of an original (fed from the ADF) are scanned.
8201* 8201 1
T: L Size Scan PGS [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the total number of scanned originals (by copying jobs and scanning jobs) classified by paper size. The following size is counted: A3/DLT and larger.
8205* 8205 1
S: L Size Scan PGS (A3/DLT, Larger) [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the total number of scanned originals (by scanning jobs) classified by paper size. The following size is counted: A3/DLT and larger.
ADF Org Feed [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] ADF Org Feed (Front) Displays the total number of scanned front sides of originals fed from the ADF. ADF Org Feed (Back) Displays the total number of scanned reverse sides of originals fed from the ADF.
8291* 8291 1
T: Scan PGS/TWAIN [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the total number of sheets stamped by the ADF in fax jobs and scanning jobs.
8293* 8293 1
F: Scan PGS/TWAIN [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the total number of sheets stamped by the ADF in fax jobs.
8295* 8295 1
S: Scan PGS/TWAIN [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the total number of sheets stamped by the ADF in scanning jobs.
B121/B122/B123
5-60
SM
8301* 8301 1 8301 2 8301 3 8301 4 8301 5 8301 6 8301 7 8301 8 8301 9 8301 10 8301 254 8301 255
T: Scan PGS/Size [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the total number of pages scanned by all application programs. A3 A4 A5 B4 B5 DLT LG LT HLT Full Bleed Other (Standard) Other (Custom)
8302* 8302 1 8302 2 8302 3 8302 4 8302 5 8302 6 8302 7 8302 8 8302 9 8301 10 8302 254 8302 255
CounterPaper Size [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the total number of pages scanned by the copier application program. A3 A4 A5 B4 B5 DLT LG LT HLT Full Bleed Other (standard size) Other (custom size)
8303* 8303 1 8303 2 8303 3 8303 4 8303 5 8303 6 8303 7 8303 8 8303 9 8301 10 8303 254 8303 255
T: Scan PGS/Size [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the total number of pages scanned by the fax application program. A3 A4 A5 B4 B5 DLT LG LT HLT Full Bleed Other (Standard) Other (Custom)
SM
5-61
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
8305* 8305 1 8305 2 8305 3 8305 4 8305 5 8305 6 8305 7 8305 8 8305 9 8301 10 8305 254 8305 255
T: Scan PGS/Size [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the total number of pages scanned by all application programs. A3 A4 A5 B4 B5 DLT LG LT HLT Full Bleed Other (Standard) Other (Custom)
8381* 8381 1
T: Total Prt PGS [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the print count of all application programs.
8382* 8382 1
C: Total Prt PGS [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the print count of the copier application program.
8383* 8383 1
F: Total Prt PGS [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the print count of the fax application program.
8384* 8384 1
P: Total Prt PGS [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the print count of the printer application program.
8385* 8385 1
S: Total Prt PGS [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the print count of the scanner application program.
8387* 8387 1
O: Total Prt PGS [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the print count of application programs other than copier, fax, printer, or scanner programs (such as external application programs).
8391* 8391 1
L size Prt PGS (A3/DLT, Larger) [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the print count of the AS/DLT size and larger paper.
8411* 8411 1
Prints/Duplex [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the total count of the duplex printing.
B121/B122/B123
5-62
SM
8421*
8421 1 8421 2 8421 3 8421 4 8421 5 8421 6 8421 7 8421 8 8421 9 8421 10 8421 11 8421 12 8421 13
T: PrtPGS/Dup Comb [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the total number of pages processed for printing. This is the total for all application programs. Simplex > Duplex Duplex > Duplex Book > Duplex Simplex Combine Duplex Combine 2> 4> 6> 8> 9> 16 > Booklet Magazine
8422*
8422 1 8422 2 8422 3 8422 4 8422 5 8422 6 8422 7 8422 8 8422 9 8422 10 8422 11 8422 12 8422 13
C: PrtPGS/Dup Comb [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the total number of pages processed for printing by the copier application program. Simplex > Duplex Duplex > Duplex Book > Duplex Simplex Combine Duplex Combine 2> 4> 6> 8> 9> 16 > Booklet Magazine
8423*
8423 1 8423 2 8423 3 8423 4 8423 5 8423 6 8423 7 8423 8 8423 9 8423 10 8423 11
F: PrtPGS/Dup Comb [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the total number of pages processed for printing by the fax application program. Simplex > Duplex Duplex > Duplex Book > Duplex Simplex Combine Duplex Combine 2> 4> 6> 8> 9> 16 >
SM
5-63
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
8424*
8424 1 8424 2 8424 3 8424 4 8424 5 8424 6 8424 7 8424 8 8424 9 8424 10 8424 11 8424 12 8424 13
P: PrtPGS/Dup Comb [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the total number of pages processed for printing by the printer application program. Simplex > Duplex Duplex > Duplex Book > Duplex Simplex Combine Duplex Combine 2> 4> 6> 8> 9> 16 > Booklet Magazine
8425*
8425 1 8425 2 8425 3 8425 4 8425 5 8425 6 8425 7 8425 8 8425 9 8425 10 8425 11 8525 12 8426 13
S: PrtPGS/Dup Comb [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the total number of pages processed for printing by the scanner application program. Simplex > Duplex Duplex > Duplex Book > Duplex Simplex Combine Duplex Combine 2> 4> 6> 8> 9> 16 > Booklet Magazine
8427*
O: PrtPGS/Dup Comb [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the total number of pages processed for printing by other application programs. Simplex > Duplex Duplex > Duplex Book > Duplex Simplex Combine Duplex Combine 2> 4> 6> 8>
B121/B122/B123
5-64
SM
8441*
8441 1 8441 2 8441 3 8441 4 8441 5 8441 6 8441 7 8441 8 8441 9 8441 10 8441 254 8441 255
T: PrtPGS/Ppr Size [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the total print count classified by paper size. This is the total for all application programs. T: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (A3) T: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (A4) T: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (A5) T: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (B4) T: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (B5) T: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (DLT) T: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (LG) T: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (LT) T: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (HLT) T: PrtPGS/Ppr SIze (Full Bleed) T: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (Other (Standard)) T: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (Other (Custom))
8442* 8442 1 8442 2 8442 3 8442 4 8442 5 8442 6 8442 7 8442 8 8442 9 8442 10 8442 254 8442 255
C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the number of pages printed by the copier application program. C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (A3) C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (A4) C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (A5) C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (B4) C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (B5) C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (DLT) C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (LG) C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (LT) C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (HLT) C: PrtPGS/Ppr SIze (Full Bleed) C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (Other (Standard)) C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (Other (Custom))
8443* 8443 1 8443 2 8443 3 8443 4 8443 5 8443 6 8443 7 8443 8 8443 9 8443 10 8443 254 SM
F: PrtPGS/Ppr Size [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the number of pages printed by the fax application program. F: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (A3) F: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (A4) F: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (A5) F: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (B4) F: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (B5) F: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (DLT) F: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (LG) F: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (LT) F: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (HLT) F: PrtPGS/Ppr SIze (Full Bleed) F: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (Other (Standard)) 5-65 B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
8444* 8444 1 8444 2 8444 3 8444 4 8444 5 8444 6 8444 7 8444 8 8444 9 8444 10 8444 254 8444 255
P: PrtPGS/Ppr Size [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the number of pages printed by the printer application program. P: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (A3) P: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (A4) P: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (A5) P: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (B4) P: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (B5) P: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (DLT) P: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (LG) P: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (LT) P: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (HLT) P: PrtPGS/Ppr SIze (Full Bleed) P: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (Other (Standard)) P: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (Other (Custom))
8445* 8445 1 8445 2 8445 3 8445 4 8445 5 8445 6 8445 7 8445 8 8445 9 8445 10 8445 254 8445 255
S: PrtPGS/Ppr Size [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the number of pages printed by the scanner application program. S: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (A3) S: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (A4) S: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (A5) S: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (B4) S: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (B5) S: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (DLT) S: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (LG) S: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (LT) S: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (HLT) S: PrtPGS/Ppr SIze (Full Bleed) S: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (Other (Standard)) S: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (Other (Custom))
8447* 8447 1 8447 2 8447 3 8447 4 8447 5 8447 6 8447 7 8447 8 8447 9 8447 10 8447 254 8447 255
O: PrtPGS/Ppr Size [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the number of pages printed by the scanner application program. O: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (A3) O: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (A4) O: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (A5) O: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (B4) O: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (B5) O: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (DLT) O: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (LG) O: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (LT) O: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (HLT) O: PrtPGS/Ppr SIze (Full Bleed) O: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (Other (Standard)) O: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (Other (Custom))
B121/B122/B123
5-66
SM
C: PrtPGS/Ppr Tray [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the total print count classified by paper source. C: PrtPGS/Ppr Tray (Bypass Tray) C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (Tray 1) C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (Tray 2) C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (Tray 3) C: PrtPGS/Ppr Size (Tray 4)
8461*
T: PrtPGS/Ppr Type [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the total print count classified by paper size. This is the total for all application programs. Normal Recycled Special Thick Normal (Back) Thick (Back) OHP Other
C: PrtPGS/Ppr Type [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the total number of pages printed by the copier application program. Normal Recycled Special Thick Normal (Back) Thick (Back) OHP Other
F: PrtPGS/Ppr Type [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the total number of pages printed by the fax application program. Normal Recycled Special Thick Normal (Back) Thick (Back) OHP Other
P: PrtPGS/Ppr Type [0 9999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step] Displays the total number of pages printed by the fax application program. Normal Recycled
SM
5-67
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
8521*
T:PrtPGS/FIN [0~9999999/ 0 / 1] These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by all applications. Sort Stack Staple Booklet Z-Fold Punch Other C:PrtPGS/FIN [0~9999999/ 0 / 1] These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Copy application. Sort Stack Staple Booklet Z-Fold Punch Other F:PrtPGS/FIN [0~9999999/ 0 / 1] These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Fax application. Note: Print finishing options for received faxes are currently not available. Sort Stack Staple Booklet Z-Fold Punch Other P:PrtPGS/FIN [0~9999999/ 0 / 1] These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Print application. Sort Stack
8524 1 8524 2
B121/B122/B123
5-68
SM
8801 8801 1
8941*
SM
Service Tables
B121/B122/B123
5-70
SM
SP9-XXX (Etc.)
9801* 9801 1 DCS Debug Common Specifies the DCS debug output format. bit 0: Time (Time is added on each line of logs) bit 1: Millisecond (Millisecond is added to time.) bit 2: Colored (Text and background is colored.) bit 3: Return code (The return code is added at line ends.) bit 4: Indentation (Text data is indented.) bit 5: Not used bit 6: Not used bit 7: Not used IFC Specifies the DCS IFC module debug output. bit 0: Client event transfer log bit 1: UCS event transfer log bit 2: DCS internal event (inter-module event in DCS) transfer log bit 3: Parameter data bit 4: Process flow log bit 5: Detailed process flow log bit 6: Not used bit 7: Not used SMM Specifies the DCS SMM module debug output. bit 0: SCS event transfer log bit 1: DCS internal event (inter-module event in DCS) transfer log bit 2: Parameter data bit 3: Process flow log bit 4: Detailed process flow log bit 5: SP read-/write-related event transfer log bit 6 SP read-/write-related event parameter log bit 7: Not used SJM/RJM Specifies the DCS SJM/RJM module debug output. bit 0: SJM: IFC/DSS event transfer log bit 1: SJM: Parameter data bit 2: SJM: Process flow log bit 3: SJM: Detailed process flow log bit 4: SJM: MCS event (RPC) log bit 5: RJM: Event transfer log bit 6: RJM: Parameter data bit 7: RJM: Process flow check DSS Specifies the DCS DSS module debug output. bit 0: DCS internal event (inter-module event in DCS) transfer log bit 1: MCS/NAS (internal module) event log bit 2: Parameter data bit 3: Time check bit 4: Process flow check log bit 5: Error check bit 6: Initial values bit 7: Temporary check
9801 2
9801 3
9801 4
9801 5
SM
5-71
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
9801 7
NAS
B121/B122/B123
5-72
SM
End
B121S907.WMF
SM
5-73
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
B121/B122/B123
5-74
SM
W1 W2
B121S919.WMF
Example 1 indicates that the paper size and its orientation is "81/2 x 13 SEF," and that the document feeder (or platen cover) is open. Example 2 indicates that the paper size and its orientation is "A4 LEF," and that the document feeder (or platen cover) is closed. The "Paper Size" data starts with eight digits. The first digit indicates the output of L2; the second digit, L1; the third digit, W2; and the fourth digit, W1. The other four digits (from the fifth through the eighth) are always "0000." In Example 1, the APS sensors L2 and L1 detect paper (W2 and W1 do not). In Example 2, APS sensors W2 and W1 detect paper (L2 and L1 do not). The paper size and its orientation is based on the outputs of these four APS sensors. The "DF Open" data shows "1" or "0," indicating if the document feeder (or platen cover) is open or closed respectively. The data is based on the output of the platen cover sensor [A]. [A]
Service Tables
B121S920.WMF
SM
5-75
B121/B122/B123
MFP
Exceptions SP5-801-002 (basic machine) and SP5-998-001 (MFP machine) clears most of the settings and counters stored in the NVRAM on the BICU (the values return to their default values). However, the following settings are not cleared:
SP5-807 (Area Selection) SP5-811-001 (Serial Num Input [Code Set]) SP5-811-003 (Serial Num Input [ID2 Code Display]) SP5-812-001 (Service TEL [Telephone]) SP5-812-002 (Service TEL [Facsimile]) SP5-907 (Plug & Play) SP7 (Data Log) SP8 (History)
Use SP5-802-002 (basic machine) or SP5-998-001 (MFP machine) after you have replaced the BICU NVRAM or when the BICU NVRAM data is corrupted. When the program ends normally, the message "Completed" is displayed. When you have replaced the controller NVRAM or when the controller NVRAM data is corrupted, use SP5-801-001. The message is the same as the basic machine.
B121/B122/B123
5-76
SM
SM
5-77
B121/B122/B123
Not at upper limit Not installed Not at upper limit Not locked Not locked Not locked Not installed Not installed Not detected Not detected Not detected Not detected SM
B121/B122/B123
*1 Paper Size Copier Europe North America China Paper Feed Unit Europe North America China By-Pass Tray Europe North America China 00 Not set Not set Not set 00 Not set Not set Not set 04 A5 SEF HLT SEF B6 SEF 01 A4 LEF A4 LEF A4 LEF 01 LT SEF LT SEF LT SEF 0C A5 SEF HLT SEF B6 SEF 02 8Hx13 SEF 8Hx13 SEF B5 LEF 03 LG SEF LG SEF LG SEF 08 A5 SEF HLT SEF A5 SEF 03 A4 SEF LT SEF A4 SEF 04 A4 LEF A4 LEF A4 LEF 00 A5 SEF HLT SEF A5 SEF 04 A5 LEF LG SEF A5 LEF 05 01 8x13 SEF HLT SEF B5 SEF 05 LT LEF LT LEF B4 SEF 0A DLT SEF DLT SEF DLT SEF 03 A4 SEF LG SEF A4 SEF 06 0C A4 SEF A4 SEF A4 SEF 02 A3 SEF DLT SEF B4 SEF 07 A3 SEF DLT SEF A3 SEF 0E LT LEF LT LEF LT LEF 06 A3 SEF DLT SEF A3 SEF 0F A3 SEF A3 SEF A3 SEF
*2 Paper Amount 10 11 00 00 Near end About 25% About 75% About 100%
*3 Available Paper Feed Unit 00 20 30 None 2-tray paper feed unit 1-tray paper feed unit
SM
5-79
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
B121/B122/B123
5-80
SM
You can specify a digit ("0" to "9") or a capital letter ("A" to "Z") for the first four characters of a serial number, and you can specify a digit in the other seven characters (not capital letters). MFP MACHINE You use the numeric keypad to type numbers. In addition, you use the optional operation panel to type other characters. When you press the "ABC" key, the letter changes as follows: A B C. To input the same letter two times, for example "AA," you press the "ABC" key, the "Space" key, and the "ABC" key. To switch between uppercase letters and lowercase letters, press the "Shift" key.
SM
5-81
B121/B122/B123
!CAUTION
Make sure that you turn off the main switch before inserting or removing a flash memory card. Installing or removing a flash memory card while the main switch is on may damage the BiCU or memory.
Overview You can copy the data from the NVRAM to a flash memory card (NVRAM Upload), or from a flash memory card to the NVRAM (NVRAM download).
From the BICU to a flash memory card From a flash memory card to the BICU
You should execute NVRAM Upload before replacing the NVRAM or before executing SP5-801-2 (Memory Clear [Engine]; ! 5.1.7). You can copy back the data from the flash card to the NVRAM as necessary.
[B]
B121S901.WMF
B121/B122/B123
5-82
SM
1. Turn off the main switch. 2. Remove the card cover [B] (1 rivet). 3. Turn the face of the flash memory card [A] ("A" is printed on it) toward your lefthand side,and insert it into the card slot. 4. Turn on the main switch. 5. Start the SP mode and select SP5-825-001. 6. The machine erases the current settings, then writes the new settings onto the NVRAM on the BiCU board. This takes about 1 second. If downloading fails, an error message appears. If an error message appears, retry the download procedure. 7. Turn off the main switch.
Service Tables 5-83 B121/B122/B123
SM
[A]
B121S901.WMF
4. Press down the power switch on the operation panel and hold it, and turn on the main switch (on the front cover). 5. Select "Execute" [C].
Execute
[C]
B121S902.WMF
6. Do not touch any key while the message "Load Status..." is displayed. This message indicates that the program is running. 7. Check that the message "End Sum..." is displayed. This message indicates that the program has ended normally. 8. Turn off the main switch (on the front cover). 9. Remove the flash memory card. 10. Install the card cover. 11. Turn the main switch on. 12. Check the operation.
B121S903.WMF
B121S904.WMF
B121/B122/B123
5-84
SM
Test Patterns
No. 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 Test Patterns Using VCU Pattern (No print) Vertical Lines (Single Dot) Horizontal Lines (Single Dot) Vertical Lines (Double Dot) Horizontal Lines (Double Dot) Grid Pattern (Single Dot) Grid Pattern (Double Dot) Alternating Dot Pattern Isolated one dot Black Band (Horizontal) Trimming Area Argyle Pattern (Single Dot) Grayscales (Horizontal) Grayscales (Vertical) Grayscales (Vertical/Horizontal) Grayscales (Vertical/Horizontal Overlay) Grayscales With White Lines (Horizontal) Grayscales with White Lines (Vertical) Grayscales with White Lines (Vertical/Horizontal) No. 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 Test Patterns Using IPU Pattern Vertical Lines (Single Dot) Horizontal Lines (Single Dot) Vertical Lines (Double Dot) Horizontal Lines (Double Dot) Isolated Four Dots Grid Pattern (Double Dot) Black Band (Vertical, 1024 Dots) Grayscales (Horizontal, 512 Dots) Grayscales (Vertical, 256 Dots) ID Patch Cross Argyle Pattern (128-Dot Pitch) Square Gradation (64 Grades) Square Gradation (256 Grades) Grayscales (Horizontal, 32-Dot Width) Grayscales (Vertical, 32-Dot Width) Trimming Area (A3) A4 Gradation Patches 1 (128 Grades) A4 Gradation Patches 2 (128 Grades) Trimming Area (A4)
No. 51 52 53
Test Patterns Using SBU Pattern Grid Pattern (double dot) Gray scale 1 (256 grades) Gray scale 2 (256 grades)
SM
5-85
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
B121/B122/B123
5-86
SM
SM
5-87
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
B121/B122/B123
5-88
SM
Rev. 04/2004
Reading Data
W1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1: Detected W2 0 0 1 1 1 0 0 1 1 L1 0 1 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 L2 0 1 0 0 1 0 1 0 0 Paper Size NA 11" x 17" 81/2" x 51/2" LEF 81/2" x 11" SEF 81/2" x 14" 11" x 81/2" LEF 11" x 17" 51/2" X 81/2" SEF
B121S921.WMF
Digit Position Jan. = 01, Feb. =02, etc. 7 Month: 01 through 12 6 5 Week of the Month: 1 through 5 1st week =1, 2nd week =2, 3rd week = 3, etc. Sun.= 0, Mon. = 1, Tue. = 2, etc. 4 Day of the Week: 0 through 7 00 = Midnight, 01 = 1 AM, 02 = 2 AM through 3 Hours: 23 = 11 PM 2 1 Start and Stop 1hour 0 minutes For SP5307-3, this must always be 10. For SP5307-4, this value must always be 00. 0 Example- April 4, 2004 DST is turned ON and October 31, 2004 DST is turned OFF: 04/04 2:00 AM DST is turned ON- 4100210 (7digits) There is no leading 0. See 2-1 below. 1- SP5-307-001: Change 0(=OFF) to 1(=ON) 2- SP5-307-003(Summer time start): 2-1. Enter 04 as month of April. (4 will be displayed. The leading 0 will not be displayed.) 2-2. Enter 1 (=1st week) and 0 (=Sunday) 2-3. Enter 02 (=2:00 AM) 2-4. Enter 10 (=1 hour 0 minute) 3- SP5-307-004(Summer time end): 10/31 2:00 AM DST is turned OFF: 10500200 (8 digits) 3-1. Enter 10 as month of October. (10 will be entered.) 3-2. Enter 5 (=5th) and 0 (=Sunday) 3-3. Enter 02 (=2:00 AM) 3-4. Enter 00. Remember to turn the main switch OFF and ON when the message is displayed.
SM
5-89
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
5.1.18
Rev. 08/2004
5.2
This section (5.2) illustrates how to update the firmware of the MFP machine (the machine with the optional controller box). To update the firmware of the BICU see section 5.1.12. To update the firmware for the MFP machine, you must have the new version of the firmware downloaded onto an SD (Secure Digital) Card. The SD Card is inserted into the lower slot on the right side of the controller box, viewed from the back of the machine.
B121/B122/B123
5-90
SM
Rev. 08/2004
The following is the revised procedure for firmware updates on the MFP model using an SD card. Important: This procedure is only for firmware files with the .fwu suffix (for the MFP model), and cannot be used for firmware files with a .bin suffix, which are only updated on the Basic model via an IC (Flash Memory) card.
1. You do not have to initialize your SD card as long as the format of the SD card is not corrupted. Your SD card is already formatted when you get it from Ricoh Family Group. 2. Create a romdata folder on the card. 3. Create the following folders within the romdata folder: B121, B620, B622, B658, B681, B685 4. Download the firmware from the website and store the files in the folder with the corresponding model code on the SD card. Example: File B1215540B should be stored in the B121 folder, whereas files B6585902B, B6585903B, and B6585905B should be stored in the B658 folder. Note: It is strongly recommended to store only B121/B122/B123 files on SD cards used for downloading to the B121/B122/B123. With the controller used on this model, firmware update may sometimes be interrupted if there is software for multiple models stored on the same SD card. Rom Data B121 B1215540E.fww
SM
5-91
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
Rev. 08/2004
[B]
To remove the SD, push it in to unlock the spring lock and then release it so it pops out of the slot. [D]
[A] [C]
B121S915.WMF
5. Disconnect the network cable or wireless option from the copier if it is connected. 6. Disconnect the Fax cable from the copier if it is connected. 7. Switch the main power switch on.
After about 5 seconds, the LCD will display Please wait Then, about 60 seconds later, the LCD will display Program Update Menu P.01 on the first line and the name of the firmware on the second line (e.g. System/Copy). The following are the display names for each type of firmware. Firmware Name BICU FCU ServiceCardCopyEXP ServiceCardNetFile ServiceCardNIB ServiceCardFAX ServiceCardWebSystem Scanner Printer SecurityModule_NRS LCD Display Name Engine GWFCU3-1 (WW)-1 System/Copy Network DocBox Network Support Fax Web Support SD#1 Scanner SD#1 Printer Security Module
NOTE:
B121/B122/B123
5-92
SM
Rev. 08/2004
8.
B121S917.WMF
B121S917.WMF
To view the firmware version, press the key. "ROM" is the information on the current firmware. "NEW" is the information on the firmware in the SD card.
B121S917.WMF
B121S917.WMF
To select the module, press the OK key. To quit the firmware-update program, press the F3 key. To cancel the selection, press the key. To scroll through the module name, the serial number, and the version, press the key or key.
SM
5-93
B121/B122/B123
Rev. 08/2004
9.
When you have selected a module, the text lines are highlighted, and the "Verify" key and the "Update" key are displayed. Use the up and down scroll keys to scroll to the firmware you wish to install. If you wish to install the following firmware simultaneously, press the START key.
The scroll keys can be used to confirm that the firmware has been selected and highlighted with a dark background. Engine, FCU, Scanner, Printer, Security Module, , Printer Font Please note that the following firmware cannot be updated simultaneously. The update procedure must be repeated for each item individually. System/Copy, ServiceCardNetFile, ServiceCardNIB, ServiceCardFAX 10. Press the OK key. Verify, Update and Exit will be displayed at the bottom of the LCD, and the firmware to be updated will be highlighted (dark background). 11. Press the Update key. The update will be begin, which will take a few minutes to complete. The LCD will initially display, Updating ***---------. 12. When the update is completed, the LCD display will change to Update done or Updated / Power Off On. 13. Repeat Steps 1-8 above until all firmware updates are complete. 14. Turn the main power switch off. 15. Remove the SD card from the lower slot on the controller by pushing on the card to release the spring lock. 16. Reinstall the network and Fax connections. 17. If an error occurs, the error code is displayed. For the information on the error codes, see the table on next page.
B121/B122/B123
5-94
SM
Rev. 08/2004
Code E20 E22 E23 E24 E31 E32 E33 E34 E35 E36 E40 E42 E44
Cause Physical address mapping error Decompression error Update program error SD card access error Download data inconsistency* Download data inconsistency* Version data error Locale data error Machine model data error Module data error Engine program error** Operation panel program error* Controller program error* Authentication error
E50
Necessary Action Insert the SD card correctly. Use another SD card Store correct data in the SD card. Update controller program. Replace the controller. Insert the SD card correctly. Use another SD card. Insert the SD card that is used when the previous update procedure is interrupted. Insert the SD card that stores the correct data. Store the correct data in the SD card. Store the correct data in the SD card. Store the correct data in the SD card. Store the correct data in the SD card. Store the correct data in the SD card. Replace BICU. Store the correct data in the SD card. Replace the operation panel board. Store the correct data in the SD card. Replace the controller board. Store the correct data in the SD card.
* You need to reinstall the program. Try pressing the 1, 4, 3, keys on the operation panel when the error appears then press the clear key three times. If the firmware update program is interrupted, for example, by power failure, keep the SD card inserted and turn the main switch off and on. The firmware update program restarts. If you do not do so, the message "Reboot after Card insert" is displayed when you turn the main switch on.
NOTE: As mentioned above, it is possible to confirm which firmware version is presently installed in the machine by accessing SP7-801-255 or printing out SP 5-990-005.If the Please Wait display does not change over to Program Update Menu P.01, it is possible the firmware has not been saved to the card correctly (e.g. files saved to the wrong folder). Please refer to Step 1 (SD card preparation) to verify if the firmware was saved to the card correctly Service Tables
SM
5-95
B121/B122/B123
Rev. 08/2004
DETAILED DESCRIPTIONS
OVERVIEW
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25
Detailed Descriptions
40 39 38 37 36 35
26 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27
B121D904.WMF
NOTE: The above illustration is the B123 model. B121: No duplex unit, one paper tray B122: No duplex unit, two paper trays
SM
6-1
B121/B122/B123
OVERVIEW
1. 2nd Mirror 2. Exposure Lamp 3. 1st Mirror 4. Exposure Glass 5. Original Width Sensors 6. Original Length Sensors 7. Lens Block 8. SBU 9. Exit Sensor 10. Scanner Motor 11. Inverter Roller 12. Duplex Inverter Sensor 13. Duplex Entrance Sensor 14. Hot Roller 15. Upper Transport Roller 16. Pressure Roller 17. OPC Drum 18. Middle Transport Roller 19. Duplex Exit Sensor 20. Image Density Sensor
21. Registration Roller 22. Registration Sensor 23. By-pass Tray 24. Lower Transport Roller 25. Upper Relay Roller 26. Relay Sensor 27. Lower Relay Roller 28. Vertical Transport Sensor 29. Paper Feed Roller 30. Paper End Sensor 31. Bottom Plate 32. PCU 33. Development Roller 34. WTL 35. Polygon Mirror Motor 36. Laser Unit 37. Toner Supply Bottle Holder 38. Exit Roller 39. 3rd Mirror 40. Scanner H.P. Sensor
B121/B122/B123
6-2
SM
OVERVIEW
B121D924.WMF
The B123 model has a duplex unit mounted on the right side of the machine. All models have a by-pass tray.
SM
6-3
B121/B122/B123
Detailed Descriptions
OVERVIEW
B121D925.WMF
2 3
10 9 8 7 6
B121D926.WMF
1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
Scanner Motor Main Motor Hot Roller OPC Drum Development Roller
6. Relay Clutch 7. Lower Paper Feed Clutch 8. By-pass Feed Clutch 9. Upper Paper Feed Clutch 10. Registration Clutch
B121/B122/B123
6-4
SM
BOARD STRUCTURE
SBU Thermistor
Operation Panel
BICU
ADF/ ARDF Motors
Clutches
Polygon Motor
One-Bin Tray
Lamp Stabilizer
Sensors
: Standard : Option
Xenon Lamp
B121D905.WMF
NOTE: 1) Only B123 models contain the duplex unit. 2) The one-bin tray is for B122/B123 with the optional controller box.
SM
6-5
B121/B122/B123
Detailed Descriptions
BOARD STRUCTURE
B121/B122/B123
6-6
SM
B121D907.WMF
7 8 9 2 6
3 4
B121D927.WMF
1. EXPOSURE A xenon lamp exposes the original. Light reflected from the original passes to the CCD, where it is converted into an analog data signal. This data is converted to a digital signal, processed and stored in the memory. At the time of printing, the data is retrieved and sent to the laser diode. 2. DRUM CHARGE In the dark, the charge roller gives a negative charge to the organic photoconductive (OPC) drum. The charge remains on the surface of the drum because the OPC layer has a high electrical resistance in the dark.
SM
6-7
B121/B122/B123
Detailed Descriptions
3. LASER EXPOSURE The processed data scanned from the original is retrieved from the memory and transferred to the drum by a laser beam, which forms an electrical latent image on the drum surface. The amount of charge remaining as a latent image on the drum depends on the laser beam intensity, which is controlled by the BICU board. 4. DEVELOPMENT The magnetic developer brush on the development roller comes in contact with the latent image on the drum surface. Toner particles are electrostatically attached to the areas of the drum surface where the laser reduced the negative charge on the drum. 5. ID SENSOR The laser forms a sensor pattern on the drum surface. The ID sensor measures the reflectivity of the pattern. The output signal is one of the factors used for toner supply control. Also, the ID sensor measures the reflectivity of the drum surface. The output signal is used for charge roller voltage control. 6. IMAGE TRANSFER Paper is fed to the area between the drum surface and the transfer roller at the proper time for aligning the copy paper and the developed image on the drum surface. Then, the transfer roller applies a high positive charge to the reverse side of the paper. This positive charge pulls the toner particles from the drum surface onto the paper. At the same time, the paper is electrostatically attracted to the transfer roller. 7. PAPER SEPARATION Paper separates from the drum as a result of the electrostatic attraction between the paper and the transfer roller. The discharge plate (grounded) helps separate the paper from the drum. 8. CLEANING The cleaning blade removes any toner remaining on the drum surface after the image transfers to the paper. 9. QUENCHING The light from the quenching lamp electrically neutralizes the charge on the drum surface.
B121/B122/B123
6-8
SM
SCANNING
6.4 SCANNING
6.4.1 OVERVIEW
1 2 3 4 5
B121D907.WMF
6 Scanner Motor Original Length Sensor Original Width Sensors Scanner H.P. Sensor
The original is illuminated by the exposure lamp (a xenon lamp). The image is reflected onto a CCD (charge coupled device) on the lens block via the 1st, 2nd, and 3rd mirrors, and through the lens on the lens block. The 1st scanner consists of the exposure lamp, a reflector, and the 1st mirror. A lamp stabilizer energizes the exposure lamp. The light reflected by the reflector is of almost equal intensity, to reduce shadows on pasted originals. An optics anti-condensation heater is available as an option. It can be installed on the left side of the scanner. It turns on whenever the power cord is plugged in.
ICP1
B121D928.WMF
ICP1
SM
6-9
B121/B122/B123
Detailed Descriptions
SCANNING
[E]
[H] [F]
B121D929.WMF
[D]
A stepper motor drives the 1st and 2nd scanners [A, B]. The 1st scanner is driven by the scanner drive motor [C], drive gear through the timing belt [D], scanner drive pulley [E], scanner drive shaft [F], and two timing belts [G]. The 2nd scanner is driven through the 1st scanner and two timing belts [H]. - Book mode The BICU controls and operates the scanner drive motor. In full size mode, the 1st scanner speed is 100 mm/s during scanning. The 2nd scanner speed is half that of the 1st scanner. In reduction or enlargement mode, the scanning speed depends on the magnification ratio. The returning speed is always the same, whether in full size or magnification mode. The image length change in the sub scan direction is done by changing the scanner drive motor speed, and in the main scan direction it is done by image processing on the BICU board. Magnification in the sub-scan direction can be adjusted by changing the scanner drive motor speed using SP4-008. Magnification in the main scan direction can be adjusted using SP4-009. - ADF mode The scanners are always kept at their home position (the scanner H.P. sensor [I] detects the 1st scanner) to scan the original. The ADF motor feeds the original through the ADF. In reduction/enlargement mode, the image length change in the sub-scan direction is done by changing the ADF motor speed. Magnification in the main scan direction is done in the BICU board, like for book mode. Magnification in the sub-scan direction can be adjusted by changing the ADF motor speed using SP6-006-005. In the main scan direction, it can be adjusted with SP4009, like for book mode.
B121/B122/B123 6-10 SM
SCANNING
B121D930.WMF
In the optics cavity for original size detection, there are four reflective sensors. The original width sensors [A] detect the original width, and the original length sensors [B] detect the original length. These are the APS (Auto Paper Select) sensors. Each APS sensor is a reflective photosensor. While the main switch is on, these sensors are active and the original size data is always sent to the CPU. However, the CPU checks the data only when the platen cover sensor [C] is activated. This is when the platen is positioned about 15 cm above the exposure glass, for example while it is being closed. The CPU can recognize the original size from the combination of on/off signals from the APS sensors. If the copy is made with the platen fully open, the CPU decides the original size from the sensor outputs when the Start key is pressed.
SM
6-11
B121/B122/B123
Detailed Descriptions
SCANNING
L1
L2
W1 W2
B121D931.WMF
Original Size A4/A3 LT/DLT version version A3 11" x 17" B4 8.5" x 14" 8.5" x 13" A4-SEF 8.5" x 13" A4-LEF 11" x 8.5" B5-LEF 8.5" x 11" A5-LEF 8.5" x 5.5" 8.5" x 13"
Length Sensors L2 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 L1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 1
Width Sensors W2 1 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 W1 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 1
SP4-301 display 11110000 11010000 11000000 01000000 00110000 00010000 00000000 01010000
NOTE: 0: High (no paper), 1: Low (paper present) The above table shows the outputs of the sensors for each original size. This original size detection method eliminates the necessity for a pre-scan and increases the machine's productivity. For other combinations, Cannot Detect Original Size will be indicated on the operation panel display (if SP4-303 is kept at the default setting). However, if the by-pass feeder is used, note that the machine assumes that the copy paper is short-edge first. For example, if A4 paper is placed long-edge first on the by-pass tray, the machine assumes it is A3 paper and scans the full A3 area for the first copy of each page of the original, disregarding the original size sensors. However, for each page, the data signal to the laser diode is stopped to match the copy paper length detected by the registration sensor. This means that copy time for the first page may be slower (because of the longer time required for scanning), but it will be normal for the rest of the job. Original size detection using the ADF is described in the manual for the ADF.
B121/B122/B123
6-12
SM
IMAGE PROCESSING
CCD
SBU
Memory Control IC
DRAM
Optional DRAM
GW Controller
LDD
BICU
B121D908.WMF
The CCD generates an analog video signal. The SBU (Sensor Board Unit) converts the analog signal to a 8-bit digital signal, then it sends the digital signal to the BICU board. The BICU board can be divided into three image-processing blocks: the IPU (Image Processing Unit), FCI (Fine Character Image), and VCU (Video Control Unit). IPU: Auto shading, filtering, magnification, scanner correction, ID correction VCU: Printer correction, LD print timing control and laser power PWM control FCI (inside the VCU): Smoothing NOTE: The IPU and VCU are contained in the same IC called SCRATCH on the BICU Finally, the BICU board sends the video data to the LD drive board at the proper time. The DRAM on the BICU provides memory for the copier features. In addition, optional DRAM is added to the GW controller board when the printer/scanner option is installed.
SM
6-13
B121/B122/B123
Detailed Descriptions
IMAGE PROCESSING
SBU
O
BICU
A/D Digital Processing IC
8 bit data
Analog Processing 1
CCD
B121D918.WMF
The CCD converts the light reflected from the original into an analog signal. The CCD line has 7,400 pixels and the resolution is 600 dpi (23.6 lines/mm). The CCD has two output lines, for odd and even pixels, to the analog processing circuit. The analog processing circuit performs the following operations on the signals from the CCD: 1. Z/C (Zero Clamp): Adjusts the black level reference for even pixels to match the odd pixels. 2. Signal Amplification: The analog signal is amplified by operational amplifiers. After the above processing, the analog signals are converted to 8-bit signals by the A/D converter. Each pixel will be assigned a value on a scale of 256 grades. Then, the digitized image data goes to the BICU board.
B121/B122/B123
6-14
SM
IMAGE PROCESSING
SBU
GW controller
PrinterScanner Controller
IPU
Memory Controller Optional DRAM
LSD
FCI
LDD
LD
VCU
DRAM
The image data from the SBU goes to the IPU (Image Processing Unit) on the BICU board, which carries out the following processes on the image data: 1. Auto shading 2. White/black line correction 3. ADS 4. Scanner gamma correction 5. Magnification (main scan) 6. Filtering (MTF and smoothing) 7. ID gamma correction 8. Binary picture processing 9. Error diffusion 10. Dithering 11. Video path control 12. Test pattern generation The image data then goes to the VCU (basic machine) or to the GW controller (MFP machine). NOTE: The IPU and VCU are contained in the same IC (called SCRATCH) on the BICU.
SM
6-15
B121/B122/B123
Detailed Descriptions
IMAGE PROCESSING
Photo
B121/B122/B123
6-16
SM
IMAGE PROCESSING
32
Optional GW Controller
B121D919.WMF
SM
6-17
B121/B122/B123
Detailed Descriptions
IMAGE PROCESSING
Original Modes
The machine has 10 original modes. There are two text modes, three photo modes, and five special modes. The original mode key on the operation panel has two settings, text and photo. With the default settings, the machine uses Normal Text (Text 1) when the Text indicator is lit, and uses Photo Priority (Photo 1) when the Photo indicator is lit. The customer can allocate different modes to the Text and Photo indicators with User Tools Copier Features Image Adjustment. Note that the Text indicator does not have to be allocated to a Text mode and the Photo key does not have to be allocated to a Photo mode. For example, the Text indicator can be allocated to Photo 3, and the Photo indicator can be allocated to Special 4. If the user wishes to customize one of the original modes, the technician can change the settings using SP4-922 to SP4-942. Refer to SP Modes for Each Image Processing Step. However, only one of the original modes can be customized at any one time.
B121/B122/B123
6-18
SM
SM
Text Normal ADS ADS ADS Sharp Photo Priority Text Priority Photographs Unneeded Background Colored Text Normal Pixel Photo Coarse Pixel Photo Preserved Background Note Photo Special Enabled Enabled Enabled (DF only) Text (Reflection Ratio ID Linear)
Text (Reflection Ratio ID Lineare Photo (Density Linear)
NOTE: The gray area means the setting cannot be changed using SP mode.
SBU
ADS
Enabled Enabled Enabled (DF only) Photo (Density Text (Refrelcion Photo (Density Ratio ID Linear Linear) Linear) Normal Normal Strong Strong Text (Reflection Ratio ID Linear) Enabled (DF only)
Text (Reflection Ratio ID Linear)
Enabled Enabled (DF only) Enabled Enabled Enabled Enabled (DF only) Enabled (DF only) Enabled Enabled
Mirroring
Normal Normal Normal Normal Normal Normal Normal Weak Disabled Disabled Weak Strong Disabled Weak Thick Weak Disabled SP4-928 SP4-927 Normal Normal Strong Weak (All Area) Normal Strong Normal Weak (All Area) Normal SP4-930 SP4-931 SP4-932
6-19
Normal Sharp Photo Priority Text Priority Photographs Sharp Normal Error Diffusion Binary Error Difusion Binary Error Diffusion Enabled Enabled Enabled Enabled Enabled Enabled Enabled Enabled
Filtering
Smoothing Filter
Normal Pixel Photo Dithering (105 Lines) Coarse Pixel Photo Dithering (53 Lines) Preserved Background Error Diffusion SP4-923
Graduation
ID g Correction
Image Correction
Graduation
Enabled
Path Control
VCU
FCI
Edge Correction
Enabled Enabled
IMAGE PROCESSING
B121D920.WMF
Printer g Correction
IMAGE PROCESSING
B121/B122/B123
6-20
SM
IMAGE PROCESSING
SM
6-21
B121/B122/B123
Detailed Descriptions
IMAGE PROCESSING
By Original Type
ADS mode is only enabled when the user has selected: Text mode 1 or 2 (Normal or Sharp), Photo mode 2 (Text/Priority), or Special mode 1 or 2 (Unneeded background or Colored Text). This can be done using Adjust Original Mode (3) in User Tools (Copier Features).
B121/B122/B123
6-22
SM
IMAGE PROCESSING
Output Density
Text
Photo
Original Density
B121D921.WMF
SM
6-23
B121/B122/B123
Detailed Descriptions
IMAGE PROCESSING
[A]
B121D932.WMF
When making copies using the ADF, the magnification circuit creates a mirror image. This is because the scanning start position along the main scan direction in ADF mode is at the opposite corner of platen mode. In platen mode, the original is placed face down on the exposure glass. The main scan start position is at corner [A], and the scanner moves down the page. In ADF mode, the ADF feeds the leading edge of the original to the DF exposure glass. Therefore as mentioned above, the main scan start position will be at the opposite corner. To create the mirror image, the IPU stores each line in LIFO (Last In First Out) memory.
B121/B122/B123
6-24
SM
IMAGE PROCESSING
Filtering Overview
There are several software filtering processes for enhancing the desired image qualities of the selected original mode. There are three MTF filters, a smoothing filter, independent dot erase, and line width correction. Each can be used only when certain modes are selected (details below) and are automatically applied. The strength levels for the MTF are controlled by SP4-932. The levels for line width correction and independent dot erase are controlled by SP4-927 and 4-928, respectively. The MTF filters bring out sharpness. The three MTF filters are Edge, Solid Image and Low ID Line. Line width correction adjusts the line width. Independent dot erase removes unwanted dots from the image.
The default value is 0 for each mode. However the actual strength of 0 differs from mode to mode.
SM
6-25
B121/B122/B123
IMAGE PROCESSING
ID Gamma () Correction
The machine automatically selects the most appropriate ID gamma correction based on the selected original type and the operation panel ID setting. In all modes, ID gamma correction can be adjusted with SP4-923.
B121/B122/B123
6-26
SM
IMAGE PROCESSING
Error Diffusion
Error diffusion reduces the difference in contrast between light and dark areas of a halftone image. Each pixel is corrected using the difference between it and the surrounding pixels. The corrected pixels are compared with an error diffusion matrix. Error diffusion is applied when the user selects Text 1, Photo 1-3 and Special 2 and 5. As the final step in error diffusion, a process called Texture Removal is applied to Text 1, Photo 2, Special 2, and Special 5 by default, but can also be applied to Photo 1 and 3 by changing the value of SP4-926. Texture removal uses 256 threshold values in an 8 x 8 matrix. The value of SP4926 controls the application of Texture Removal for each of the 6 modes listed above. The settings are as follows:
Detailed Descriptions
0: The default value for each mode is used. Text 1, Photo 2, Special 2, and Special 5 have a default of 3 (see below) and Photo 1 and 3 have a default of 1. 1: No removal applied. 2 6: Removal applied at the level specified here. The higher the setting (level), the less clear the image will become (more texture removal).
Dithering
Each pixel is compared with the threshold in a dither matrix. Several matrices are available to bring out half-tone areas in images such as newspaper-type photographs. Dithering is only used for Special 3 and Special 4.
SM
6-27
B121/B122/B123
IMAGE PROCESSING
4/4
3/4
2/4
1/4
Fig. A
Fig. B
Fig. C
B121D933.WMF
Usually, binary picture processing generates jagged edges on characters, as shown in the above illustration. These are reduced using edge smoothing. The FCI changes the laser pulse duration and position for certain pixels. Fig. A shows the four possible pulse durations, and Fig. B shows how the laser pulse can be in one of three positions within the pixel. Fig. C shows an example of how edge smoothing is used. FCI smoothing is only effective when Text 2 or Special 1 is selected. There is no SP adjustment for this.
LASER EXPOSURE
The LD drive board controls both the laser output and laser synchronization mechanism. The machine cuts off the power supply to the LD drive board if the front or right cover is opened.
SM
6-29
B121/B122/B123
Detailed Descriptions
LD unit Synchronization detector lens Double toroidal lens Shield glass OPC drum 1st mirror
2nd mirror F-theta lens Polygon mirror Cylindrical lens Synchronization detector mirror
LASER EXPOSURE
+5VLD 1 M61880 LD LD PD
PD
APC_SH
+5VLD
XDETP GND
Sync Detector
LD Drive Board
B121D935.WMF
The LD driver IC drives the laser diode. To prevent the intensity of the laser beam from changing because of the temperature, the machine monitors the current passing through the laser diode (LD). The machine adjusts the current to the laser diode by comparing it with the reference level from the reference circuit. This auto power control is done just after the machine is turned on and during printing. The laser diode power is adjusted on the production line. NOTE: Do not touch the variable resistors on the LD unit in the field.
B121/B122/B123
6-30
SM
LASER EXPOSURE
Front/Right Cover Safety Switches LDD: LDD Drive Board LD VCC +24V PD
REG
+5VLD
BICU
B121D915.WMF
To ensure technician and user safety and to prevent the laser beam from inadvertently switching on during servicing, there are safety switches at the front and right covers.
Detailed Descriptions
When the front cover or the right cover is opened, the power supply to the laser diode is interrupted. The switches are installed on the +24V line coming from the power supply unit, then the +5VLD is generated from the +24V supply after it goes through the interlock switches.
SM
6-31
B121/B122/B123
5 8
6
B121D936.WMF
The PCU consists of the components shown in the above illustration. An organic photoconductor (OPC) drum (diameter: 30 mm) is used in this machine. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Cleaning Blade Toner Collection Coil Pick-off Pawl OPC Drum ID Sensor (see note) 6. Development Roller 7. Development Unit 8. Charge Roller 9. Charge Roller Cleaning Brush 10. Quenching Lamp (see note)
NOTE: The ID sensor and quenching lamp are not included in the PCU.
B121/B122/B123
6-32
SM
6.7.2 DRIVE
[A]
[C]
[B]
B121D937.WMF
The main motor [A] drives the drum [B] through a series of gears and the drum drive shaft [C]. The main motor assembly includes a drive controller, which outputs a motor lock signal when the rotation speed is out of the specified range.
SM
6-33
B121/B122/B123
Detailed Descriptions
DRUM CHARGE
[A]
[B]
B121D938.WMF
This copier uses a drum charge roller to charge the drum. The drum charge roller [A] always contacts the surface of the drum [B] to give it a negative charge of 950 V. The high voltage supply board gives a negative charge of 1700 V to the drum charge roller through the screw [C] and terminal plate [D]. This voltage can be changed using SP2-001-1.
B121/B122/B123
6-34
SM
DRUM CHARGE
ID Sensor Pattern
2 cm
[B]
Sub Scan Direction
[A]
Charge Voltage On Laser Diode Drum Potential Off 950 V 650 V 600 V 350 V 150 V Vsg (4.00 V) Vsdp (3.70 V) 1700 V 1400 V
Development Bias
ID Sensor Output
Vsp (0.50 V)
t
B121D940.WMF
With a drum charge roller system, the voltage transferred from roller to drum varies with the temperature and humidity around the drum charge roller. The higher the temperature or humidity is the higher the applied voltage required. To compensate, the machine uses the ID sensor to measure the effects of current environmental conditions. For this measurement, the process control parameters are balanced so that any small change in drum potential caused by environmental effects is reflected in a change in the amount of toner transferred to the drum. This measurement is made immediately after the ID sensor pattern for toner density control. Immediately after making ID sensor pattern [A], the charge roller voltage stays the same, but the development bias goes up to 600 V; as a result the drum potential is reduced to 650 V. The laser diode is not switched on, and the drum potential is now slightly higher than the development bias, so a very small amount of toner transfers to the drum. The ID sensor measures the density of this pattern [B], and the output voltage is known as Vsdp. This voltage is compared with Vsg (read from the bare drum at the same time).
SM 6-35 B121/B122/B123
Detailed Descriptions
DRUM CHARGE
If the humidity drops, the drum potential goes up (to a higher ve voltage) even if the charge roller voltage supply stays the same (efficiency of voltage transfer is higher with lower humidity). As a result, less toner is transferred to ID sensor pattern [B]. If the sensor output reaches a certain point, the drum charge voltage will be reduced. To determine whether to change the drum charge roller voltage, the machine compares Vsdp with Vsg. Vsdp/Vsg > 0.95 = Make the drum charge voltage less ve (smaller) by 50 V Vsdp/Vsg < 0.90 = Make the drum charge voltage more ve (larger) by 50 V
B121/B122/B123
6-36
SM
DRUM CHARGE
[A] [B]
B121D941.WMF
Because the drum charge roller [A] always contacts the drum, it gets dirty easily. So, the cleaning brush [B] also contacts the drum charge roller all the time to clean the surface of the drum charge roller.
SM
6-37
B121/B122/B123
Detailed Descriptions
DEVELOPMENT
6.9 DEVELOPMENT
6.9.1 OVERVIEW
4 1 2 3
B121D942.WMF
The development unit consists of the following parts. 1. Development roller 2. Mixing auger 2 3. TD sensor 4. Mixing auger 1 5. Doctor blade
This machine uses a single-roller development system. Two mixing augers mix the developer. The toner density (TD) sensor and image density (ID) sensor (see the illustration in the PCU section) are used to control the image density on the copy.
B121/B122/B123
6-38
SM
DEVELOPMENT
6.9.2 DRIVE
The main motor [A] drives the development roller [B] and mixing augers [C] through a train of gears and the development drive shaft [D]. When the PCU is pushed in, the development drive shaft engages the development roller gear. The development drive gears (except for the gears in the development unit) are helical gears. These gears are quieter than normal gears. [A]
[B]
[D]
[C]
B121D943.WMF
[F]
Detailed Descriptions
[E]
[F]
B121D944.WMF
SM
6-39
B121/B122/B123
DEVELOPMENT
[B] [A]
B121D945.WMF
This machine uses a negative-positive development system, in which black areas of the latent image are at a low negative charge (about 154 50 V) and white areas are at a high negative charge (about 950 V). To attract negatively charged toner to the black areas of the latent image on the drum, the high voltage supply board applies a bias of 650 volts to the development rollers throughout the image development process. The bias is applied to the development roller shaft [A] through the drive shaft [B]. The development bias voltage (650 V) can be adjusted with SP2-201-1.
B121/B122/B123
6-40
SM
DEVELOPMENT
[A]
[D]
[B]
[C]
B121D946.WMF
The toner supply mechanism transports toner from the bottle to the development unit. The toner bottle has a spiral groove [G] that helps move toner to the development unit. To add a new toner bottle, first lift the toner bottle holder. When this is done, the chuck releases the toner bottle cap into its proper position to prevent toner from scattering. Then, when the bottle holder unit is pulled out to add a new toner bottle, the toner shutter shuts to block the opening as a result of pressure from a spring.
SM
6-41
B121/B122/B123
Detailed Descriptions
When a toner bottle is placed in the bottle holder unit [A] and the unit is pushed in completely, toner shutter [B] moves against the side [C] of the PCU. When the toner bottle holder lever [D] is put back in the original position, the cap [E] on the toner bottle is pulled away and kept in place by the chuck [F].
DEVELOPMENT
[A] [B]
[C]
[E]
B121D947.WMF
[D]
B121D948.WMF
The toner supply motor [A] drives the toner bottle [B] and the mylar blades [C]. First, the toner falls down into the toner bottle holder. The toner supply mylar blades transfer the toner to the slit [D]. When the PCU is installed in the machine, the shutter [E] above the PCU is opened by the toner bottle holder. Then the toner falls down into the development unit through the slit and the shutter.
B121/B122/B123
6-42
SM
DEVELOPMENT
Vt Reference Voltage (Vref) New Vref Vt Reference Voltage Update Vref Update ID Sensor Output (Vsp/Vsg) TD Sensor Initial Setting (Vts)
B121D949.WMF
SM
6-43
B121/B122/B123
Detailed Descriptions
DEVELOPMENT
Mode Toner supply decision Toner control process Toner supply amount Toner end detection
Mode Toner supply decision Toner control process Toner supply amount Toner end detection
Mode Toner supply decision Toner control process Toner supply amount Toner end detection
B121/B122/B123
6-44
SM
DEVELOPMENT
Vsp/Vsg Detection
The ID sensor detects the following voltages. Vsg: The ID sensor output when checking the drum surface Vsp: The ID sensor output when checking the ID sensor pattern In this way, the reflectivity of both the drum surface and the pattern on the drum are checked, compensating for any variations in the reflectivity of the pattern on the drum or the reflectivity of the drum surface. The ID sensor pattern is made on the drum by the charge roller and laser diode. Vsp/Vsg is not detected every page or job; it is detected at the following times to decide Vref. During warm-up at power on If the machine starts warming up when the fusing temperature is 30C or less (default) after entering night mode or low power mode (SP2-994 specifies the temperature setting).
SM
6-45
B121/B122/B123
Detailed Descriptions
DEVELOPMENT
For sensor control modes 1 and 2, the toner supply motor on time is decided by the following factors. Vt Vref or Vts TD sensor sensitivity (coefficient: S, value is 0.4) There are seven levels for toner supply motor on time as shown below.
Level 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Decision (Vts or Vref) < Vt (Vts or Vref) + S/16 (Vts or Vref) < Vt (Vts or Vref) + S/8 (Vts or Vref) < Vt (Vts or Vref) + S/4 (Vts or Vref) < Vt (Vts or Vref) + S/2 (Vts or Vref) < Vt (Vts or Vref) + 4S/5 Vt (Vts or Vref) + 4S/16 (near-end) Vt (Vts or Vref) + S (toner end) Motor On Time (seconds) t (0.4) t x 2 (0.8) t x 4 (1.6) t x 8 (3.2) t x 16 (6.4) T (30); see note 3 T (30); see note 3
NOTE: 1) The value of t can be changed using SP2-922 (default: 0.4 second) 2) The value of T can be changed using SP2-923 (default: 30 seconds) 3) T (30) means that toner is supplied intermittently in a 1/3 duty cycle (1 s on, 2 s off) for 30 seconds
B121/B122/B123
6-46
SM
DEVELOPMENT
TD Sensor
The TD sensor output is checked every copy. If the readings from the TD sensor become abnormal, the machine changes the toner density control mode to fixed supply mode 2, and the toner supply amount per page is always 200 ms, regardless of the value of SP2-925. If the machine detects the TD sensor error condition 10 times consecutively, an SC code is generated (SC390) and the machine must be repaired.
SM
6-47
B121/B122/B123
Detailed Descriptions
DEVELOPMENT
B121/B122/B123
6-48
SM
[A]
[B]
B121D951.WMF
[A]
[C]
SM 6-49
[B]
B121D952.WMF
B121/B122/B123
Detailed Descriptions
PAPER FEED
5 6 7 8
B121D953.WMF
There are one or two paper trays, each of which can hold 250 sheets. The paper tray feed stations use a friction pad system. To prevent paper from getting caught inside the machine when the tray is pulled out, the paper feed roller and shaft do not separate from the tray when the tray is pulled out. The two relay sensors are used for paper jam detection. The lower one detects jams when paper is fed up from the optional paper feed unit. The components of the paper feed station are as follows. 1. 2. 3. 4. Paper End Sensor Paper Feed Roller Registration Roller Paper Size Switch 5. 6. 7. 8. Upper Relay Roller Upper Relay Sensor Lower Relay Sensor Friction Pad
B121/B122/B123
6-50
SM
PAPER FEED
[C]
B121D954.WMF
[A] [B]
SM
6-51
B121/B122/B123
Detailed Descriptions
PAPER FEED
[A]
B121D956.WMF
[A]
[B]
B121/B122/B123
6-52
SM
PAPER FEED
SW Size A3, 11" x 17" A4 LEF A4 SEF, 81/2" x 11" A5 LEF, 81/2" x 14" 81/2" x 13" 11" x 81/2" * (Asterisk)
1 !
" "
2 !
"
3 ! ! !
" "
!
"
!
"
!
"
! !
!
"
[A] [B]
B121D958.WMF
!: OFF (Pushed)
There are three paper size microswitches [A] on the front right plate of the paper tray unit. The switches are actuated by a paper size actuator [B] behind the paper size indicator plate, which is on the front right of the tray. Each paper size has its own actuator, with a unique combination of notches. To determine which size has been installed, the CPU reads which microswitches the actuator has switched off. The CPU disables paper feed from a tray if the paper size cannot be detected. If the paper size actuator is broken, or if there is no tray installed, the Add Paper indicator will light.
Detailed Descriptions
When the paper size actuator is at the * mark, the paper tray can be set up to accommodate one of a wider range of paper sizes by using User Tools. If the paper size for this position is changed without changing the User Tool setting, a paper jam will result.
SM
6-53
B121/B122/B123
PAPER FEED
By-pass Tray
[A]
B121D959.WMF
The by-pass feed paper size switch [A] monitors the paper width. The side fence is connected to the terminal plate gear. When the side fences move to match the paper width, the circular terminal plate rotates over the wiring patterns on the rectangular part of the paper size switch. The patterns for each paper width in the paper size switch are unique.
North America
CN No. (BICU) CN136-1 CN136-2 CN136-3 (GND) CN136-4 CN136-5 11" x 17" ON/OFF OFF OFF OFF ON 81/2" x 14" OFF OFF OFF ON ON OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF 51/2" x 81/2" OFF OFF ON OFF OFF OFF OFF ON OFF OFF
Europe/Asia
CN No. (BICU) CN136-1 CN136-2 CN136-3 (GND) CN136-4 CN136-5 A3 ON/OFF OFF OFF OFF ON A4 SEF OFF OFF OFF ON ON 8" x 13" OFF OFF OFF ON OFF A5 SEF OFF ON/OFF OFF OFF OFF
B121/B122/B123
6-54
SM
PAPER FEED
B121D960.WMF
[B]
[D]
Detailed Descriptions
[C]
B121D961.WMF
If jams frequently occur after registration, SP1-903 can be used to activate the relay clutch so that the relay roller assists the registration roller in feeding the paper along. When feeding from the bypass tray, the by-pass feed clutch is activated, turning the by-pass feed roller. This feature may be needed when feeding thick paper, and cannot be used for the first paper feed tray.
SM
6-55
B121/B122/B123
[B]
[C] [A]
[C]
[A]
B121D963.WMF B121D962.WMF
[D]
B121D964.WMF
The transfer roller [A] touches the surface of the drum [B]. The high voltage supply board supplies a positive current to the transfer roller, which attracts the toner from the drum onto the paper. The current depends on the paper width, paper type, and paper feed tray. The curvature of the drum and the discharge plate [C] help the paper to separate from the drum. The discharge plate is grounded. Drive from the drum through a gear [D] turns the transfer roller.
B121/B122/B123
6-56
SM
Be careful when increasing the transfer current. This may cause a ghosting effect, in which part of the image at the top of the page is repeated lower down the page at a lower density. In the worst case, it may also damage the OPC drum.
SM
6-57
B121/B122/B123
Detailed Descriptions
A3/A4 LEF DLT B4 SEF LT SEF A4 SEF B5 SEF A5 SEF HLT SEF B6 SEF A6 SEF Post card/Envelope
B121D966.WMF
B121D965.WMF
The discharge plate [A] and the drum curvature of the drum help the paper to separate away from the drum. The discharge plate is grounded.
B121/B122/B123
6-58
SM
10
9 5
B121D901.WMF
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6.
Paper exit roller Exit sensor Hot roller strippers Pressure roller Cleaning roller Pressure spring
SM
6-59
B121/B122/B123
Detailed Descriptions
[A]
[B]
[C]
[D]
[H]
[I]
Contact/Release Control
The drive power is not transmitted to the fusing unit (# Drive Release Solenoid) during warming up when the fusing temperature (at the start) is 18C or higher. The drive power is transmitted when the fusing temperature is less than 18C. This contact/release control is based on the following fact. The hot roller [L] takes a shorter time to become hot enough if it is not turning during warming up. When, however, the fusing temperature (at the start) is low, the temperature of the hot-roller surface may become uneven. You can disable this control (# SP1-103-001).
Fusing Temp. 18C or higher Less than 18C Contact/Release Release Contact
B121/B122/B123
6-60
SM
SM
6-61
B121/B122/B123
Detailed Descriptions
[B]
[B]
B121D967.WMF
[C]
[A]
[D]
B121D968.WMF
B121/B122/B123
6-62
SM
[A]
B121D902.WMF
There are two fusing lamps (not identical), two thermistors, and four thermostats. The fusing temperature is controlled using the thermistors [A]. The CPU checks the output from the fusing thermistor once every 1.5 seconds. The CPU decides how long the lamps must be switched on during the next 1.5 seconds by comparing the following temperatures: The center thermistor temperature and the target center temperature The end thermistor temperature and the target end temperature The fusing lamp works to maintain a target fusing temperature of 160C during copying.
SM
6-63
B121/B122/B123
Detailed Descriptions
Temperature Control
According to the operation mode, the fusing temperature is controlled. The diagram illustrates the transition of fusing temperature. After you turn the main switch on, the fusing temperature rises from the room temperature (t0) to one of the specified temperatures. You can adjust some of the temperatures.
Temperature T4 t3 T2 T1 t0 Time A2 A1 b2 b1
B121D910.WMF
: Regular Start : Cold Start UPPER CASE : Adjustable by SP lower case : Not adjustable
A1 Regular Start Mode/A2 Cold Start Mode (SP1-107-1/2) Turning the fusing lamp on and off may affect the voltage of the power source in the room, causing the fluorescent lights in the room to flicker. To lighten this problem, you can reduce the checking repetition to 20 times. When machine initialization ends, the fusing temperature is set to one of the following temperatures: The Standby Temperature (T2: SP1-105-3/4) when there is no print job The First Print Temperature when the copier has received a print request during machine initialization You cannot directly adjust the First Print Temperature. This temperature is 10C higher (up to 185C) than the Copying Temperature (# Copying Mode). C Copying Mode When the copier is making copies, the fusing temperature is set to one of the following temperatures: The Warm Up Temperature (SP1-105-1/2) to output the first print after the Low Power Mode (# Low Power Mode) The Copying Temperature (T4: SP1-105-5/6) to output the second print (and after the second) You can raise the Warm Up Temperature to make better the fusing quality of the first print. While the copier is adjusting the fusing temperature to the Warm Up Temperature, the message "Copy starts after warm up" is displayed. c Thick Paper Mode
B121/B122/B123 6-64 SM
When the machine is making copies on thick paper, the fusing temperature is set to the Thick Paper Temperature (SP1-105-9/10). When thick paper reaches the registration sensor, the copier checks the fusing temperature, and executes one of the following processing: Stops feeding the thick paper (and keeps it at the registration sensor) and waits for the fusing temperature to reach the predefined temperaturethe temperature 5C lower than the Thick Paper Temperature. (The fusing temperature keeps rising until it reaches the Thick Paper Temperature while the thick paper travels from the registration sensor to the fusing unit.) Continues feeding paper and executes the print job if the fusing temperature is high enough. b1/b2 Standby Mode When the copier is not making copies, the fusing temperature is set to the Standby Temperature (T2: SP1-105-3/4). You can adjust this temperature. However, if you have raised this temperature, the BICU may be unable to generate an SC code in the event of fusing lamp error. While in the Standby Mode, the copier checks the fusing temperature every 1.5 seconds (G: SP1-108-1). Turning on and off the fusing lamp may affect the voltage of the power source (in the room), causing the fluorescent lights (in the room) to flicker. To lighten such trouble, you can adjust the control period. However, if you elongate this period (to two seconds or longer), the BICU may be unable to generate an SC code in the event of a fusing lamp error. e Low Power Mode When the Energy Saver Timer (! > System Settings > Timer Settings Energy Saver Timer) expires, the fusing temperature is set to the Low Power Temperature (T1: SP1-105-7/8).
SM
6-65
B121/B122/B123
Detailed Descriptions
B121/B122/B123
6-66
SM
DUPLEX UNIT
B121D912.WMF
The printed page from the fusing unit goes straight through to the exit tray, or upward to the inverter section, depending on the position of the junction gate.
Detailed Descriptions
If the user selects duplex mode, the page is directed to the inverter tray, then reversed through the duplex unit, and back into the machine for printing the second side. 1. 2. 3. 4. Duplex Inverter Roller Duplex Entrance Sensor Upper Transport Roller Middle Transport Roller 5. 6. 7. 8. Duplex Exit Sensor Lower Transport Roller Junction Gate Duplex Inverter Sensor
SM
6-67
B121/B122/B123
DUPLEX UNIT
5 6
B121D969.WMF
B121/B122/B123
6-68
SM
DUPLEX UNIT
Larger than A4 Short-edge/LT Short-edge The paper feed path can hold only one sheet of copy paper at a time.
Example: 8 pages. The number [A] in the illustration shows the order of pages. The number [B] in the illustration shows the order of sheets of copy paper (if black, this indicates the second side).
2
1
!
2
&
!
3
'
!
4
B121D970.WMF
B121D922.WMF
SM
6-69
B121/B122/B123
Detailed Descriptions
DUPLEX UNIT
Up to A4 Short-edge/LT Short-edge
The paper feed path can hold two sheets of copy paper. Example: 8 pages. The number [A] in the illustration shows the order of pages. The number [B] in the illustration shows the order of sheets of copy paper (if black, this indicates the second side).
2
1
!
2
!
3
&
!
4
'
B121D971.WMF
B121D923.WMF
B121/B122/B123
6-70
SM
DUPLEX UNIT
[A]
[B] [D]
B121D972.WMF
[C]
B121D913.WMF
During duplex copying, the inverter gate solenoid [A] switches on and the junction gate [B] switches over to direct the paper to the inverter. When the paper trailing edge reaches the duplex inverter sensor [C], the inverter roller [D] reverses its rotation direction and the paper goes to the duplex unit. The paper is then sent to the mainframe registration rollers to print the reverse side. If there are two or more copies being made with A4/81/2" x 11" SEF (or smaller), the next sheet waits at the registration sensor for the current sheet to exit the inverter.
SM
6-71
B121/B122/B123
Detailed Descriptions
Overview
Power consumption
Operating Mode
Night/Off Mode
Time
B121D917.WMF
The machine has two energy-saver modes: the Low Power Mode and the Night/Off Mode. The table lists the status of several components. For the fusing temperature, see section 6.13.5.
Operating Mode* Low Power Mode Night/Off Mode * Operation panel On Off Off Engine On On Off** Exhaust fan On Off Off
The "Operating Mode" here refers to all the modes (and status) other than the Low Power Mode and Night/Off Mode. Actual power consumption (during the Operating Mode) depends on job status and environmental conditions. ** The SRAM is alive and backs up the engine controller.
AOF
When AOF is off, the engine controller is unable to start the Night/Off Mode. The user should keep AOF on (! > System Settings > Key Operator Tools > AOF).
B121/B122/B123
6-72
SM
Timers
The engine controller references the Energy Saver Timer to start the Low Power Mode, and references the Auto Off Timer to start the Night/Off Mode. The user can set these timers (! > System Settings > Timer Settings). The Energy Saver Timer and the Auto Off Timer start at the same time (t0) when the machine ends all jobs or when the user ends all manual operations. Note that the Auto Off Timer does not wait for the Energy Saver Timer. Therefore, if the user specifies a smaller value in the Energy Saver Timer, the Auto Off Timer expires earlier than the Energy Saver Timer. In a case like this, the Low Power Mode is not activated. Instead, the engine controller starts the Night/Off Mode when the Auto Off Timer expires.
Specified value Energy Saver Timer > Auto Off Timer Energy Saver Timer = Auto Off Timer Energy Saver Timer < Auto Off Timer Low Power Mode Can start Cannot start Cannot start Night/Off Mode Can start Can start Can start
Recovery
Any of the following operations brings the machine back to the Operating Mode: The power switch is pressed. Originals are set on the document feeder. The platen cover (or document feeder) is opened.
SM
6-73
B121/B122/B123
Detailed Descriptions
Overview
Power consumption
Operating Mode
Time
B121D916.WMF
The machine has three energy-saver modes: the Low Power Mode, the Transit Mode, and the Night/Off Mode. The Transit Mode continues for about two seconds (probably, the user does not recognize this mode when it occurs). The table lists the status of several components. For the fusing temperature, see section 6.13.5.
Operating Mode* Low Power Mode Transit Mode Night/Off Mode * Operation panel On Off Off Off Engine On On On Off** Exhaust fan On Off Off Off
The "Operating Mode" here refers to all the modes (or status) other than the Low Power Mode and Night/Off Mode. Actual power consumption (during the Operating Mode) depends on job status and environmental conditions. ** The SRAM is alive and backs up the engine controller.
AOF
See "AOF" in section 6.15.
B121/B122/B123
6-74
SM
Timers
The Energy Saver Timer and Auto Off Timer start at the same time (t0) when the machine ends all jobs, when the user ends all manual operations, or when the controller starts the default application program (the program specified by the user [! > System Settings > General Features > Function Priority]). The default application program starts when the System Auto Reset Timer expires (! > System Settings > Timer Settings > System Auto Reset Timer). For more information, see "Timers" in section 6.15.
Recovery
Any of the following operations brings the machine back to the Operating Mode: The power switch is pressed. Originals are set on the document feeder. The platen cover (or document feeder) is opened. The controller receives a job over the network or the telephone line. An SC code is generated.
SM
6-75
B121/B122/B123
Detailed Descriptions
SPECIFICATIONS
SPECIFICATIONS
SPECIFICATIONS
1. GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
Configuration: Copy Process: Originals: Original Size: Copy Paper Size: Desktop Dry electrostatic transfer system Sheet/Book/Object Maximum A3/11" x 17" Maximum A3/11" x 17" Minimum A5 LEF/81/2" x 51/2" (Paper tray) A6 SEF/51/2" x 81/2" (Bypass) Custom sizes in the bypass tray: Width: 90 297 mm (3.55" 11.69") Length: 148 600 mm (5.83" 23.62")
NOTE: Physically, the by-pass tray can handle the following size (but this size is not recognized by the application software): Width: 305 mm Length: 1,260 mm
Paper Tray: 60 90 g/m2, 16 24 lb. Bypass: 52 162 g/m2, 14 43 lb. 3 enlargement and 4 reduction
A4/A3 Version 200% 141% 122% 100% 93% 82% 71% 50% LT/DLT Version 155% 129% 121% 100% 93% 78% 65% 50%
Specifications B121/B122/B123
Reproduction Ratios:
Zoom:
SM
7-1
SPECIFICATIONS
Power Source:
Taiwan 110 V, 60 Hz 12 A Korea 220 V, 60 Hz 7A North and South America 120 V, 60 Hz 12 A Europe, Asia 220 240 V, 50/60 Hz 7A
Power Consumption:
Full System Energy Saver Off Mode Not above 1.28 kW Not above 10 W Not above 1 W
NOTE: Full system - Maximum possible power consumption (any combination of mainframe and options), excluding optional heaters, key counter, fax unit, and printer controller. Noise Emission
Standby (Mainframe/Full system): Operating (Mainframe only): Operating (Full System): Sound Power Level Not above 40 dB(A) Not above 62 dB(A) Not above 66 dB(A)
NOTE: The above measurements were made in accordance with ISO 7779. Measurements were taken from the normal position of the operator. Dimensions (W x D x H) B121: 550 x 568 x 420 mm (21.7" x 22.4" x 16.5") B122: 550 x 568 x 558 mm (21.7" x 22.4" x 23.0") B123: 587 x 568 x 558 mm (23.1" x 22.4" x 23.0") NOTE: Measurement Conditions 1) With bypass feed table closed 2) Without the A(R)DF Weight B121: 35 kg (77 lb.) B122: 43 kg (95 lb.) B123: 47 kg (103 lb.) (Excluding A(R)DF, platen cover, toner, and developer)
B121/B122/B123
7-2
SM
SPECIFICATIONS
DF 1-to-1
1-sided 2-sided
Memory copy
NOTE: Measurement Conditions: 1) Figures are for one-sided original to one-sided copy except where stated otherwise 2) Not APS mode 3) 100% size Warm-up Time: First Copy Time: Basic model: Less than 15 seconds (at 20C [68F]) MFP model: Less than 35 seconds (at 20C [68F]) Not more than 6.5 seconds NOTE: Measurement Conditions 1) From the ready state, with the polygonal mirror motor operating. 2) A4/LT copying 3) Not APS mode 4) 100%size 5) Paper feed from the upper tray Numeric keypad, 1 to 99 (increment, decrement) 5 steps
Specifications
Copy Number Input: Manual Image Density: Automatic Reset: Automatic Shut-off:
Default is 60 seconds. Can be set from 10 to 999 seconds with user tools. Default is 1 minute. Can be set from 1 to 240 minutes with user tools.
SM
7-3
B121/B122/B123
SPECIFICATIONS
Paper Tray: 250 sheets (B121) 250 sheets x 2 (B122/B123) Optional Paper Tray Unit: 500 sheets x 1, or 500 sheets x 2 Bypass Tray: 100 sheets (sheets up to 432 mm [17"]) 40 postcards 10 envelopes NOTE: Copy weight: 80 g/m2 (20 lb.)
Cartridge replacement (260 g/cartridge) Platen cover Auto document feeder Auto-reverse document feeder Paper tray unit (1 tray) Paper tray unit (2 trays) 1-bin tray Tray heater Optics anti-condensation heater Fax unit Handset Printer/scanner unit GW board IEEE 1394 IEEE 1284 Wireless LAN Bluetooth PostScript 3 NRS (CSS) kit 9k copies (A4 LEF, 6% full black, 1 to 2 copying, normal text mode) 250 sheets Basic Model: 16 MB MFP Model: 64 MB + 128 MB DIMM
B121/B122/B123
7-4
SM
SPECIFICATIONS
SM
7-5
B121/B122/B123
Specifications
SPECIFICATIONS
When the settings of SP4-305-001 is "1: A4/LT," the settings of SP4-303 is invalidated (A5 LEF is not detected).
B121/B122/B123
7-6
SM
SPECIFICATIONS
China, Korea
Paper A3 SEF B4 SEF A4 SEF A4 LEF B5 SEF B5 LEF A5 SEF A5 LEF B6 SEF B6 LEF 8K SEF 16K SEF 16K LEF DLT SEF SEF LG SEF LT SEF LT LEF HLT SEF HLT LEF F/GL (F4) SEF Foolscap SEF Folio SEF USB4 SEF Eng Quarto SEF Eng Quarto LEF Size (W x L) 297 x 420 mm 257 x 364 mm 210 x 297 mm 297 x 210 mm 182 x 257 mm 257 x 182 mm 148 x 210 mm 210 x 148 mm 128 x 182 mm 182 x 128 mm 267 x 390 mm 195 x 267 mm 267 x 195 mm 11.0" x 17.0" 11.0" x 15.0" 8.5" x 14.0" 8.5" x 11.0" 11.0" x 8.5" 5.5" x 8.5" 8.5" x 5.5" 8.0" x 13.0" 8.5" x 13.0" 8.25" x 13.0" 10.0" x 14.0" 8.0" x 10.0" 10.0" x 8.0" China/Korea Platen ADF X X X X X X X X X X X X O X S X O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O A4/LT A4/LT A4/LT A4/LT O O O O O F O F O F O O O O O O China/Korea (localized) ADF c Platen b X O O O X O X O O O O O O X S X O O O O X X X X X X O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O F O F O F O O O O O O
Change the settings of SP4-305-001. Adjust the positions of the APS sensors. c Change the settings of SP4-305-001.
SM
7-7
B121/B122/B123
Specifications
SPECIFICATIONS
SIGN: X: O: M: K: NOTE: Custom Detected (Main frame tray)/Processed (Duplex) Not detected (Main frame tray)/Not processed (Duplex) Selected manually Specified from the key pad W: 90 to 297 mm L: 148 to 600 mm
B121/B122/B123
7-8
SM
SPECIFICATIONS
(Continued) Paper Executive SEF Executive LEF F SEF F LEF Foolscap SEF Foolscap LEF Folio SEF Folio LEF 8K SEF 8K LEF 16K SEF 16K LEF C5 Env. SEF C6 Env. SEF DL Env. SEF Com10 SEF Monarch SEF Custom Size (W x L) 71/4" x 101/2" 101/2" x 71/4" 8" x 13" 13" x 8" 81/2" x 13" 13" x 81/2" 81/4" x 13" 13" x 81/4" 267 x 390 mm 390 x 267 mm 195 x 267 mm 267 x 195 mm 162 x 229 mm 114 x 162 mm 110 x 220 mm 41/8" x 91/2" 37/8" x 71/2" China/ Korea M M M O M O M O M O M M O O O O O O Main frame tray North Europe America M M M M M M O O X X O O M M O O M M O O M M M M O O O O O O O O O O O O Asia/ Taiwan M M M O X O M O M O M M O O O O O O Duplex X X X O X O X O X O X X O O O O O O
SIGN: X: O: M: K: NOTE: Custom Detected (Main frame tray)/Processed (Duplex) Not detected (Main frame tray)/Not processed (Duplex) Selected manually Specified from the key pad W: 90 to 297 mm L: 148 to 600 mm
SM
7-9
B121/B122/B123
Specifications
SPECIFICATIONS
Europe
M O M O M M M M M M M O K O X O X O K O X M X O
X O M O X M M M X M M O K O M O M O K O M M M O
Asia/ Taiwa n X O M O X M M M X M M O K O M O M O K O M M M O
SIGN: X: O: M: K: NOTE: Custom Detected (Opt. paper tray and By-pass)/Processed (One-bin tray) Not detected (Opt. paper tray and By-pass)/Not processed (One-bin tray) Selected manually Specified from the key pad W: 90 to 297 mm L: 148 to 600 mm
B121/B122/B123
7-10
SM
SPECIFICATIONS
(Continued) Paper Executive SEF Executive LEF F SEF F LEF Foolscap SEF Foolscap LEF Folio SEF Folio LEF 8K SEF 8K LEF 16K SEF 16K LEF C5 Env. SEF C6 Env. SEF DL Env. SEF Com10 SEF Monarch SEF Custom Size (W x L) 7 1/4" x 101/2" 101/2" x 71/4" 8" x 13" 13" x 8" 81/2" x 13" 13" x 81/2" 81/4" x 13" 13" x 81/4" 267 x 390 mm 390 x 267 mm 195 x 267 mm 267 x 195 mm 162 x 229 mm 114 x 162 mm 110 x 220 mm 41/8" x 91/2" 37/8" x 71/2" Opt. paper tray M M M O X O M O M O M M O O O O O O Onebin tray X X X O X O X O X O X X O O O O O O By-pass China M M M O M O M O M O M M M M M M M X
North America
Europe
M M M O M O M O M O M M M M M M M X
M M X O M O M O M O M M M M M M M X
Asia/ Taiwa n M M X O M O M O M O M M M M M M M X
SIGN: X: O: M: K: NOTE: Custom Detected (Opt. paper tray and By-pass)/Processed (One-bin tray) Not detected (Opt. paper tray and By-pass)/Not processed (One-bin tray) Selected manually Specified from the key pad W: 90 to 297 mm L: 148 to 600 mm
SM
7-11
B121/B122/B123
Specifications
SPECIFICATIONS
3. MACHINE CONFIGURATION
[A] [B] [F]
[C] [D]
[G]
B121V901.WMF
[J]
[K]
[L]
[M]
[N]
B121V902.WMF
B121/B122/B123
7-12
SM
SPECIFICATIONS
Copier
Unit/Component Copier (1-tray non-duplex model) Copier (2-tray non-duplex model) Copier (2-tray with duplex) Platen cover (optional) ADF (optional) ARDF (optional) Paper tray unit1 tray (optional) Paper tray unit2 trays (optional) 1-bin tray (optional) Tray heater (optional) Optics anti-condensation heater (optional) GW controller (optional) Fax controller (optional) Handset (optional) Printer scanner controller (optional) PostScript 3 (optional) IEEE 1394 IEEE 1284 Wireless LAN Bluetooth
Machine Code B121 B122 B123 B406 B616 B617 B385 B384 B621 B658 B620 B433 B622 B681 B581 B679 B682 G377
Diagram [H] [D] [G] [F] [A] [A] [E] [I] [C] [J] [L] [B] [M] [K] [N] [N] [N] [N]
NOTE: The GW controller is supplied with the dedicated controller box and operation panel.
SM
7-13
B121/B122/B123
Specifications
SPECIFICATIONS
4. OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
ARDF
Original Size: Standard sizes Single-sided mode: A3 to A5, 11" x 17" to 51/2" x 81/2" Double-sided mode: A3 to A5, 11" x 17" to 51/2" x 81/2" Non-standard sizes (Single-sided mode only) Max. width 297 mm Min. width 105 mm Max. length 1260 mm Min. length 128 mm Single-sided mode: 40 128 g/m2,10 34 lb. Double-sided mode: 52 105 g/m2,14 28 lb. 50 sheets (80 g/m2, 70 kg) FRR Roller transport From the top original 50 to 200% (Sub scan direction only) 24 and 5 Vdc from the copier 50 W 550 x 470 x 130 mm 10 kg
Original Weight: Table Capacity: Separation: Original Transport: Original Feed Order: Reproduction Range: Power Source: Power Consumption: Dimensions (W x D x H): Weight:
B121/B122/B123
7-14
SM
SPECIFICATIONS
ADF
Original Size: Standard sizes (Single-sided mode only): A3 to A5, 11" x 17" to 51/2" x 81/2" Non-standard sizes (Single-sided mode only): Max. width 297 mm Min. width 105 mm Max. length 1,260 mm Min. length 128 mm 52 105 g/m2 (14 28 lb.) 30 sheets (80 g/m2, 22 lb.) FRR Roller transport From the top original 50 200% 24 and 5 Vdc (from the main frame) 25 W 550 mm x 470 mm x 90 mm Not above 7 kg
Original Weight: Table Capacity: Separation: Original Transport: Original Feed Order: Reproduction Range: Power Source: Power Consumption: Dimensions (W x D x H): Weight:
SM
7-15
B121/B122/B123
Specifications
SPECIFICATIONS
Power Consumption:
B121/B122/B123
7-16
SM
SPECIFICATIONS
Power Consumption:
One-Bin Tray
Paper Size: Output Standard Position: Paper Weight: Tray Capacity: Power Source: Power Consumption: Weight: Size (W x D x H): Width: 140 ~ 297 mm Length: 140 ~ 432 mm Center 60 ~ 105 g/m, 16 ~ 28 lbs. 100 sheets (A4 LEF 80 g/m2, 20 lb) 5 VDC, 24 VDC (from the copier) Max. 20 W 1.55 kg (Base unit: 1.1 kg, Tray: 0.45 kg) 461 mm x 478 mm x 104 mm (508 mm x 478 mm x 104 mm when tray extended)
Specifications
SM
7-17
B121/B122/B123
Rev. 03/2004
B621
TABLE OF CONTENTS
1. REPLACEMENT AND ADJUSTMENT ............................................1
1.1 TRAY OPEN SWITCH................................................................................... 1 1.2 PAPER SENSOR .......................................................................................... 3 1.3 EXIT SENSOR .............................................................................................. 3
3. TROUBLESHOOTING .....................................................................9
3.1 PAPER JAM .................................................................................................. 9 3.2 PAPER-JAM HANDLING............................................................................. 10 3.2.1 RESETTING THE COPIER ................................................................ 10 3.2.2 COMPONENT-RELATED PAPER JAM ............................................. 11
SM
B621
# : Clip ring
#%
[A]
B621R901.WMF
SM
B621
1. Remove the tray [A] as follows: " Lift the front end of the tray. # Pull the right hook off the copier. $ Pull the whole tray off the copier.
2. Open the front cover [A]. 3. Front right cover [B] (! x 1) 4. Disconnect the connector [C].
[C] [B]
B621R902.WMF
[D]
B621R903.WMF
[E]
B621R905.WMF
B621
SM
PAPER SENSOR
[A]
B621R906.WMF
[A]
B621R904.WMF
[A]
SM
B621
COMPONENTS
2. DETAILED DESCRIPTION
2.1 COMPONENTS
1 2 3 4 5 6
B621D901.WMF
B621D902.WMF
10
13 12
B621D903.WMF
11
B621D907.WMF
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8.
Exit rollers Tray open switch Paper sensor Exit sensor Tray motor 1-bin tray board Junction gate solenoid Exit tray LED
9. Tray open switch 10. Exit sensor 11. Junction gate 12. Junction gate solenoid 13. Paper sensor
B621
SM
SETTINGS
2.2 SETTINGS
Settings
Use the User Tools to specify which application program (the copy, printer, or fax application program) uses the 1-bin tray. Locate the user tool as follows: % > System Settings > General Features > Output: Copier, Output: Facsimile, Output: Printer.
Limitation
The machine can output to the 1-bin tray if the paper is fed from a regular tray or from an optional tray. Paper fed from the by-pass tray is not output to the 1-bin tray. The paper source setting takes precedence over the paper exit setting. As a result, paper fed from the by-pass tray is output to the copier exit tray even if you have specified the 1-bin tray as the exit. In a case like this, no warning or message is displayed.
Setting 1-bin tray 1-bin tray 1-bin tray Paper source Actual output Regular tray Optional tray By-pass tray 1-bin tray 1-bin tray Copier tray
SM
B621
PAPER TRANSPORT
[E] [F]
B621D902.WMF B621D908.WMF
When the paper has passed the registration sensor (of the copier) and a predefined time (not adjustable) has elapsed, the tray motor [A] starts and the junction gate solenoid [F] turns on. The tray motor drives the exit rollers [C] and the junction gate solenoid opens the junction gate [E]. The junction gate feeds the leading edge of the paper upwards [D]. The paper, transported by the exit rollers of the copier, travels up to the exit rollers of the 1-bin tray base unit. The exit rollers transport the paper to the one-bin tray [B]. When the last sheet of paper has been output, the tray motor stops and the junction gate solenoid turns off.
B621
SM
[C] [D]
B621D902.WMF
B621D903.WMF
B621D904.WMF
The exit tray LED [A] lights whenever the paper sensor [B] detects paper. When you open the base unit to remove jammed paper, the exit tray LED may light. This is because the paper sensor [C] detects the tray [D].
SM
B621
[B]
B621D906.WMF B621D905.WMF
The tray open switch [A] detects the mechanical link [B] at the front end. When you open the base unit, the message "Cover Open" is displayed with a diagram indicating the location. The message "Cover Open" is also displayed when the connector of the one-bin tray base unit [C] disconnects from the connector of the copier [B]. In this case, the message is not cleared until you install the base unit correctly.
B621
SM
PAPER JAM
3. TROUBLESHOOTING
3.1 PAPER JAM
[A] [A]
B621T905.WMF B621T903.WMF
The paper-jam sign is displayed under either of the following conditions: Condition 1 a) The paper has passed the registration sensor (of the copier), and b) The exit sensor [A] does not detect the paper in " the predefined time (not adjustable). Condition 2 a) The paper has passed the registration sensor (of the copier), and b) The exit sensor detects the paper in # the predefined time (not adjustable), and c) The exit sensor keeps detecting the paper for a longer time than $ the predefined time (not adjustable). Note that " and # are the same predefined time and that $ is different from the other two.
SM
B621
PAPER-JAM HANDLING
[A]
[B]
B621T901.WMF
B621T902.WMF
The paper-jam sign is displayed when one of the two conditions (! 3.1) is met. To get the copier ready for normal operation, you must: 1) Remove the paper. 2) Open and close the right cover [A] of the copier. 3) Open and close the base unit [B]. Note that you must open and close the right cover of the copier to reset the copier when the 1-bin tray unit has caused a paper jam.
B621
10
SM
PAPER-JAM HANDLING
[C] [A]
B621D901.WMF
B621D902.WMF
The 1-bin tray unit does not know if the tray motor [C] is working properly. No error message is displayed even when, for example, the tray-motor cable comes off the 1-bin tray board [B]. When the tray motor does not work properly, the leading edge of the paper is caught by the exit rollers [A]. The paper stays between the exit rollers (of the 1-bin tray unit) and the fusing unit. In this case, the copier controller detects that the paper jam has occurred in the copier (not in the 1-bin tray unit). To get the copier ready for normal operation, you must: 1) Remove the paper. 2) Open and close the right cover of the copier. [D]
SM
11
B621
B616/B617
TABLE OF CONTENTS
ADF 616 AND ARDF B617 .................................................................. 1
SM
B616/B617
ADF B616 and ARDF B617 are both applicable to the B121/B122/B123 models and the B039/B040/B043 models. When the copier starts, the controller of the document feeder communicates with the controller of the copier. The documentfeeder controller checks the line speed of the copier, and decides the line speed of the document feeder. The table lists the line speeds of ADF B616 and ARDF B617.
When installed on B121/B122/B123 100 mm/sec 100 mm/sec When installed on B039/B040/B043 89 mm/sec 89 mm/sec
NOTE: The line speed of B121/B122/B123 is 100 mm/sec; the line speed of B039/B040/B043 is 89 mm/sec. The document feeders for the B039/B040/B043 (ADF B387, ARDF B379) are not applicable to B121/B122/B123. If those feeders are installed on the B121/B122/B123, SC621 appears. To re-set the SC621, turn the mainswitch off and on.
ADF B616/ARDF B617 ADF B387/ARDF B379
B121/B122/B123
B039/B040/B043
B616D901.WMF
For Overall Machine Information, Detailed Section Descriptions and Replacement and Adjustment procedures on the B616 ADF and B617 ARDF, please refer to the B039/B040/B043 Service Manual, Auto Reverse Document Feeder B379 and Document Feeder B387. A copy of this manual is provided on the CD-ROM in the front cover of this manual.
SM
B616/B617
ADF/ARDF B616/B617
2. TROUBLESHOOTING .....................................................................6
2.1 ERROR CODES........................................................................................... 6 2.2 FAX SC CODES......................................................................................... 13 2.2.1 OVERVIEW ....................................................................................... 13 2.2.2 SC1201.............................................................................................. 13 2.2.3 FAX SC CODE TABLE ...................................................................... 13
3. SERVICE TABLES.........................................................................14
3.1 SERVICE PROGRAM MODE..................................................................... 14 3.1.1 SERVICE PROGRAM MODE OPERATION...................................... 14 Entering and Exiting SP mode ............................................................... 14 SP2-XXX (RAM) .................................................................................... 15 SP3-XXX (Machine Set) ........................................................................ 16 SP4-XXX (ROM Versions) ..................................................................... 16 SP5-XXX (RAM Clear)........................................................................... 17 SP6-XXX (Reports)................................................................................ 17 SP7-XXX (Tests) ................................................................................... 18 3.2 BIT SWITCHES .......................................................................................... 19 3.2.1 SYSTEM SWITCHES ........................................................................ 19 3.2.2 IFAX SWITCHES............................................................................... 30 3.2.3 PRINTER SWITCHES ....................................................................... 30 3.2.4 COMMUNICATION SWITCHES........................................................ 35 3.2.5 G3-1 SWITCHES............................................................................... 40 3.2.6 FAX SWITCHES................................................................................ 48 3.3 NCU PARAMETERS .................................................................................. 50 3.4 DEDICATED TRANSMISSION PARAMETERS ......................................... 60 3.4.1 PROGRAMMING PROCEDURE ....................................................... 60 3.4.2 PARAMETERS .................................................................................. 61 3.5 SERVICE RAM ADDRESSES.................................................................... 64
SM
B620
SPECIFICATIONS...............................................................................75
1 GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS....................................................................... 75 2 CAPABILITIES OF PROGRAMMABLE ITEMS ............................................. 76 3 MACHINE CONFIGURATION ....................................................................... 76
B620
ii
SM
!CAUTION
1. Before installing the fax unit, switch off the main switch, and disconnect the power cord. 2. The fax unit contains a lithium battery. The danger of explosion exists if a battery of this type is incorrectly replaced. Replace only with the same or an equivalent type recommended by the manufacture. Discard batteries in accordance with the manufactures instructions and local regulations. NOTE FOR AUSTRALIA Unit must be connected to Telecommunication Network through a line cord which meets the requirements of ACA Technical Standard TS008.
SM
B620
1. INSTALLATION
INSTALLATION
[B]
B620I900.WMF
3. Remove the slot cover [C]. 4. Install the FCU [D] (! x 3). 5. Short the jumper [E]. NOTE: The jumper works as the battery switch.
[C]
[E] [D] 6. Attach the ferrite core [D] to the telephone cable [G]. The end of the ferrite core must be about 5 cm (2") from the end of the cable [H]. 7. Reassemble the controller box. 8. Install the rear cover.
B620 2
B620I901.WMF
[H] [G]
[F]
B620I912.WMF
SM
INSTALLATION
9. When installing the optional fax only (not with the optional printer/scanner), install the keys as follows: NOTE: See step 10 when installing the optional fax with the optional printer/scanner.
[E]
[e]
Facsimile
[A]
[a]
Copy
[B]
[D]
[C]
B620I906.WMF
1) Remove the dummy cover (from the basic operation panel) and install the copy key [A] or [a]. 2) Remove the dummy panel (from the basic operation panel) and install the fax panel [B]. 3) Install the dummy cover [C] on the optional operation panel. 4) Install the fax panel [D] on the optional operation panel. 5) Install the fax key [E] or [e] on the optional operation panel.
SM
B620
INSTALLATION
10. When installing the optional fax with the optional printer/scanner, install the keys as follows: NOTE: See step 9 when installing the optional fax without the optional printer/scanner. [E] [e]
Facsimile
[A]
[a]
Copy
[G]
[g]
Printer
[D]
Scanner
[C]
[c]
[F]
[B]
B620I902.WMF
1) Remove the dummy cover (from the basic operation panel) and install the copy key [A] or [a]. 2) Remove the dummy panel (from the basic operation panel) and install the fax panel [B]. 3) Install the scanner key [C] or [c] on the optional operation panel. 4) Install the fax panel [D] on the optional operation panel. 5) Install the fax key [E] or [e] on the optional operation panel. 6) Remove the dummy panel (from the basic panel) and install the printer panel [F]. 7) Install the printer key [G] or [g] on the basic operation panel.
B620
SM
INSTALLATION
B620I108.WMF
12. Install the stamp cartridge [B] into the ADF as shown (if the ADF is installed). 13. Connect the telephone line to the "LINE" jack. 14. Plug in the machine and turn on the main switch. NOTE: The copier must be connected to a properly grounded socket outlet. 15. Make sure that the clock (date and time) is set.
B620I552.WMFMFMF
[B]
16. Start the SP mode and input the serial number into the fax unit (SP-3-102-000). The serial number can be found on the serial number label.
SM
B620
ERROR CODES
2. TROUBLESHOOTING
2.1 ERROR CODES
If an error code occurs, retry the communication. If the same problem occurs, try to fix the problem as suggested below. Note that some error codes appear only in the error code display and on the service report.
Code 0-00 Meaning DIS/NSF not detected within 40 s of Start being pressed Suggested Cause/Action !" Check the line connection. !" The machine at the other end may be incompatible. !" Replace the FCU. !" Check for DIS/NSF with an oscilloscope. !" If the rx signal is weak, there may be a bad line. !" The other party is out of paper or has a jammed printer. !" The other party pressed Stop during communication. !" The other terminal is incompatible. !" Check the line connection. !" Try changing the tx level and/or cable equalizer settings. !" Replace the FCU. !" The other terminal may be faulty; try sending to another machine. !" If the rx signal is weak or defective, there may be a bad line. Cross reference !" Tx level - NCU Parameter 01 (PSTN) !" Cable equalizer - G3 Switch 07 (PSTN) !" Dedicated Tx parameters - Section 4 !" Check the line connection. !" Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable equalizer. !" Replace the FCU. !" Check for line problems. Cross reference !" See error code 0-04. !" Check the line connection. !" Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable equalizer settings. !" Replace the FCU. !" The other end may be defective or incompatible; try sending to another machine. !" Check for line problems. Cross reference !" See error code 0-04.
0-01
0-03 0-04
Incompatible modem at the other end CFR or FTT not received after modem training
0-05
0-06
B620
SM
ERROR CODES
Code 0-07 Meaning No post-message response from the other end after a page was sent Suggested Cause/Action !" Check the line connection. !" Replace the FCU. !" The other end may have jammed or run out of paper. !" The other end user may have disconnected the call. !" Check for a bad line. !" The other end may be defective; try sending to another machine. !" Check the line connection. !" Replace the FCU. !" The other end may have jammed, or run out of paper or memory space. !" Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable equalizer settings. !" The other end may have a defective modem/NCU/FCU; try sending to another machine. !" Check for line problems and noise. Cross reference !" Tx level - NCU Parameter 01 (PSTN) !" Cable equalizer - G3 Switch 07 (PSTN) !" Dedicated Tx parameters - Section 4 !" Incompatible or defective remote terminal; try sending to another machine. !" Noisy line: resend. !" Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable equalizer settings. !" Replace the FCU. Cross reference !" See error code 0-08. The other terminal is not capable of accepting the following functions, or the other terminals memory is full. !" Confidential rx !" Transfer function !" SEP/SUB/PWD/SID !" Check the line connection. !" Replace the FCU. !" Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable equalizer settings. !" The other end may have disconnected, or it may be defective; try calling another machine. !" If the rx signal level is too low, there may be a line problem. Cross reference !" See error code 0-08.
0-08
The other end sent RTN or PIN after receiving a page, because there were too many errors
0-14
0-15
0-16
CFR or FTT not detected after modem training in confidential or transfer mode
SM
B620
ERROR CODES
Code 0-17 Meaning Communication was interrupted by pressing the Stop key. Facsimile data not received within 6 s of retraining Suggested Cause/Action If the Stop key was not pressed and this error keeps occurring, replace the operation panel. !" !" !" !" !" Check the line connection. Replace the FCU. Check for line problems. Try calling another fax machine. Try adjusting the reconstruction time for the first line and/or rx cable equalizer setting. Cross reference !" Reconstruction time - G3 Switch 0A, bit 6 !" Rx cable equalizer - G3 Switch 07 (PSTN) !" Check the connections between the FCU & line. !" Check for line noise or other line problems. !" Replace the FCU. !" The remote machine may be defective or may have disconnected. Cross reference !" Maximum interval between EOLs and between ECM frames - G3 Bit Switch 0A, bit 4 !" Check the line connection. !" Replace the FCU. !" Defective remote terminal. !" Check for line noise or other line problems. !" Try adjusting the acceptable modem carrier drop time. Cross reference !" Acceptable modem carrier drop time - G3 Switch 0A, bits 0 and 1 !" Check the line connection. !" Replace the FCU. !" Defective remote terminal. !" Check for line noise or other line problems. !" Try asking the other end to adjust their tx level. !" Try adjusting the rx cable equalizer setting and/or rx error criteria. Cross reference !" Rx cable equalizer - G3 Switch 07 (PSTN) !" Rx error criteria - Communication Switch 02, bits 0 and 1 !" Check the line connection. !" Try adjusting the tx level and/or cable equalizer settings. !" The other terminal may not be compatible. Cross reference !" Dedicated tx parameters - Section 4
0-20
0-21
EOL signal (end-of-line) from the other end not received within 5 s of the previous EOL signal
0-22
The signal from the other end was interrupted for more than the acceptable modem carrier drop time (default: 200 ms)
0-23
0-30
The other terminal did not reply to NSS(A) in AI short protocol mode
B620
SM
ERROR CODES
Code 0-32 Meaning The other terminal sent a DCS, which contained functions that the receiving machine cannot handle. Polarity changed during communication The communication mode specified in CM/JM was not available (V.8 calling and called terminal) The calling terminal fell back to T.30 mode, because it could not detect ANSam after sending CI. The called terminal fell back to T.30 mode, because it could not detect a CM in response to ANSam (ANSam timeout). The calling terminal fell back to T.30 mode, because it could not detect a JM in response to a CM (CM timeout). The called terminal fell back to T.30 mode, because it could not detect a CJ in response to JM (JM timeout). The called terminal detected CI while waiting for a V.21 signal. The line was disconnected due to a timeout in V.34 phase 2 line probing. The line was disconnected due to a timeout in V.34 phase 3 equalizer training. The line was disconnected due to a timeout in the V.34 phase 4 control channel start-up. Suggested Cause/Action !" Check the protocol dump list. !" Ask the other party to contact the manufacturer. !" Check the line connection. Retry communication. !" The other terminal did not have a compatible communication mode (e.g., the other terminal was a V.34 data modem and not a fax modem.) !" A polling tx file was not ready at the other terminal when polling rx was initiated from the calling terminal. !" The calling terminal could not detect ANSam due to noise, etc. !" ANSam was too short to detect. !" Check the line connection and condition. !" Try making a call to another V.8/V.34 fax. !" The terminal could not detect ANSam. !" Check the line connection and condition. !" Try receiving a call from another V.8/V.34 fax. !" The called terminal could not detect a CM due to noise, etc. !" Check the line connection and condition. !" Try making a call to another V.8/V.34 fax. !" The calling terminal could not detect a JM due to noise, etc. !" A network that has narrow bandwidth cannot pass JM to the other end. !" Check the line connection and condition. !" Try receiving a call from another V.8/V.34 fax. Check for line noise or other line problems. If this error occurs, the called terminal falls back to T.30 mode. !" The guard timer expired while starting these phases. Serious noise, narrow bandwidth, or low signal level can cause these errors. If these errors happen at the transmitting terminal: !" Try making a call at a later time. !" Try using V.17 or a slower modem using dedicated tx parameters. !" Try increasing the tx level. !" Try adjusting the tx cable equalizer setting.
0-52 0-70
0-74
0-75
0-76
0-77
0-79
0-80
0-81
0-82
SM
B620
ERROR CODES
Code 0-83 Meaning The line was disconnected due to a timeout in the V.34 control channel restart sequence. Suggested Cause/Action If these errors happen at the receiving terminal: !" Try adjusting the rx cable equalizer setting. !" Try increasing the tx level. !" Try using V.17 or a slower modem if the same error is frequent when receiving from multiple senders. !" The signal did not stop within 10 s. !" Turn off the machine, then turn it back on. !" If the same error is frequent, replace the FCU. !" !" !" !" !" The signal did not stop within 10 s. Turn off the machine, then turn it back on. If the same error is frequent, replace the FCU. The other terminal was incompatible. Ask the other party to contact the manufacturer.
0-84
0-85
The line was disconnected due to abnormal signaling in V.34 phase 4 control channel start-up. The line was disconnected due to abnormal signaling in V.34 control channel restart. The line was disconnected because the other terminal requested a data rate using MPh that was not available in the currently selected symbol rate. The control channel started after an unsuccessful primary channel. The line was disconnected because PPR was transmitted/received 9 (default) times within the same ECM frame. The modem cannot enter tx mode Only one V.21 connection flag was received Modem clock irregularity Modem initialization error JBIG compression or reconstruction error JBIG ASIC error JBIG data reconstruction error (BIH error) JBIG data reconstruction error (Float marker error) JBIG data reconstruction error (End marker error) JBIG data reconstruction error (Timeout) The machine resets itself for a fatal FCU system error
0-86
0-87
0-88
!" The receiving terminal restarted the control channel because data reception in the primary channel was not successful. !" This does not result in an error communication. !" Try using a lower data rate at the start. !" Try adjusting the cable equalizer setting.
2-10 2-11 2-12 2-13 2-23 2-24 2-25 2-26 2-27 2-28 2-50
!" Replace the FCU. !" Replace the FCU. !" !" !" !" !" !" !" !" Replace the FCU. Turn off the machine, then turn it back on. Replace the FCU. Turn off the machine, then turn it back on. Turn off the machine, then turn it back on. JBIG data error Check the senders JBIG function. Update the MBU ROM.
B620
10
SM
ERROR CODES
Code 2-51 Meaning The machine resets itself because of a fatal communication error Line current was cut Suggested Cause/Action !" If this is frequent, update the ROM, or replace the FCU. !" !" !" !" Check the line connector. Check for line problems. Replace the FCU. Get the ID Codes the same and/or the CSIs programmed correctly, then resend. !" The machine at the other end may be defective.
4-01
4-10
Communication failed because of an ID Code mismatch (Closed Network) or Tel. No./CSI mismatch (Protection against Wrong Connections) Data construction not possible DCR timer expired Storage impossible because of a lack of memory Memory overflow Print data error when printing a substitute rx or confidential rx message SAF file access error G3 ECM - T1 time out during reception of facsimile data G3 ECM - no V.21 signal was received G3 ECM - EOR was received G3 ECM - RTC not detected
5-25 6-00
Temporary memory shortage. Test the SAF memory. Replace the FCU or optional EXMEM board Test the SAF memory. Ask the other end to resend the message. Replace the FCU. Replace the FCU. Try adjusting the rx cable equalizer. Replace the FCU.
6-05
G3 ECM - facsimile data frame not received within 18 s of CFR, but there was no line fail
6-06 6-08
G3 ECM - coding/decoding error G3 ECM - PIP/PIN received in reply to PPS.NULL G3 ECM - ERR received
6-09
!" Check the line connection. !" Check connections from the NCU to the FCU. !" Check for a bad line or defective remote terminal. !" Replace the FCU. !" Check the line connection. !" Check for a bad line or defective remote terminal. !" Replace the FCU. !" Try adjusting the rx cable equalizer Cross reference !" Rx cable equalizer - G3 Switch 07 (PSTN) !" Defective FCU. !" The other terminal may be defective. !" The other end pressed Stop during communication. !" The other terminal may be defective. !" Check for a noisy line. !" Adjust the tx levels of the communicating machines. !" See code 6-05.
SM
11
B620
ERROR CODES
Code 6-10 Meaning G3 ECM - error frames still received at the other end after all communication attempts at 2400 bps V.21 flag detected during high speed modem communication The machine resets the sequence because of an abnormal handshake in the V.34 control channel V.21 signal not stopped within 6 s Original length exceeded the maximum scan length Suggested Cause/Action Check for line noise. Adjust the tx level (use NCU parameter 01 or the dedicated tx parameter for that address). Check the line connection. Defective remote terminal. The other terminal may be defective or incompatible.
6-21
6-22
6-99 22-00
!" Check for line noise. !" If the same error occurs frequently, replace the FCU. !" Defective remote terminal. !" Replace the FCU. !" Divide the original into more than one page. !" Check the resolution used for scanning. Lower the scan resolution if possible. !" Add optional page memory. !" Wait for the files in the queue to be sent. !" Delete unnecessary files from memory. !" Transfer the substitute reception files to an another fax machine, if the machines printer is busy or out of order. !" Add an optional SAF memory card or hard disk. !" The job started normally but did not finish normally; data may or may not have been received fully. !" Restart the machine. !" Update the ROM !" Replace the FCU. !" Restart the machine. !" Replace the FCU !" Update the ROM !" Replace the FCU. !" Replace the FCU.
22-01
22-02
Tx or rx job stalled due to line disconnection at the other end The machine cannot store received data in the SAF Data read timeout during construction The machine software resets itself after a fatal transmission error occurred V.34 modem error
F0-xx
B620
12
SM
FAX SC CODES
2.2.1 OVERVIEW
When the FCU detects a Fax SC Code condition other than SC1201, it resets itself automatically (default setting). This initializes the FCU without erasing files in the SAF memory or resetting the switches. NOTE: For details on Fax SC Codes 1201, refer to the following sections. If bit 7 of System Switch 1F is changed to 1, when the FCU detects a Fax SC Code condition, it displays the code on the display and stops working until the fax unit is initialized using one of the following methods: !" Hold down the 7 and 9 keys for more than 10 s. !" Turn off the main power switch and turn it back on.
2.2.2 SC1201
When the FCU detects an unrecoverable error in the SRAM, which requires a complete SRAM initialization, the fax unit displays this SC Code and stops. There is no way to recover from this error condition without a complete SRAM initialization (all the user and service programmed data will be erased). The possible causes are: !" SRAM backup battery defect, or CN1 on the MBU is at the OFF position !" SRAM on the MBU has a physical defect
Sys Switch 1F bit 7 = 0 Automatic reset Service Call display Automatic reset
SM
13
B620
3. SERVICE TABLES
!CAUTION
Never turn off the main power switch when the power LED is lit or flashing. To avoid damaging the hard disk or memory, press the operation power switch to switch the power off, wait for the power LED to go off, and then switch the main power switch off. NOTE: The main power LED lights or flashes while the platen cover or ARDF is open, while the main machine is communicating with a facsimile or the network server, or while the machine is accessing the hard disk or memory for reading or writing data.
"#
1 . .
'#
2 Fax SP Exit
3 . 4 . 5 .
Hold down Clear/Stop for at least 3 seconds. Press the "2" key on the numeric keypad. Press the Cancel key twice to return to the copy window.
B620
14
B620
1
101
Mode No. System Switch 001 032 00 1F Ifax Switch 001 016 Printer Switch 001 016
Function Change the bit switches for system settings for the fax option ! Section 3.2 Bit Switches Change the bit switches for IFAX settings ! Section 3.2 Bit Switches Change the bit switches for printer settings for the fax option ! Section 3.2 Bit Switches Change the bit switches for communication settings for the fax option ! Section 3.2 Bit Switches Change the bit switches for the protocol settings of the standard G3 board ! Section 3.2 Bit Switches
102
00 0F
103
00 0F
104
105
00 0F
SP2-XXX (RAM)
2
101
Mode No. RAM Read/Write 001 Memory Dump 001 G3-1 Memory Dump G3-1 NCU Parameters 001 023 CC, 01 22
Function Change RAM data for the fax board directly. ! Section 3.5 Service RAM Addresses Print out RAM data for the fax board. ! Section 3.5 Service RAM Addresses NCU parameter settings for the standard G3 board. ! Section 3.3 NCU Parameters
102
103
SM
15
B620
3
101 102 103
Mode No. Service Station 001 Fax Number Serial Number 001 PSTN-1 Port Settings 001 Select Line
Function Enter the fax number of the service station. Enter the fax units serial number. Select the line type setting for the G3-1 line. If the machine is installed on a PABX line, select PABX, PABX(GND) or PABX(FLASH). Enter the PSTN access number for the G3-1 line. If the customer does not want to receive transmissions using Memory Lock on this line, turn this SP on. Change the bit switches for scanner settings for the fax option ! Section 3.2 Bit Switches
00 1F
4
101 001 002 003 004 005 006 007 001 001 002 003 004
102 103
Mode No. FCU ROM Version FCU ROM Version P/N FCU ROM Version Ver. FCU ROM Version Area FCU ROM Version Date FCU ROM Version Drer. FCU ROM Version sum. Error Codes G3-1 ROM Version G3-1 ROM Version Parts No. G3-1 ROM Version Control G3-1 ROM Version DSP
Displays the latest 64 fax error codes. Displays the G3-1 modem version.
B620
16
B620
5
101 Initialize SRAM 001 Erase All Files 001
Mode No.
Function Initializes the bit switches and user parameters, user data in the SRAM, files in the SAF memory, and clock. Erases all files stored in the SAF memory. Resets the bit switches and user parameters. Resets the bit switches and user parameters, user data in the SRAM and files in the SAF memory.
102
103
104
SP6-XXX (Reports)
6
101
Mode No. System Parameter List 001 Service Monitor Report 001 G3 Protocol Dump List G3-1 (All Communications) 002 G3-1 (1 Communication) All Files print out 001 001
Function Press the ON button to print the system parameter list. Press the ON button to print the service monitor report.
102
103
Prints the protocol dump list of all communications for the G3-1 line. Prints the protocol dump list of the last communication for the G3-1 line. Prints out all the user files in the SAF memory, including confidential messages. NOTE: Do not use this function, unless the customer is having trouble printing confidential messages or recovering files stored using the memory lock feature. The machine prints all the communication records on the report. The machine prints all communication records after the specified date.
105
106
SM
17
B620
6
107
Mode No. Log List Print out 001 All log files 002 Printer 003 SC/TRAP Stored 004 Decompression 005 Scanner 006 JOB/SAF 007 Reconstruction 008 JBIG 009 G3 CCU 010 Fax Job 011 CCU 012 Scanner Condition
Function These log print out functions are for designer use only.
SP7-XXX (Tests)
These are the test modes for PTT approval.
7
101 102 103 104 105 106 107 108 109
Function G3-1 Modem Tests G3-1 DTMF Tests Ringer G3-1 V34 (S2400baud) G3-1 V34 (S2800baud) G3-1 V34 (S3000baud) G3-1 V34 (S3200baud) G3-1 V34 (S3429baud) Message Test
B620
18
B620
BIT SWITCHES
!WARNING
Do not adjust a bit switch or use a setting that is described as Not used, as this may cause the machine to malfunction or to operate in a manner that is not accepted by local regulations. Such bits are for use only in other areas, such as Japan. NOTE: Default settings for bit switches are not listed in this manual. Refer to the System Parameter List printed by the machine.
e.g. 0000 32V34 288/264 L0100 03 04 (1) (2)(3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (1): EQM value (Line quality data). A larger number means more errors. (2): Symbol rate (V.34 only) (3): Final modem type used (4): Starting data rate (for example, 288 means 28.8 kbps) (5): Final data rate (6): Rx revel (refer to the note after this table for how to read the rx level) (7): Total number of error lines that occurred during non-ECM reception. (8): Total number of burst error lines that occurred during non-ECM reception. Note: EQM and rx level are fixed at FFFF in tx mode. The seventh and eighth numbers are fixed at 00 for transmission records and ECM reception records.
SM
19
B620
BIT SWITCHES
System Switch 00 No FUNCTION 2 Rx level calculation Example: 0000 32 V34 288/264 L 01 00 03 04 The four-digit hexadecimal value (N) after L indicates the rx level. The high byte is given first, followed by the low byte. Divide the decimal value of N by -16 to get the rx level. In the above example, the decimal value of N (= 0100 [H]) is 256. So, the actual rx level is 256/-16 = -16 dB Not used Do not change the setting. Line error mark on the If this bit is 1, a mark will be printed on the left edge received page of the page at any place where a line error occurred 0: Disabled in the data. Such errors are caused by a noisy line 1: Enabled for example. G3 communication parameter This is a fault-finding aid. The LCD shows the key display parameters (see below). This is normally disabled 0: Disabled because it cancels the CSI display for the user. 1: Enabled Be sure to reset this bit to 0 after testing. Protocol dump list output after This is only used for communication each communication troubleshooting. It shows the content of the 0: Off transmitted facsimile protocol signals. Always reset 1: On this bit to 0 after finishing testing. If system switch 09 bit 6 is at 1, the list is only printed if there was an error during the communication. Not used Do not change the setting. SP No. 1-101-001 COMMENTS
3 4
B620
20
B620
BIT SWITCHES
Modem rate
Resolution
Compression mode
336: 33600 bps 168: 16800 bps 312: 31200 bps 144: 14400 bps 288: 28800 bps 120: 12000 bps 264: 26400 bps 96: 9600 bps 240: 24000 bps 72: 7200 bps 216: 21600 bps 48: 4800 bps 192: 19200 bps 24: 2400 bps S: Standard (8 x 3.85 dots/mm) D: Detail (8 x 7.7 dots/mm) F: Fine (8 x 15.4 dots/mm) SF: Superfine (16 x 15.4 dots/mm) 21: Standard (200 x 100 dpi) 22: Detail (200 x 200 dpi) 44: Superfine (400 x 400 dpi) MMR: MMR compression MR: MR compression MH: MH compression JBO: JBIG compression (Optional mode) JBB: JBIG compression (Basic mode) ECM: With ECM NML: With no ECM A4: A4 (8.3"), no reduction B4: B4 (10.1"), no reduction A3: A3 (11.7"), no reduction 0: 0 ms/line 10: 10 ms/line 25: 2.5 ms/line 20: 20 ms/line 5: 5 ms/line 40: 40 ms/line Note: 40 is displayed while receiving a fax message using AI short protocol.
System Switch 01 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
SM
21
B620
G3 Communication Parameters
BIT SWITCHES
System Switch 02 No FUNCTION 0-1 Not used 2 Communication stall fail safe. 0: Disabled 1: Enabled 3-4 Not used. 5 Not used 6 Memory read/write by RDS to Bit 7 6 Setting 7 0 0 Always disabled 0 1 User selectable 1 0 User selectable 1 1 Always enabled
SP No. 1-101-003 COMMENTS Do not change the settings. If enabled, the machine cuts communication within one hour of a communication error but the connection remains established. Do not change the settings. Do not change the setting. (0,0): All RDS systems are always locked out. (0,1), (1,0): Normally, RDS systems are locked out, but the user can temporarily switch RDS on to allow RDS operations to take place. RDS will automatically be locked out again after a certain time, which is stored in System Switch 03. Note that if an RDS operation takes place, RDS will not switch off until this time limit has expired. (1,1): At any time, an RDS system can access the machine. SP No. 1-101-004 COMMENTS 00 - 99 hours (BCD). This setting is only valid if bits 6 and 7 of System Switch 02 are set to User selectable. The default setting is 24 hours. SP No. 1-101-005 COMMENTS Do not change the settings. 1: Each Quick dial number on the list is printed with the dedicated tx parameters (10 bytes each). The first 10 bytes of data are the programmed dedicated tx parameters; 34 bytes of data are printed (the other 24 bytes have no use for service technicians). Do not change the settings.
System Switch 03 No FUNCTION 0 Length of time that RDS is to temporarily switched on when 7 bits 6 and 7 of System Switch 02 are set to User selectable
System Switch 04 No FUNCTION 0-2 Not used 3 Printing dedicated tx parameters on Quick Dial Lists 0: Disabled 1: Enabled
4-7
Not used
System Switch 05 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.) System Switch 06 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.) System Switch 07 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.) System Switch 08 - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.)
B620
22
B620
BIT SWITCHES
System Switch 09 No FUNCTION 0 Not used 1 Inclusion of communications on the Journal when no image data was exchanged. 0: Disabled 1: Enabled 2 3 Automatic error report printout 0: Disabled 1: Enabled Printing of the error code on the error report 0: No 1: Yes Not used Power failure report 0: Disabled 1: Enabled
SP No. 1-101-010 COMMENTS Do not change the setting. 0: Communications that reached phase C (message tx/rx) of the T.30 protocol are listed on the Journal. 1: Communications that reached phase A (call setup) of T.30 protocol are listed on the Journal. This will include telephone calls. 0: Error reports will not be printed. 1: Error reports will be printed automatically after failed communications. 1: Error codes are printed on the error reports.
4 5
Conditions for printing the protocol dump list 0: Print for all communications 1: Print only when there is a communication error Priority given to various types of remote terminal ID when printing reports 0: RTI > CSI > Dial label > Tel. number 1: Dial label > Tel. number > RTI > CSI
Do not change the setting. 1: A power failure report will be automatically printed after the power is switched on if a fax message disappeared from the memory when the power was turned off last. This switch becomes effective only when system switch 00 bit 6 is set to 1. 1: Set this bit to 1 when you wish to print a protocol dump list only for communications with errors. This bit determines which set of priorities the machine uses when listing remote terminal names on reports. Dial Label: The name stored, by the user, for the Quick/Speed Dial number.
System Switch 0A No FUNCTION 0-3 Not used 4 Dialing on the ten-key pad when the external telephone is off-hook 0: Disabled 1: Enabled
5 6-7
SP No. 1-101-011 COMMENTS Do not change the settings. 0: Prevents dialing from the ten-key pad while the external telephone is off-hook. Use this setting when the external telephone is not by the machine, or if a wireless telephone is connected as an external telephone. 1: The user can dial on the machines ten-key pad when the handset is off-hook. 0: On hook dial is disabled. Do not change the settings.
SM
23
B620
BIT SWITCHES
Rev. 04/2004
System Switch 0B - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.) System Switch 0C - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.) System Switch 0D - Not used (Do not change the factory settings.) System Switch 0E No FUNCTION 0-2 Not used 3 Action when the external handset goes off-hook 0: Manual tx and rx operation 1: Memory tx and rx operation (the display remains the same) SP No. 1-101-015 COMMENTS Do not change the settings. 0: Manual tx and rx are possible while the external handset is off-hook. However, memory tx is not possible. 1: The display stays in standby mode even when the external handset is used, so that other people can use the machine for memory tx operation. Note that manual tx and rx are not possible with this setting. Do not change the settings. SP No. 1-101-016 COMMENTS This country/area code determines the factory settings of bit switches and RAM addresses. However, it has no effect on the NCU parameter settings and communication parameter RAM addresses.
4-7
Not used
System Switch 0F No FUNCTION 0 Country/area code for to functional settings (Hex) 7 00: France 11: USA 01: Germany 12: Asia 02: UK 13: Japan 03: Italy 14: Hong Kong 04: Austria 15: South Africa 05: Belgium 16: Australia 06: Denmark 17: New Zealand 07: Finland 18: Singapore 08: Ireland 19: Malaysia 09: Norway 1A: China 0A: Sweden 1B: Taiwan 0B: Switz. 1C: Korea 0C: Portugal 20: Turkey 0D: Holland 21: Greece 0E: Spain 22: Hungary 0F: Israel 23: Czech 10: Canada 24: Poland
1. Please be sure to keep the following in mind when installing the optional FAX Feature After changing the bit SW setting for the country code (system switch 0F), do not use the scroll key to go to the next bit setting. Instead, turn the main power On/Off to activate the country code setting, and then go on to the next settings.
If the scroll key is used just after the country code is set, other bits may be changed Cross reference NCU country code: SP2-103 parameter C.C.
B620
24
B620
BIT SWITCHES
System Switch 10 No FUNCTION 0 Threshold memory level for to parallel memory transmission 7
COMMENTS Threshold = is N x 128 kbytes + 256 kbytes N can be between 00 - FF(H) Default setting: 02(H) = 512 kbytes SP No. 1-101-018 COMMENTS Change this bit to 1 if the TTI overprints information that the customer considers to be important (G3 transmissions).
System Switch 11 No FUNCTION 0 TTI printing position 0: Superimposed on the page data 1: Printed before the data leading edge 1-7 Not used System Switch 12 No FUNCTION 0 TTI printing position in the main to scan direction 7
Do not change the factory settings. SP No. 1-101-019 COMMENTS TTI: 08 to 92 (BCD) mm Input even numbers only. This setting determines the print start position for the TTI and CIL from the left edge of the paper. If the TTI is moved too far to the right, it may overwrite the file number which is on the top right of the page.
System Switch 13 - Not used (Do not change the settings.) System Switch 14 - Not used (Do not change the settings.)
SM
25
B620
BIT SWITCHES
System Switch 15 No FUNCTION 0 Not used 1 Going into the Energy Saver mode automatically 0: Enabled 1: Disabled 2-3 Not used 4-5 Wait time for post message 00: 1 minute 01: 30 minutes 10: 1 hour 11: 24 hours 6 Shows user codes on reports and lists 0: Disabled 1: Enabled 7 Not used
SP No. 1-101-022 COMMENTS Do not change the setting. 1: The machine will restart from the Energy Saver mode quickly, because the +5V power supply is active even in the Energy Saver mode. Do not change the settings. The machine stays in the standby mode for the specified time if it reserves a post message in memory.
The user codes are printed on reports and lists. The default setting is "Disabled" since the user codes used for authentication should not be seen. Do not change the settings.
System Switch 16 - Not used (Do not change the settings.) System Switch 17 - Not used (Do not change the settings.) System Switch 18 - Not used (Do not change the settings.) System Switch 19 No FUNCTION 0-2 Not used 3 Selects a temporary address for the number PC-FAX #. SP No. 1-101-026 COMMENTS Do not change the settings. 0: When prefixed by #, handled only as a stored address. 1: When prefixed by #, when a digit exists that prevents handling the transaction as a Quick, Speed, or Group dialing, handles temporarily. Sets the number of jobs controlled for PC-FAX transactions. If 1 is selected (no limitations), control is relinquished to the device (standard 400, expandable to 800).
5-6 7
Number of jobs controlled for PC-FAX TX 0: 64 Jobs 1: No limitations (but conforms to device limitations) Not used Special original mode 0: Disabled 1: Enabled
Do not change the settings. Enables the user to select the special original mode from the operation panel. When the user selects this mode, the text-mode LED and the photo-mode LED light at the same time.
B620
26
B620
BIT SWITCHES
System Switch 1A - Not used (Do not change the settings.) System Switch 1B No FUNCTION 0-1 Image mode when Text is selected 00: Text 1 01: Text 2 2-3 Image mode when Photo is selected 00: Photo 1 01: Photo 2 4-6 Image mode when Special original is selected 000: Text 1 001: Text 2 010: Photo 1 011: Photo 2 100: Special 7 Not used SP No. 1-101-030 COMMENTS 00: Text 1 is the regular mode. 01: Text 2 is the sharp mode.
00: Photo 1 is the error diffusion mode. 01: Photo 2 is the dithering mode.
000: Text 1 is the regular mode. 001: Text 2 is the sharp mode. 010: Photo 1 is the error diffusion mode. 011: Photo 2 is the dithering mode. 100: Special is the dropout color mode.
System Switch 1C - Not used (Do not change the settings.) System Switch 1D No FUNCTION 0 RTI/CSI display 0: Disabled 1: Enabled 1-7 Not used SP No. 1-101-030 COMMENTS 1: RTI/CSI is displayed on the top line of the LCD panel during communication. Do not change the settings.
SM
27
B620
BIT SWITCHES
System Switch 1E No FUNCTION 0 Communication after the Journal data storage area has become full 0: Impossible 1: Possible
Action when the SAF memory has become full during scanning 0: The current page is erased. 1: The entire file is erased. RTI/CSI display priority 0: RTI 1: CSI File No. printing 0: Enabled 1: Disabled Action when authorized reception is enabled but authorized RTIs/CSIs are not yet programmed 0: All fax reception is disabled 1: Faxes can be received if the sender has an RTI or CSI
SP No. 1-101-031 COMMENTS This setting is effective only when Automatic Journal printout is enabled but the machine cannot print the report (e.g., no paper). 0: If the buffer memory of the communication records for the Journal has become full, fax communications will become impossible, to prevent overwriting the communication records before the machine prints them out. 1: If the buffer memory of the communication records for the Journal is full, fax communications are still possible. But the machine will overwrite the oldest communication records. Cross Reference !"Automatic Journal output - User switch 03 bit 7 !"Number of communication records for the Journal: 200 records (standard) 1000 records (with the Function Upgrade unit installed) 0: If the SAF memory becomes full during scanning, the successfully scanned pages are transmitted. 1: If the SAF memory becomes full during scanning, the file is erased and no pages are transmitted. This bit switch is ignored for parallel memory transmission. This bit determines which identifier, RTI or CSI, is displayed on the LCD while the machine is communicating in G3 non-standard mode. 1: File numbers are not printed on any reports.
5-7
Not used
If authorized reception is enabled but the user has stored no acceptable sender RTIs or CSIs, the machine will not be able to receive any fax messages. If the customer wishes to receive messages from any sender that includes an RTI or CSI, and to block messages from senders that do not include an RTI or CSI, change this bit to 1, then enable Authorized Reception. Otherwise, keep this bit at 0 (default setting). Do not change the setting.
B620
28
B620
BIT SWITCHES
System Switch 1F No FUNCTION 0 Not used 1 Report printout after an original jam during SAF storage or if the SAF memory fills up 0: Enabled 1: Disabled 2 3 Not used Received fax print start timing (G3 reception) 0: After receiving each page 1: After receiving all pages Not used Action when a fax SC has occurred 0: Automatic reset 1: Fax unit stops
SP No. 1-101-032 COMMENTS Do not change the setting. 0: When an original jams, or the SAF memory overflows during scanning, a report will be printed. Change this bit to 1 if the customer does not want to have a report in these cases. Memory tx Memory storage report Parallel memory tx Transmission result report Do not change the setting. 0: The machine prints each page immediately after the machine receives it. 1: The machine prints the complete message after the machine receives all the pages in the memory. Do not change the factory settings. 0: When the fax unit detects a fax SC code other than SC1201, the fax unit automatically resets itself. 1: When the fax unit detects any fax SC code, the fax unit stops. Cross Reference Fax SC codes - See Troubleshooting
4-6 7
SM
29
B620
BIT SWITCHES
Repetition of data when the received page is longer than the printer paper 0: Disabled 1: Enabled Prints the date and time on received fax messages 0: Disabled 1: Enabled Not used
3-7
Printer Switch 01 No FUNCTION 0-2 Not used 3-4 Maximum print width used in the setup protocol Bit 4 3 Setting 0 0 Not used 0 1 A3 1 0 B4 1 1 A4 5-6 Not used 7 Received message width restriction in the protocol signal to the sender 0: Disabled 1: Enabled
Do not change the settings. 0: The machine informs the transmitting machine of the print width depending on the paper size available from the paper feed stations. Refer to the table on the next page for how the machine chooses the paper width used in the setup protocol (NSF/DIS). 1: The machine informs the transmitting machine of the fixed paper width which is specified by bits 3 and 4 above.
B620
30
B620
BIT SWITCHES
Available Paper Size A4 or 8.5" x 11" B5 A5 or 8.5" x 5.5" No paper available (Paper end) Printer Switch 02 No FUNCTION 0 1st paper feed station usage for fax printing 0: Enabled 1: Disabled 1 2nd paper feed station usage for fax printing 0: Enabled 1: Disabled 2 3rd paper feed station usage for fax printing 0: Enabled 1: Disabled 3 4th paper feed station usage for fax printing 0: Enabled 1: Disabled 4-7 Not used Printer Switch 03 No FUNCTION 0 Length reduction of received data 0: Disabled 1: Enabled
Printer width used in the Protocol (NSF/DIS) 297 mm width 256 mm width 216 mm width 216 mm width SP No. 1-103-003 COMMENTS 0: The paper feed station can be used to print fax messages and reports. 1: The specified paper feed station will not be used for printing fax messages and reports. Note: Do not disable usage for a paper feed station which has been specified by User Parameter Switch 0F (15), or which is used for the Specified Cassette Selection feature.
Do not change the settings. SP No. 1-103-004 COMMENTS 0: Incoming pages are printed without length reduction. (Page separation threshold: Printer Switch 03, bits 4 to 7) 1: Incoming page length is reduced when printing. (Maximum reducible length: Printer Switches 04, bits 0 to 4) Do not change the settings
1-3
Not used
SM
31
B620
Relationship between available paper sizes and printer width used in the setup protocol
BIT SWITCHES
Printer Switch 03 SP No. 1-103-004 No FUNCTION COMMENTS 4 Page separation threshold (with reduction disabled with switch 03-0 above) to 7 If the incoming page is up to x mm longer than the length of copy paper, the excess portion will not be printed. If the incoming page is more than x mm longer than the length of copy paper, the excess portion will be printed on the next page. The value of x is determined by these four bits. Hex value of bits 4 to 7 x (mm) 0 0 1 1 and so on until F 15 Default setting: 6 mm Cross reference Length reduction On/Off: Printer Switch 03, Bit 0 Printer Switch 04 SP No. 1-103-005 No FUNCTION COMMENTS 0 Maximum reducible length when length reduction is enabled with switch 03-0 above. to <Maximum reducible length> = <Paper length> + (N x 5mm) 4 N is the decimal value of the binary setting of bits 0 to 4. Bit 4 3 2 1 0 Setting 0 0 0 0 0 0 mm 0 0 0 0 1 5 mm 0 0 1 0 0 20 mm (default setting) 1 1 1 1 1 155 mm For A5 sideways and B5 sideways paper <Maximum reducible length> = <Paper length> + 0.75 x (N x 5mm) Length of the duplicated image on the next page, when page separation has taken place.
5 to 6
& 0# &1 # & 0# &1# $ $ $ 0 =4 mm,$ $ 0 =10 mm, $1 =15 mm,$ $1 = Not used % " % " % " % "
Not used. Do not change the setting.
B620
32
B620
BIT SWITCHES
Printer Switch 06 No FUNCTION 0 Printing while a paper cassette is pulled out, when the Just Size Printing feature is enabled. 0: Printing will not start 1: Printing will start if another cassette has a suitable size of paper, based on the paper size selection priority tables. 1-7 Not used. Printer Switch 07 No FUNCTION 0-3 Not used. 4 List of destinations in the Communication Failure Report for broadcasting 0: All destinations 1: Only destinations where communication failure occurred 5-7 Not used.
Cross reference Just size printing on/off User switch 05, bit 5
Do not change the settings. SP No. 1-103-008 COMMENTS Do not change the settings. 1: Only destinations where communication failure occurred are printed on the Communication Failure Report.
Printer Switch 08 - Not used (Do not change the settings.) Printer Switch 09 - Not used (Do not change the settings.) Printer Switch 0A - Not used (Do not change the settings.) Printer Switch 0B - Not used (Do not change the settings.) Printer Switch 0C - Not used (Do not change the settings.) Printer Switch 0D - Not used (Do not change the settings.)
SM
33
B620
BIT SWITCHES
Printer Switch 0E No FUNCTION 0 Paper size selection priority 0: Width 1: Length 1 Paper size selected for printing A4 width fax data 0: 8.5" x 11" size 1: A4 size Page separation 0: Enabled 1: Disabled
SP No. 1-103-015 COMMENTS 0: A paper size that has the same width as the received data is selected first. 1: A paper size which has enough length to print all the received lines without reduction is selected first. This switch determines which paper size is selected for printing A4 width fax data, when the machine has both A4 and 8.5" x 11" size paper. 1: If all paper sizes in the machine require page separation to print a received fax message, the machine does not print the message (Substitute Reception is used). After a larger size of paper is set in a cassette, the machine automatically prints the fax message. Same size means the sample image is printed at 100%, even if page separation occurs. User Parameter Switch 19 (13H) bit 4 must be set to 0 to enable this switch. Refer to Detailed Section Descriptions for more on this feature.
3 to 4
5-6 7
Printing the sample image on reports Bit 4 Bit 3 Setting 0 0 The upper half only 0 1 50% reduction in sub-scan only 1 0 Same size 1 1 Not used Not used Equalizing the reduction ratio among separated pages (Page Separation) 0: Enabled 1: Disabled
Do not change the settings. 0: When page separation has taken place, all the pages are reduced with the same reduction ratio. 1: Only the last page is reduced to fit the selected paper size when page separation has taken place. Other pages are printed without reduction. SP No. 1-103-016 COMMENTS (0, 0) (0, 1): Disable smoothing if the machine receives halftone images from other manufacturers fax machines frequently.
Printer Switch 0F No FUNCTION 0 Smoothing feature to Bit 1 Bit 0 Setting 1 0 0 Disabled 0 1 Disabled 1 0 Enabled 1 1 Not used 2-3 Not used 4 Printing fax messages in user code mode 0: Enabled 1: Disabled
5-7
Not used
Do not change the settings. 1: The machine holds the received fax messages until the machine exits the restricted access mode (user code or key counter). If the machine enters the restricted access mode again while printing fax messages, the machine stops printing the machine exits the mode again. Do not change the settings.
B620
34
B620
BIT SWITCHES
Communication Switch 00 No FUNCTION 0 Compression modes available to in receive mode 1 Bit 1 0 Modes 0 0 MH only 0 1 MH/MR 1 0 MH/MR/MMR 1 1 MH/MR/MMR/ JBIG 2 Compression modes available to in transmit mode 3 Bit 3 2 Modes 0 0 MH only 0 1 MH/MR 1 0 MH/MR/MMR 1 1 MH/MR/MMR/ JBIG 4 Not used 5 JBIG compression method: Reception 0: Only basic supported 1: Basic and optional both supported 6 JBIG compression method: Transmission 0: Basic mode priority 1: Optional mode priority 7 Not used Communication Switch 01 No FUNCTION 0 ECM 0: Off 1: On
SP No. 1-104-001 COMMENTS These bits determine the compression capabilities to be declared in phase B (handshaking) of the T.30 protocol.
These bits determine the compression capabilities to be used in the transmission and to be declared in phase B (handshaking) of the T.30 protocol.
Do not change the setting. Change the setting when communication problems occur using JBIG compression.
Change the setting when communication problems occur using JBIG compression.
Do not change the settings. SP No. 1-104-002 COMMENTS If this bit is set to 0, ECM is switched off for all communications. In addition, V.8 protocol and JBIG compression are switched off automatically. Do not change the settings. The setting determined by these bits is informed to the transmitting terminal in the pre-message protocol exchange (in the DIS/NSF frames).
1-5 6 to 7
Not used Maximum printable page length available Bit 7 6 Setting 0 0 No limit 0 1 B4 (364 mm) 1 0 A4 (297 mm) 1 1 Not used
SM
35
B620
BIT SWITCHES
1 2
Acceptable total error line ratio 0: 5% 1: 10% Treatment of pages received with errors during G3 reception 0: Deleted from memory without printing 1: Printed Hang-up decision when a negative code (RTN or PIN) is received during G3 immediate transmission 0: No hang-up, 1: Hang-up
SP No. 1-104-003 COMMENTS If there are more consecutive error lines in the received page than the threshold, the machine will send a negative response. The Low and High threshold values depend on the sub-scan resolution, and are as follows. Resolution 100 dpi 200 dpi 400 dpi 3.85 l/mm 7.7 l/mm 15.4 l/mm Low settings 6 12 24 High settings 12 24 48 If the error line ratio for a page exceeds the acceptable ratio, RTN will be sent to the other end. 0: Pages received with errors are not printed.
0: The next page will be sent even if RTN or PIN is received. 1: The machine will send DCN and hang up if it receives RTN or PIN. This bit is ignored for memory transmissions or if ECM is being used. Do not change the settings. SP No. 1-104-004 COMMENTS 00 - FF (Hex) times. This setting is not used if ECM is switched on. Default setting - 03(H)
4-7
Not used
Communication Switch 04 - Not used (Do not change the settings.) Communication Switch 05 - Not used (Do not change the settings.) Communication Switch 06 - Not used (Do not change the settings.) Communication Switch 07 - Not used (Do not change the settings.) Communication Switch 08 - Not used (Do not change the settings.) Communication Switch 09 - Not used (Do not change the settings.)
B620
36
B620
BIT SWITCHES
Communication Switch 0A No FUNCTION 0 Point of resumption of memory transmission upon redialing 0: From the error page 1: From page 1 1-7 Not used
SP No. 1-104-011 COMMENTS 0: The transmission begins from the page where transmission failed the previous time. 1: Transmission begins from the first page, using normal memory transmission. Do not change the settings.
Communication Switch 0B - Not used (Do not change the settings.) Communication Switch 0C - Not used (Do not change the settings.) Communication Switch 0D No FUNCTION 0 The available memory to threshold, below which ringing 7 detection (and therefore reception into memory) is disabled SP No. 1-104-014 COMMENTS 00 to FF (Hex), unit = 4 kbytes (e.g., 06(H) = 24 kbytes) One page is about 24 kbytes. The machine refers to this setting before each fax reception. If the amount of remaining memory is below this threshold, the machine cannot receive any fax messages. If this setting is kept at 0, the machine will detect ringing signals and go into receive mode even if there is no memory available. This will result in communication failure. SP No. 1-104-015 COMMENTS 06 to FF (Hex), unit = 2 s (e.g., 06(H) = 12 s) This value is the minimum time that the machine waits before it dials the next destination.
SM
37
B620
BIT SWITCHES
Communication Switch 10 No FUNCTION 0 Memory transmission: to Maximum number of dialing 7 attempts to the same destination
Communication Switch 11 - Not used (Do not change the settings.) Communication Switch 12 No FUNCTION 0 Memory transmission: Interval to between dialing attempts to the 7 same destination SP No. 1-104-019 COMMENTS 01 - FF (Hex) minutes
Communication Switch 13 - Not used (Do not change the settings.) Communication Switch 14 No FUNCTION 0 Inch-to-mm conversion during transmission 0: Disabled 1: Enabled SP No. 1-104-021 COMMENTS 0: In immediate transmission, data scanned in inch format are transmitted without conversion. In memory transmission, data stored in the SAF memory in mm format are transmitted without conversion. Note: When storing the scanned data into SAF memory, the fax unit always converts the data into mm format. 1: The machine converts the scanned data or stored data in the SAF memory to the format which was specified in the set-up protocol (DIS/NSF) before transmission. Do not change the factory settings. For the best performance, do not change the factory settings. The setting determined by these bits is informed to the transmitting terminal in the pre-message protocol exchange (in the DIS/NSF frames).
1-5 6 to 7
Not used Available unit of resolution in which fax messages are received Bit 7 Bit 6 Unit 0 0 mm 0 1 inch 1 0 mm and inch (default) 1 1 Not used
B620
38
B620
BIT SWITCHES
Communication Switch 15 - Not used (Do not change the settings.) Communication Switch 16 - Not used (Do not change the settings.) Communication Switch 17 - Not used (Do not change the settings.) Communication Switch 18 - Not used (Do not change the settings.) Communication Switch 19 - Not used (Do not change the settings.) Communication Switch 1A - Not used (Do not change the settings.) Communication Switch 1B No FUNCTION 0 Extension access code (0 to 7) to to turn V.8 protocol On/Off 7 0: On 1: Off SP No. 1-104-028 COMMENTS If the PABX does not support V.8/V.34 protocol procedure, set this bit to 1 to disable V.8. Example: If 0 is the PSTN access code, set bit 0 to 1. When the machine detects 0 as the first dialed number, it automatically disables V.8 protocol. (Alternatively, if 3 is the PSTN access code, set bit 3 to 1.)
Communication Switch 1C No FUNCTION 0 Extension access code (8 and to 9) to turn V.8 protocol On/Off 1 0: On 1: Off 2-7 Not used
SP No. 1-104-029 COMMENTS Refer to communication switch 1E. Example: If 8 is the PSTN access code, set bit 0 to 1. When the machine detects 8 as the first dialed number, it automatically disables V.8 protocol. (If 9 is the PSTN access code, use bit 1.) Do not change the settings.
Communication Switch 1D - Not used (Do not change the settings.) Communication Switch 1E - Not used (Do not change the settings.) Communication Switch 1F - Not used (Do not change the settings.)
SM
39
B620
BIT SWITCHES
5 6
G3-1 Switch 02 No FUNCTION 0 G3 protocol mode used 0: Standard and non-standard 1: Standard only
1-4 5
Not used Use of modem rate history for transmission using Quick/Speed Dials 0: Disabled 1: Enabled AI short protocol (transmission and reception) 0: Disabled 1: Enabled Short preamble 0: Disabled 1: Enabled
B620
40
B620
BIT SWITCHES
G3-1 Switch 03 No FUNCTION 0 DIS detection number (Echo countermeasure) 0: 1 1: 2 1 V.8 protocol in manual reception 0: Disabled 1: Enabled 2 V.8 protocol 0: Disabled 1: Enabled
ECM frame size 0: 256 bytes 1: 64 bytes CTC transmission conditions 0: After one PPR signal received 1: After four PPR signals received (ITU-T standard)
SP No. 1-105-004 COMMENTS 0: The machine will hang up if it receives the same DIS frame twice. 1: Before sending DCS, the machine will wait for the second DIS which is caused by echo on the line. 0: The machine sends CED instead of ANSam when starting a manual reception. 1: The machine sends ANSam during manual reception. 0: V.8/V.34 communications will not be possible. Note: Do not set to 0 unless the line condition is always bad enough to slow down the data rate to 14.4 kbps or lower. Keep this bit at 0 in most cases.
0: When using ECM in non-standard (NSF/NSS) mode, the machine sends a CTC to drop back the modem rate after receiving a PPR, if the following condition is met in communications at 14.4, 12.0, 9.6, and 7.2 kbps.
Modem rate used for the next page after receiving a negative code (RTN or PIN) 0: No change 1: Fallback V.8 protocol in manual transmission 0: Disabled 1: Enabled Not used
SM
41
B620
BIT SWITCHES
G3-1 Switch 04 No FUNCTION 0 Training error detection to threshold 3 4-7 Not used
SP No. 1-105-005 COMMENTS 0 - F (Hex); 0 - 15 bits If the number of error bits in the received TCF is below this threshold, the machine informs the sender that training has succeeded. Do not change the settings. SP No. 1-105-006 COMMENTS These bits set the initial starting modem rate for transmission. Use the dedicated transmission parameters if you need to change this for specific receivers. If a modem rate 14.4 kbps or slower is selected, V.8 protocol should be disabled manually. Cross reference V.8 protocol on/off - G3 switch 03, bit2
G3-1 Switch 05 No FUNCTION 0 Initial Tx modem rate to Bit 3 2 1 0 Setting (bps) 3 0 0 0 1 2.4 k 0 0 1 0 4.8 k 0 0 1 1 7.2 k 0 1 0 0 9.6 k 0 1 0 1 12.0 k 0 1 1 0 14.4 k 0 1 1 1 16.8 k 1 0 0 0 19.2 k 1 0 0 1 21.6 k 1 0 1 0 24.0 k 1 0 1 1 26.4 k 1 1 0 0 28.8 k 1 1 0 1 31.2 k 1 1 1 0 33.6 k Other settings - Not used 4 Initial modem type for 9.6 k or to 7.2 kbps. 5 Bit 5 Bit 4 Setting 0 0 V.29 0 1 V.17 1 0 V.34 1 1 Not used 6-7 Not used
These bits set the initial modem type for 9.6 and 7.2 kbps, if the initial modem rate is set at these speeds.
B620
42
B620
BIT SWITCHES
G3-1 Switch 06 No FUNCTION 0 Initial Rx modem rate to Bit 3 2 1 0 Setting (bps) 3 0 0 0 1 2.4 k 0 0 1 0 4.8 k 0 0 1 1 7.2 k 0 1 0 0 9.6 k 0 1 0 1 12.0 k 0 1 1 0 14.4 k 0 1 1 1 16.8 k 1 0 0 0 19.2 k 1 0 0 1 21.6 k 1 0 1 0 24.0 k 1 0 1 1 26.4 k 1 1 0 0 28.8 k 1 1 0 1 31.2 k 1 1 1 0 33.6 k Other settings - Not used 4 Modem types available for to reception 7 Bit 7 6 5 4 Setting 0 0 0 1 V.27ter 0 0 1 0 V.27ter, V.29 0 0 1 1 V.27ter, V.29 V.33 0 1 0 0 V.27ter, V.29, V.17/V.33 0 1 0 1 V.27ter, V.29, V.17/V33, V.34 Other settings - Not used
SP No. 1-105-007 COMMENTS These bits set the initial starting modem rate for reception. Use a lower setting if high speeds pose problems during reception. If a modem rate 14.4 kbps or slower is selected, V.8 protocol should be disabled manually. Cross reference V.8 protocol on/off - G3 switch 03, bit2
The setting of these bits is used to inform the transmitting terminal of the available modem type for the machine in receive mode. If V.34 is not selected, V.8 protocol must be disabled manually. Cross reference V.8 protocol on/off - G3 switch 03, bit2
SM
43
B620
BIT SWITCHES
G3-1 Switch 07 No FUNCTION 0 PSTN cable equalizer to (tx mode: Internal) 1 Bit 1 Bit 0 Setting 0 0 None 0 1 Low 1 0 Medium 1 1 High
SP No. 1-105-008 COMMENTS Use a higher setting if there is signal loss at higher frequencies because of the length of wire between the modem and the telephone exchange. Use the dedicated transmission parameters for specific receivers. Also, try using the cable equalizer if one or more of the following symptoms occurs. Communication error Modem rate fallback occurs frequently. Note: This setting is not effective in V.34 communications. Use a higher setting if there is signal loss at higher frequencies because of the length of wire between the modem and the telephone exchange. Also, try using the cable equalizer if one or more of the following symptoms occurs. Communication error with error codes such as 0-20, 0-23, etc. Modem rate fallback occurs frequently. Note: This setting is not effective in V.34 communications. Do not change the settings.
2 to 3
PSTN cable equalizer (rx mode: Internal) Bit 3 Bit 2 Setting 0 0 None 0 1 Low 1 0 Medium 1 1 High
4-7
Not used
G3-1 Switch 08 - Not used (Do not change the settings.) G3-1 Switch 09 - Not used (Do not change the settings.)
B620
44
B620
BIT SWITCHES
G3-1 Switch 0A No FUNCTION 0 Maximum allowable carrier to drop during image data 1 reception Bit 1 Bit 0 Value (ms) 0 0 200 0 1 400 1 0 800 1 1 Not used 2 Non-ECM Carrier Drop 0: Maintain connection 1: Disconnect 3 Not used 4 Maximum allowable frame interval during image data reception. 0: 5 s 1: 13 s 5 6 Not used Reconstruction time for the first line in receive mode 0: 6 s 1: 12 s
SP No. 1-105-011 COMMENTS These bits set the acceptable modem carrier drop time. Try using a longer setting if error code 0-22 is frequent.
Determines how the machine will respond when it detects a drop in the carrier signal during non-ECM communication. Do not change the settings. This bit set the maximum interval between EOL (end-of-line) signals and the maximum interval between ECM frames from the other end. Try using a longer setting if error code 0-21 is frequent. Do not change the setting. When the sending terminal is controlled by a computer, there may be a delay in receiving page data after the local machine accepts set-up data and sends CFR. This is outside the T.30 recommendation. But, if this delay occurs, set this bit to 1 to give the sending machine more time to send data. Refer to error code 0-20. ITU-T T.30 recommendation: The first line should come within 5 s of CFR. Do not change the setting.
Not used
SM
45
B620
BIT SWITCHES
G3-1 Switch 0B No FUNCTION 0 Protocol requirements: Europe 0: Disabled 1: Enabled 1 Protocol requirements: Spain 0: Disabled 1: Enabled 2 Not used 3 Protocol requirements: France 0: Disabled 1: Enabled 4 PTT requirements: Germany 0: Disabled 1: Enabled 5-7 Not used G3-1 Switch 0C No FUNCTION 0 Pulse dialing method to Bit 1 Bit 0 Setting 1 0 0 Normal(P=N) 0 1 Oslo (P=10 - N) 1 0 Sweden (N+1) 1 1 Not used 2-7 Not used
SP No. 1-105-012 COMMENTS The machine does not automatically reset these bits for each country after a country code (System Switch 0F) is programmed. Change the required bits manually at installation. Do not change the setting. The machine does not automatically reset these bits for each country after a country code (System Switch 0F) is programmed. Change the required bits manually at installation. Do not change the settings. SP No. 1-105-013 COMMENTS P = Number of pulses sent out, N = Number dialed.
G3-1 Switch 0D - Not used (Do not change the settings.) G3-1 Switch 0E No FUNCTION CNG transmission OFF interval. 0 to To input a value more than 3 s, use 7 bits 3 to 0, and keep bits 4 to 7 at 0. 3000 + 50 x N ms To inpu a value less than 3 s, use bits 4 to 7, and keep bits 0 to 3 at 1. 3000 50 x N ms SP No. 1-105-015 COMMENTS Examples: 3100 ms: 50 x 2 = 100 Bits 4 to 7 must be 0 Bits 0 to 3 must be 2(H) So, enter 02H. 2800 ms: 50 x 4 = 200 Bits 0 to 3 must be F(H) Bits 4 to 7 must be 4(H) So, enter 4FH
B620
46
B620
BIT SWITCHES
G3-1 Switch 0F No FUNCTION 0 Alarm when an error occurred in Phase C or later 0: Disabled 1: Enabled 1 Alarm when the handset is offhook at the end of communication 0: Disabled 1: Enabled 2-7 Not used
SP No. 1-105-016 COMMENTS If the customer wants to hear an alarm after each error communication, change this bit to 1.
If the customer wants to hear an alarm if the handset is off-hook at the end of fax communication, change this bit to 1.
SM
47
B620
BIT SWITCHES
FAX Switch 0C No FUNCTION 0 Action when an original jam has occurred while scanning the original into memory for memory tx 0: Continues scanning after recovery 1: Stops scanning and erases all scanned pages for that job
1 to 2
3-7
Setting when an original size cannot be recognized Bit 2 1 Setting 0 0 No original 0 1 A5 ( 1 0 A5 ) 1 1 No original Not used
FAX Switch 0D No FUNCTION 0-6 Not used 7 Scan width for A5 lengthwise or B5 lengthwise originals 0: 210 mm (8.5) 1: Original width
COMMENTS Do not change the settings. 0: The machine scans the original as 210 mm (8.5") width. The transmitted image has a blank area on the right. 1: The machine scans 148 mm (A5) or 182 mm (B5) and centers the scanned data on a 216 mm width transmitted image.
B620
48
B620
BIT SWITCHES
FAX Switch 0E No FUNCTION 0 Not used 1 Scan resolution unit 0: mm 1: inches 2-7 Not used Scanner Switch 0F No FUNCTION 0 Image rotation before transmission (A4/LT sideways) 0: Disabled 1: Enabled 1 2 Not used Image rotation before transmission (A5/HLT lengthwise) 0: Disabled 1: Enabled Not used
SP No. 3-201-015 COMMENTS Do not change the settings. This bit determines which resolution unit will be used for scanning a fax message. Default setting: mm Do not change the settings. SP No. 3-201-016 COMMENTS This bit determines whether the machine rotates the scanned image by 90 degrees before transmission. If this bit is set at 1, A4 (LT) sideways images (297 mm width in the protocol) will be transmitted as A4 (LT) lengthwise images (216 mm width in the protocol). Do not change the settings This bit determines whether the machine rotates the scanned image by 90 degrees before transmission. If this bit is set at 1, A5 (HLT) lengthwise images will be transmitted as A4 (LT) width images (216 mm width in the protocol). Do not change the settings.
3-7
SM
49
B620
NCU PARAMETERS
B620
50
B620
NCU PARAMETERS
Address 680500
Unit Remarks Use the Hex value to program the country/area code directly into this address, or use the decimal value to program it using SP2-103-001 Country/Area France Germany UK Italy Austria Belgium Denmark Finland Ireland Norway Sweden Switzerland Portugal Holland Spain Israel USA Asia Hong Kong South Africa Australia New Zealand Singapore Malaysia China Taiwan Korea Greece Hungary Czech Poland 20 ms Decimal Hex 00 00 01 01 02 02 03 03 04 04 05 05 06 06 07 07 08 08 09 09 10 0A 11 0B 12 0C 13 0D 14 0E 15 0F 17 11 18 12 20 14 21 15 22 16 23 17 24 18 25 19 26 1A 27 1B 28 1C 33 21 34 22 35 23 36 24 Line current detection is disabled. Line current is not detected if 680501 contains FF. If both addresses contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled. If both addresses contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled.
Line current detection time Line current wait time Line current drop detect time PSTN dial tone frequency upper limit (high byte) PSTN dial tone frequency upper limit (low byte) PSTN dial tone frequency lower limit (high byte) PSTN dial tone frequency lower limit (low byte)
Hz (BCD)
Hz (BCD)
SM
51
B620
NCU PARAMETERS
Address 680508 680509 68050A 68050B 68050C 68050D 68050E 68050F 680510 680511 680512 680513 680514 680515 680516 680517 680518 680519 68051A 68051B 68051C 68051D 68051E 68051F 680520 680521 680522 680523 680524 680525
Function PSTN dial tone detection time PSTN dial tone reset time (LOW) PSTN dial tone reset time (HIGH) PSTN dial tone continuous tone time PSTN dial tone permissible drop time PSTN wait interval (LOW) PSTN wait interval (HIGH) PSTN ring-back tone detection time PSTN ring-back tone off detection time PSTN detection time for silent period after ring-back tone detected (LOW) PSTN detection time for silent period after ring-back tone detected (HIGH) PSTN busy tone frequency upper limit (high byte) PSTN busy tone frequency upper limit (low byte) PSTN busy tone frequency lower limit (high byte) PSTN busy tone frequency lower limit (low byte) PABX dial tone frequency upper limit (high byte) PABX dial tone frequency upper limit (low byte) PABX dial tone frequency lower limit (high byte) PABX dial tone frequency lower limit (low byte) PABX dial tone detection time PABX dial tone reset time (LOW) PABX dial tone reset time (HIGH) PABX dial tone continuous tone time PABX dial tone permissible drop time PABX wait interval (LOW) PABX wait interval (HIGH) PABX ringback tone detection time PABX ringback tone off detection time PABX detection time for silent period after ringback tone detected (LOW) PABX detection time for silent period after ringback tone detected (HIGH)
Unit 20 ms
Remarks If 680508 contains FF(H), the machine pauses for the pause time (address 68050D / 68050E). Italy: See Note 2.
20 ms 20 ms 20 ms 20 ms Hz (BCD)
If both addresses contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled. If both addresses contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled. If both addresses contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled. If both addresses contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled. If 68051B contains FF, the machine pauses for the pause time (680520 / 680521).
Hz (BCD)
Hz (BCD)
Hz (BCD)
20 ms
20 ms 20 ms 20 ms 20 ms
If both addresses contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled. If both addresses contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled.
B620
52
B620
NCU PARAMETERS
Address 680526 680527 680528 680529 68052A 68052B 68052C 68052D 68052E 68052F 680530 680531 680532 680533
Function Unit Remarks Hz (BCD) PABX busy tone frequency upper If both addresses contain limit (high byte) FF(H), tone detection is disabled. PABX busy tone frequency upper limit (low byte) Hz (BCD) PABX busy tone frequency lower If both addresses contain limit (high byte) FF(H), tone detection is disabled. PABX busy tone frequency lower limit (low byte) Busy tone ON time: range 1 20 ms Busy tone OFF time: range 1 Busy tone ON time: range 2 Busy tone OFF time: range 2 Busy tone ON time: range 3 Busy tone OFF time: range 3 Busy tone ON time: range 4 Busy tone OFF time: range 4 Busy tone continuous tone detection time Busy tone signal state time tolerance for all ranges, and number of cycles required for detection (a setting of 4 cycles means that ON-OFF-ON or OFF-ONOFF must be detected twice). Tolerance () Bit 1 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 1 1
680534 680535 680536 680537 680538 680539 68053A 68053B 68053C 68053D 68053E
Bits 7, 6, 5, 4 - number of cycles required for cadence detection Hz (BCD) If both addresses contain International dial tone frequency upper limit (high byte) FF(H), tone detection is disabled. International dial tone frequency upper limit (low byte) Hz (BCD) International dial tone frequency If both addresses contain lower limit (high byte) FF(H), tone detection is disabled. International dial tone frequency lower limit (low byte) International dial tone detection time 20 ms If 680538 contains FF, the machine pauses for International dial tone reset time the pause time (68053D / (LOW) 68053E). International dial tone reset time (HIGH) Belgium: See Note 2. International dial tone continuous tone time International dial tone permissible drop time International dial wait interval (LOW) International dial wait interval (HIGH)
SM
53
B620
NCU PARAMETERS
Address 68053F 680540 680541 680542 680543 680544 680545 680546 680547 680548 680549 68054A 68054B 68054C 68054D Function Country dial tone upper frequency limit (HIGH) Country dial tone upper frequency limit (LOW) Country dial tone lower frequency limit (HIGH) Country dial tone lower frequency limit (LOW) Country dial tone detection time Country dial tone reset time (LOW) Country dial tone reset time (HIGH) Country dial tone continuous tone time Country dial tone permissible drop time Country dial wait interval (LOW) Country dial wait interval (HIGH) Time between opening or closing the DO relay and opening the OHDI relay Break time for pulse dialing Make time for pulse dialing Time between final OHDI relay closure and DO relay opening or closing Minimum pause between dialed digits (pulse dial mode) Time waited when a pause is entered at the operation panel DTMF tone on time DTMF tone off time Tone attenuation level of DTMF signals while dialing Tone attenuation value difference between high frequency tone and low frequency tone in DTMF signals Unit Hz (BCD) Remarks If both addresses contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled. If both addresses contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled. 20 ms If 680543 contains FF, the machine pauses for the pause time (680548 / 680549).
1 ms 1 ms 1 ms 1 ms
See Notes 3, 6 and 8. SP2-103-11 See Note 3. SP2-103-12 See Note 3. SP2-103-13 See Notes 3, 6 and 8. SP2-103-14 This parameter is only valid in Europe. See Note 3 and 8. SP2-103-15 SP2-103-16 See Note 3. SP2-103-17 SP2-103-18 SP2-103-19 See Note 5. SP2-103-20 The setting must be less than 5dBm, and should not exceed the setting at 680552h above. See Note 5. SP2-103-21 See Note 5. See Note 5 Do not change the settings.
20 ms
1 ms
-N x 0.5 3.5 dBm
-dBm x 0.5
PSTN: DTMF tone attenuation level after dialling ISDN: DTMF tone attenuation level after dialling Not used
-dBm x 0.5
B620
54
B620
NCU PARAMETERS
Address 680557 680558 680559 68055A 68055B 68055C 68055D Function Time between 68054Dh (NCU parameter 14) and 68054Eh (NCU parameter 15) Not used Grounding time (ground start mode) Break time (flash start mode) International dial access code (High) International dial access code (Low) PSTN access pause time Remarks This parameter takes effect when the country code is set to France. Do not change the setting. 20 ms The Gs relay is closed for this interval. 1 ms The OHDI relay is open for this interval. BCD For a code of 100: 68055B - F1 68055C - 00 20 ms This time is waited for each pause input after the PSTN access code. If this address contains FF[H], the pause time stored in address 68054F is used. Do not set a number more than 7 in the UK. Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 dBm 0 0 0 -25.0 0 0 1 -35.0 0 1 0 -30.0 1 0 0 -40.0 1 1 0 -49.0 Bits 2, 0 - See Note 2. Do not change the settings. BCD BCD For a code of 0: 680565 - FF 680566 - F0 Do not change the settings. SP2-103-2 SP2-103-3 SP2-103-4 SP2-103-5 Unit 1 ms
68055E
68055F to 680564 680565 680566 680567 to 680571 680572 680573 680574 680575
Not used Long distance call prefix (HIGH) Long distance call prefix (LOW) Not used Acceptable ringing signal frequency: range 1, upper limit Acceptable ringing signal frequency: range 1, lower limit Acceptable ringing signal frequency: range 2, upper limit Acceptable ringing signal frequency: range 2, lower limit
1000/ N (Hz).
SM
55
B620
NCU PARAMETERS
Address 680576
Function Number of rings until a call is detected Minimum required length of the first ring Minimum required length of the second and subsequent rings Ringing signal detection reset time (LOW) Ringing signal detection reset time (HIGH) Not used
Unit 1
20 ms 20 ms 20 ms
Remarks SP2-103-6 The setting must not be zero. See Note 4. SP2-103-7 SP2-103-8 SP2-103-9 SP2-103-10 Do not change the settings. Factory setting: 500 ms
680582
Interval between dialing the last digit 20 ms and switching the Oh relay over to the external telephone when dialing from the operation panel in handset mode. Bits 0 and 1 - Handset off-hook detection time Bit 1 0 Setting 0 0 200 ms 0 1 800 ms Other Not used Bits 2 and 3 - Handset on-hook detection time Bit 3 2 Setting 0 0 200 ms 0 1 800 ms Other Not used
680583 to 6805A0 6805A1 6805A2 6805A3 6805A4 6805A5 6805A6 6805A7 6805A8
Bits 4 to 7 - Not used Not used Acceptable CED detection frequency upper limit (high byte) Acceptable CED detection frequency upper limit (low byte) Acceptable CED detection frequency lower limit (high byte) Acceptable CED detection frequency lower limit (low byte) CED detection time Acceptable CNG detection frequency upper limit (high byte) Acceptable CNG detection frequency upper limit (low byte) Acceptable CNG detection frequency lower limit (high byte)
56
Do not change the settings. BCD (Hz) If both addresses contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled. If both addresses contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled. Factory setting: 200 ms If both addresses contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled. If both addresses contain FF(H), tone
B620
BCD (Hz)
20 ms 20 ms BCD (Hz)
BCD (Hz)
B620
NCU PARAMETERS
Address 6805A9 6805AA 6805AB 6805AC 6805AD 6805AE 6805AF Function Acceptable CNG detection frequency lower limit (low byte) Not used CNG on time CNG off time Number of CNG cycles required for detection Not used Acceptable AI short protocol tone (800Hz) detection frequency upper limit (high byte) Acceptable AI short protocol tone (800Hz) detection frequency upper limit (low byte) Acceptable AI short protocol tone (800Hz) detection frequency lower limit (high byte) Acceptable AI short protocol tone (800Hz) detection frequency lower limit (low byte) Detection time for 800 Hz AI short protocol tone PSTN: Tx level from the modem PSTN: 1100 Hz tone transmission level PSTN: 2100 Hz tone transmission level PABX: Tx level from the modem PABX: 1100 Hz tone transmission level PABX: 2100 Hz tone transmission level ISDN: Tx level from the modem Hz (BCD) Unit Remarks detection is disabled. Do not change the setting. Factory setting: 500 ms Factory setting: 200 ms The data is coded in the same way as address 680533. Do not change the settings. If both addresses contain FF(H), tone detection is disabled.
20 ms 20 ms
6805B0
6805B1
Hz(BCD)
6805B2
20 ms
-N 3 dBm SP2-103-1 - N 6805B4 - 0.5N 6805B5 3.5 (dB) See Note 7. - N6805B4 - 0.5N 6805B6 3 (dB) See Note 7. - dBm - N 6805B7 - 0.5N 6805B8 (dB) - N 6805B7 - 0.5N 6805B9 (dB) The setting must be between -12dBm and 15dBm. - N 6805BA - 0.5N 6805BB (dB) - N 6805BA - 0.5N 6805BC (dB) - dBm
6805BB 6805BC
ISDN: 1100 Hz tone transmission level ISDN: 2100 Hz tone transmission level
SM
57
B620
NCU PARAMETERS
Address 6805BD
Remarks
Not used
Bits 0 to 3 Not used. Bit 4 V.34 protocol dump 0: Simple, 1: Detailed (default) Bits 5 to 7 Not used. Not used Do not change the settings. T.30 T1 timer Maximum wait time for post message 1s 0: 12 s 1: 30 s
1: Maximum wait time for post message (EOP/EOM/MPS) can be changed to 30 s. Change this bit to 1 if communication errors occur frequently during V.17 reception.
NOTES: 1. If a setting is not required, store FF in the address. 2. Italy and Belgium only RAM address 68055E: the lower four bits have the following meaning. Bit 2 - 1: International dial tone cadence detection enabled (Belgium) Bit 1 - Not used Bit 0 - 1: PSTN dial tone cadence detection enabled (Italy) If bit 0 or bit 2 is set to 1, the functions of the following RAM addresses are changed. 680508 (if bit 0 = 1) or 680538 (if bit 2 = 1): tolerance for on or off state duration (%), and number of cycles required for detection, coded as in address 680533. 68050B (if bit 0 = 1) or 68053B (if bit 2 = 1): on time, hex code (unit = 20 ms) 68050C (if bit 0 = 1) or 68053C (if bit 2 = 1): off time, hex code (unit = 20 ms) 3. Pulse dial parameters (addresses 68054A to 68054F) are the values for 10 pps. If 20 pps is used, the machine automatically compensates. 4. The first ring may not be detected until 1 to 2.5 wavelengths after the time specified by this parameter.
B620
58
B620
NCU PARAMETERS
5. The calculated level must be between 0 and 10. The attenuation levels calculated from RAM data are: High frequency tone: 0.5 x N680552/6805543.5 dBm 0.5 x N680555 dBm Low frequency tone: 0.5 x (N680552/680554 + N680553) 3.5 dBm 0.5 x (N680555 + N680553) dBm NOTE: N680552, for example, means the value stored in address 680552(H) 6. 68054A: Europe - Between Ds opening and Di opening, France - Between Ds closing and Di opening 68054D: Europe - Between Ds closing and Di closing, France - Between Ds opening and Di closing 7. Tone signals which frequency is lower than 1500Hz (e.g., 800Hz tone for AI short protocol) refer to the setting at 6805B5h. Tones which frequency is higher than 1500Hz refer to the setting at 6805B6h. 8. 68054A, 68054D, 68054E: The actual inter-digit pause (pulse dial mode) is the sum of the period specified by the RAM addresses 68054A, 68054D, and 68054E.
SM
59
B620
B620
60
B620
The initial settings of the following parameters are all FF(H) - all the parameters are disabled.
Switch 00 FUNCTION AND COMMENTS ITU-T T1 time (for PSTN G3 mode) If the connection time to a particular terminal is longer than the NCU parameter setting, adjust this byte. The T1 time is the value stored in this byte (in hex code), multiplied by 1 second. Range: 0 to 120 s (00h to 78h) FFh - The local NCU parameter factory setting is used. Do not program a value between 79h and FEh. Switch 01 No FUNCTION 0 Tx level to Bit 4 3 2 1 0 Setting 4 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 -1 0 0 0 1 0 -2 0 0 0 1 1 -3 0 0 1 0 0 -4 : : 0 1 1 1 1 -15 1 1 1 1 1 Disabled 5 Cable equalizer to Bit 7 6 5 Setting 7 0 0 0 None 0 0 1 Low 0 1 0 Medium 0 1 1 High 1 1 1 Disabled
COMMENTS If communication with a particular remote terminal often contains errors, the signal level may be inappropriate. Adjust the Tx level for communications with that terminal until the results are better. If the setting is Disabled, the NCU parameter 01 setting is used. Note: Do not use settings other than listed on the left. Use a higher setting if there is signal loss at higher frequencies because of the length of wire between the modem and the telephone exchange when calling the number stored in this Quick/Speed Dial. Also, try using the cable equalizer if one or more of the following symptoms occurs. Communication error with error codes such as 0-20, 0-23, etc. Modem rate fallback occurs frequently. Note: Do not use settings other than listed on the left. If the setting is Disabled, the bit switch setting is used.
SM
61
B620
3.4.2 PARAMETERS
COMMENTS If training with a particular remote terminal always takes too long, the initial modem rate may be too high. Reduce the initial Tx modem rate using these bits. For the settings 14.4 or kbps slower, Switch 04 bit 4 must be changed to 0. Note: Do not use settings other than listed on the left. If the setting is Disabled, the bit switch setting is used.
Do not change the settings. Refer to Appendix B in the Group 3 Facsimile Manual for details about AI Short Protocol. If the setting is Disabled, the bit switch setting is used. Do not change the settings.
B620
62
B620
Switch 03 No FUNCTION 0 Inch-mm conversion before tx to Bit 1 Bit 0 Setting 0 0 Inch-mm 1 conversion available 0 1 Inch only 1 0 Not used 1 1 Disabled 2 DIS/NSF detection method to Bit 3 Bit 2 Setting 3 0 0 First DIS or NSF 0 1 Second DIS or NSF 1 0 Not used 1 1 Disabled 4 V.8 protocol 0: Off 1: Disabled
COMMENTS The machine uses inch-based resolutions for scanning. If inch only is selected, the printed copy may be slightly distorted at the other end if that machine uses mm-based resolutions. If the setting is Disabled, the bit switch setting is used. (0, 1): Use this setting if echoes on the line are interfering with the set-up protocol at the start of transmission. The machine will then wait for the second DIS or NSF before sending DCS or NSS. If the setting is Disabled, the bit switch setting is used. If transmissions to a specific destination always end at a lower modem rate (14,400 bps or lower), disable V.8 protocol so as not to use V.34 protocol. 0: V.34 communication will not be possible. If the setting is Disabled, the bit switch setting is used. This bit determines the capabilities that are informed to the other terminal during transmission. If the setting is Disabled, the bit switch setting is used. For example, if ECM is switched on but is not wanted when sending to a particular terminal, use the (0, 0) setting. Note that V.8/V.34 protocol and JBIG compression are automatically disabled if ECM is disabled. If the setting is Disabled, the bit switch setting is used.
6 to 7
Compression modes available in transmit mode 0: MH only 1: Disabled ECM during transmission Bit 7 Bit 6 Setting 0 0 Off 0 1 On 1 0 Not used 1 1 Disabled
Switch 04 - Not used (Do not change the settings.) Switch 05 - Not used (Do not change the settings.) Switch 06 - Not used (Do not change the settings.) Switch 07 - Not used (Do not change the settings.) Switch 08 - Not used (Do not change the settings.) Switch 09 - Not used (Do not change the settings.)
SM
63
B620
680001 to 680004(H) - ROM version (Read only) 680001(H) - Revision number (BCD) 680002(H) - Year (BCD) 680003(H) - Month (BCD) 680004(H) - Day (BCD) 680006 to 680015(H) - Machines serial number (16 digits - ASCII) 680018(H) - Total program checksum (low) 680019(H) - Total program checksum (high) 680020 to 68003F(H) - System bit switches 680050 to 68005F(H) - Printer bit switches 680060 to 68007F(H) - Communication bit switches 680080 to 68008F(H) - G3 bit switches 6800D0(H) - User parameter switch 00 (SWUER_00) : Not used 6800D1(H) - User parameter switch 01 (SWUSR_01) : Not used 6800D2(H) - User parameter switch 02 (SWUSR_02)
Bit 0: Bit 1: Forwarding mark printing on forwarded messages 0: Disabled 1: Enabled Center mark printing on received copies. (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) 0: Disabled 1: Enabled Reception time printing. (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) 0: Disabled 1: Enabled TSI print on received messages 0: Disabled 1: Enabled Checkered mark printing. (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) 0: Disabled 1: Enabled Not used.
Bit 2:
Bit 3: Bit 4:
Bit 5 to 7:
B620
64
B620
6800D3(H) - User parameter switch 03 (SWUSR_03: Automatic report printout) Bit 0: Transmission result report (memory transmissions) 0: Off, 1: On Bit 1: Not used Bit 2: Memory storage report 0: Off, 1: On Bit 3: Not used Bit 4: Not used Bit 5: Transmission result report (immediate transmissions) 0: Off, 1: On Bit 6: Not used Bit 7: Journal 0: Off, 1: On 6800D4(H) - User parameter switch 04 (SWUSR_04: Automatic report printout) Bits 0 to 6: Not used Bit 7: Inclusion of a sample image on reports 0: Off, 1: On 6800D5(H) - User parameter switch 05 (SWUSR_05) Bit 0: Substitute reception when the base copier is in an SC condition 0: Enabled, 1: Disabled Bits 1 and 2: Condition for substitute rx when the machine cannot print messages (Paper end, toner end, jam, and during night mode) Bit 2 1 Setting 0 0 The machine receives all the fax messages. 0 1 The machine receives the fax messages with RTI or CSI. 1 0 The machine receives the fax messages with the same ID code. 1 1 The machine does not receive anything. Bit 3 and 4: Not used Bit 5: Just size printing 0: Off, 1: On Bit 6: Not used Bit 7: Add paper display when a cassette is empty 0: Off, 1: On 6800D6(H) - User parameter switch 06 (SWUSR_06): Not used 6800D7(H) - User parameter switch 07 (SWUSR_07) Bits 0 and 1: Not used Bit 2: Parallel memory transmission 0: Off, 1: On Bits 3 to 7: Not used
SM
65
B620
6800D8(H) - User parameter switch 08 (SWUSR_08) Bits 0 and 1: Not used. Bit 2: Authorized reception 0: Only faxes from senders whose RTIs/CSIs are specified for this feature are accepted. 1: Only faxes from senders whose RTIs/CSIs are not specified for this feature are accepted. Bits 3 to 7: Not used. 6800D9(H) - User parameter switch 09 (SWUSR_09) : Not used 6800DA(H) - User parameter switch 10 (SWUSR_0A) Bit 0: Not used Bit 1: 2 into 1 0: Off, 1: On Bit 2: Not used Bit 3: Page reduction 0: Off, 1: On Bits 4 to 7: Not used 6800DB(H) - User parameter switch 11 (SWUSR_0B) Bit 0: Not used Bit 1: Not used Bit 2: Blank sheet detection 0: On (Blank sheets are not detected.) 1: Off (The LCD indication alarms the user when a blank sheet is detected.) Bit 3 to 5: Not used Bit 6: Printout of messages received while acting as a forwarding station 0: Off, 1: On Bit 7: Not used 6800DC(H) - User parameter switch 12 (SWUSR_0C): Not used 6800DD(H) - User parameter switch 13 (SWUSR_0D): Not used 6800DE(H) - User parameter switch 14 (SWUSR_0E) Bit 0: Message printout while the machine is in Night Printing mode 0: On, 1: Off Bit 1: Maximum document length detection 0: Double letter, 1: Longer than double-letter (well log) up to 1,200 mm Bit 2: Batch transmission 0: Off, 1: On Bit 3: Fax mode settings, such as resolution, before a mode key (Copy/Fax/Printer/ Scanner) is pressed 0: Not cleared, 1: Cleared Bits 4 to 6: Not used Bit 7: Manual service call (sends the system parameter list to the service station) 0: Off, 1: On
B620
66
B620
6800DF(H) - User parameter switch 15 (SWUSR_0F) Bits 0, 1 and 2: Cassette for fax printout Bit 2 1 0 Setting 0 0 1 1st paper feed station 0 1 0 2nd paper feed station 0 1 1 3rd paper feed station 1 0 0 4th paper feed station 1 0 1 5th paper feed station Other settings Not used Bits 3 and 4: Not used Bit 5: Using the cassette specified by bits 0, 1 and 2 above only 0: On, 1: Off Bits 6 and 7: Not used 6800E0(H) User parameter switch 16 (SWUSR_10) (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) Bits 0 and 1: Not used Bit 2: Paper size selection priority for an A4 size fax message when A4/LT size paper is not available. 0: A3 has priority, 1: B4 has priority Bits 3 to 7: Not used 6800E1(H) User parameter switch 17 (SWUSR_11) Bit 0: Specifies the mode to select the group address for the IFAX function. 0: Priority Select Mode 1: All Select Mode Bit 1: Not used Bit 2: Inclusion of the Add button when a sequence of Quick/Speed dials is selected for broadcasting 0:Not needed, 1: Needed Bits 3 to 6: Not used Bit 7: Press Start key without an original when using the on hook dial or the external telephone, 0: displays Cannot detect original size. 1: Receives fax messages. 6800E2(H) - User parameter switch 18 (SWUSR_12) Bit 0: TTI date 0: Off, 1: On Bit 1: TTI sender 0: Off, 1: On Bit 2: TTI file number 0: Off, 1: On Bit 3: TTI page number 0: Off, 1: On Bits 4 and 5: TTI selection Bit 5 4 0 0 TTI 1 0 1 TTI 2 1 0 TTI off 1 1 Not used Bit 6 to 7: Not used
SM
67
B620
6800E3(H) - User parameter switch 19 (SWUSR_13) Bits 0 - 2: Not used Bit 3: 90 image rotation during B5 portrait Tx (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) 0: Off, 1: On Bit 4: Reduction of sample images on reports to 50% in the main scan and subscan directions. (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) 0: Technician adjustment (printer switch 0E bits 3 and 4), 1: 50% reduction Bit 5: Use of A5 size paper for reports (This switch is not printed on the user parameter list.) 0: Off, 1: On Bits 6 and 7: Not used 6800E4(H) - User parameter switch 20 (SWUSR_14) Bit 0: Automatic printing of the PC FAX error report 0: Off, 1: On Bit 1: Reprint the documents fail to print from PC Fax driver 0: Off, 1: On Bits 2 to 5: Store documents in memory which could not be printed from PC Fax driver Bit 5 4 3 2 Setting 0 0 0 0 0 min. 0 0 0 1 1 min. # # 1 1 1 0 14 min. 1 1 1 1 15 min. Bits 6: Not used. Bit 7: PC fax result notification mail, 0: Off, 1: On 6800E5(H) - User parameter switch 21 (SWUSR_15) Bit 0: Print E-mail Reception Notice, 0: Off, 1: On Bit 1: Respond to E-mail Reception Acknowledgement Request, 0: Off, 1: On Bit 2 and 3: Not used. Bit 4: Transmit Journal by E-Mail, 0: Off, 1: On Bit 5: Not used. Bit 6: Network error display, 0: On (Displayed), 1: Off (Not displayed) Bit 7: Transmit Error Mail Notification, 0: Off, 1: On
B620
68
B620
6800E6(H) - User parameter switch 22 (SWUSR_16): Not used 6800E7(H) User Parameter switch 23 (SWUSR_17) : Not used 6800E8(H) - User parameter switch 24 (SWUSR_18) Bits 0 and 1: File retention time (Cross reference: System switch 02 bit 4) Bit 1 0 Setting 0 0 File retention impossible 0 1 24 hours 1 0 File retention impossible 1 1 72 hours Bits 2 to 7: Not used 6800E9(H) - User parameter switch 25 (SWUSR_19) Bits 0 to 3: Not used Bit 4: RDS operation 0: Not acceptable 1: Acceptable for the limit specified by system switch 03 Note: This bit is only effective when RDS operation can be selected by the user (see system switch 02). Bits 5 to 7: Not used 6800EA to 6800EF(H) - User parameter switch 26 to 31 (SWUSR_1A to 1F), Not used 6800F0 User Parameter Switch 32 (SWUSR_20) Bit 0: Priority destination for transfer, 0: Fax number, 1: E-mail address Bits 2 to 7: Not used 680180 to 68019F(H) - Service stations fax number (SP3-101) See 68036C(H) for the type of network used for this number. 6801A0 to 6801A3(H) - Own fax PABX extension number 6801AA to 6801B3(H) - Own fax number (PSTN) 6801F8 to 68020B(H) - PSTN-1 RTI (Max. 20 characters - ASCII) - See the following note. 680237 to 680276(H) - TTI 1 (Max. 64 characters - ASCII) - See the following note. 680277 to 6802B6(H) - TTI 2 (Max. 64 characters - ASCII) - See the following note. 6802F7 to 68030A(H) - PSTN-1 CSI (Max. 20 characters - ASCII) 680333(H) - Number of PSTN-1 CSI characters (Hex) If the number of characters is less than the maximum (20 for RTI, 64 for TTI), add a stop code (FF[H]) after the last character.
SM
69
B620
680340 to 680342(H) - PSTN-1 line settings 680340 Bits 0 and 1: PSTN access method from behind a PABX. Bit 1 0 Setting 0 0 Loop start 0 1 Ground start 1 0 Flash start 1 1 Not used Bit 2: Telephone line type. 0: PSTN, 1: PABX Bits 3 and 4: Dialing type. Bit 4 3 Setting 0 0 Pulse dialing 0 1 Not used 1 0 Tone dialing 1 1 Not used Bits 4 to 7: Not used 680341: PSTN access number for loop start Access number Hex value to program (BCD) 0 F0 # # 9 F9 00 00 # # 99 99 680342 Bit 0: Transmission disabled 0: Tx and Rx, 1: Rx only Bit 1: Memory Lock reception 0: Enabled, 1: Disabled Bits 2 to 7: Not used 680360(H) Polling ID Code (Low Hex) 680361(H) Polling ID Code (High Hex) 680362(H) - Confidential ID (low - BCD) 680363(H) - Confidential ID (high - BCD) 680364(H) - Memory Lock ID (low - BCD) 680365(H) - Memory Lock ID (high - BCD)
B620
70
B620
680370 to 680377(H) - Last power off time (Read only) 680370(H) - 01(H) - 24-hour clock, 00(H) - 12-hour clock (AM), 02(H) - 12-hour clock (PM) 680371(H) - Year (BCD) 680372(H) - Month (BCD) 680373(H) - Day (BCD) 680374(H) - Hour 680375(H) - Minute 680376(H) - Second 680377(H) - 00: Monday, 01: Tuesday, 02: Wednesday, ....... , 06: Sunday 680384(H) - Optional equipment (Read only Do not change the settings) Bit 0 to 3: Not used Bit 4: Function Upgrade unit 0: Not installed, 1: Installed Bit 5 to 7: Not used 680385(H) - Optional equipment (Read only Do not change the settings) Bit 0: Function Upgrade unit 0: Not installed, 1: Installed Bit 1 to 3: Not used Bit 4: G3-2 0: Not installed, 1: Installed 680406 to 68040B(H) - Modem ROM version (Read only) 680406(H) - Part number (low) 680407(H) - Part number (high) 680408(H) - Control (low) 680409(H) - Control (high) 68040A(H) - DSP (low) 68040B(H) - DSP (high) 680466(H) - Time for economy transmission (hour in 24h clock format - BCD) 680467(H) - Time for economy transmission (minute - BCD) 680482(H) - Transmission monitor volume 00 - 07(H) 680483(H) - Reception monitor volume 00 - 07(H) 680484(H) - On-hook monitor volume 00 - 07(H) 680485(H) - Dialing monitor volume 00 - 07(H) 680486(H) - Buzzer volume 00 - 07(H) 69B000 6BA1FF(H) Latest 64 error codes (Read only) 69EEFC 69FEA3(H) Latest 20 error communication records
SM
71
B620
OVERVIEW
Rev. 04/2004
FCU
Controller
MBU
B620D902.WMF
The basic fax unit consists of two PCBs: an FCU and an MBU.
The FCU controls all the fax communications and fax features, in cooperation with the controller board. The MBU contains the ROM and SRAM.
B620
72
SM
BOARDS
4.2.1 FCU
FCU Controller
DRAM (16MB)
MBU
LINE LSD FAME SRAM (128 KB) FROM (3 MB)
Monitor Speaker
B620D901.WMF
The FCU (Facsimile Control Unit) controls fax communications, the video interface to the base copiers engine, and all the fax options.
FACE3 (Fax Application Control Engine) CPU Data compression and reconstruction (DCR) DMA control Clock generation DRAM backup control Ringing signal/tone detection FAME (Ricoh Modem) V.34, V.33, V.17, V.29, V.27ter, V.21, and V.8 LSD (Line Side Device) Data transfer Line control
SM
73
B620
4.2 BOARDS
BOARDS
DRAM The 8 MB of DRAM is shared as follows. SAF memory : 2 MB Working memory : 3 MB Page memory : 1.5 MB Memory back-up A rechargeable battery backs up the SAF memory (DRAM) for 1 hour.
4.2.2 MBU
On this board, the flash ROM contains the FCU firmware, and the SRAM contains the system data and user parameters. Even if the FCU is changed, the system data and user parameters are kept on the MBU board.
ROM 3MB flash ROMs for system software storage 2MB (16bit x 1MB) + 1MB (16bit x 512K) SRAM The 128 KB SRAM for system and user parameter storage is backed up by a lithium battery. Memory back-up A lithium battery backs up the system parameters and programmed items in the SRAM, in case the base copier's main switch is turned off. Switches
Item CN1 Description Switches the SRAM backup battery on/off.
B620
74
SM
SPECIFICATIONS
1. GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
Type: Circuit: Connection: Original Size: Desktop type transceiver PSTN PABX Direct couple Book (Face down) Maximum Length: 432 mm [17 ins] Maximum Width: 297 mm [11.7 ins] ARDF (Face up) (single sided document) Length: 128 - 1200 mm [5.0 - 47.2 ins] Width: 105 - 297 mm [4.1 - 11.7 inch] (double sided document) Length: 128 - 432 mm [5.0 - 17 inch] Width: 105 - 297 mm [4.1 - 11.7 inch] Scanning Method: Resolution: Flat bed, with CCD G3 8 x 3.85 lines/mm (Standard) 8 x 7.7 lines/mm (Detail) 8 x 15.4 line/mm (Fine) 200 x 100 dpi (Standard) 200 x 200 dpi (Detail) Transmission Time: G3: 3 s at 28800 bps; Measured with G3 ECM using memory for an ITU-T #1 test document (Slerexe letter) at standard resolution MH, MR, MMR, JBIG Group 3 with ECM V.34, V.33, V.17 (TCM), V.29 (QAM), V.27ter (PHM), V.8, V.21 (FM) G3: 33600/31200/28800/26400/24000/21600/ 19200/16800/14400/12000/9600/7200/4800/2400 bps Automatic fallback With ECM: 0 ms/line Without ECM: 2.5, 5, 10, 20, or 40 ms/line
I/O Rate:
SM
75
B620
SPECIFICATIONS
SPECIFICATIONS
Memory Capacity:
ECM: 128 KB SAF Standard: 2 MB Page Memory Standard: 4 MB (Print: 2 MB + Scanner: 2 MB)
3. MACHINE CONFIGURATION
Item Fax Option Type 2018 Handset Type 1018 Marker Type 30 Machine Code B620 B433 H903 Remarks USA only Refill ink for stamp
B620
76
SM
IFAX
TABLE OF CONTENTS
1. INSTALLATION................................................................................1
1.1 IFAX INSTALLATION ................................................................................... 1 1.2 INITIAL SETTINGS ...................................................................................... 1
2. TROUBLESHOOTING .....................................................................2
2.1 ERROR CODES FOR LAN COMMUNICATION .......................................... 2 2.2 TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES ....................................................... 7
4.3.2 SELECT/PROGRAM SUBJECT ........................................................ 30 Program/Change Menu.......................................................................... 30 Manual Input Menu ................................................................................ 30 4.3.3 MESSAGE DISPOSITION NOTIFICATION (MDN) ........................... 31 Handling Mail ......................................................................................... 32 Setting up the Receiving Party............................................................... 33 Handling Reports ................................................................................... 33 4.4 T.37 FULL MODE....................................................................................... 35 4.4.1 OVERVIEW ....................................................................................... 35 4.4.2 REGISTERING REMOTE MACHINE FEATURE............................... 35 4.4.3 SENDING DATA AND REQUEST ..................................................... 35 4.4.4 SENDING RECEIPT NOTIFICATION AND FEATURE REPORT ..... 36 4.4.5 INTERPRETING FEATURE REPORT .............................................. 37 Error Handling........................................................................................ 37 Exception Handling ................................................................................ 37
SPECIFICATIONS...............................................................................38
1. IFAX SPECIFICATIONS.............................................................................. 38
IFAX
ii
SM
IFAX INSTALLATION
1. INSTALLATION
1.1 IFAX INSTALLATION
IFAX requires the installation of the Fax Unit and the Printer/Scanner Controllers. For details about installation, please refer to the Fax Unit and the Printer/Scanner option manuals for the machine.
I-FAX 1 IFAX
SM
2. TROUBLESHOOTING
2.1 ERROR CODES FOR LAN COMMUNICATION
If an error code occurs, retry the communication. If the same problem occurs, try to solve the problem as suggested below.
Code 14-00 Meaning SMTP Send Error Cause Error occurred during sending to the SMTP server. Occurs for any error other than 14-01 to 16. For example, the mail address of the system administrator is not registered. Action Register the address of the system administrator. Set the User Parameter Switch 21 (15[H]) Bit 4 to Off.
14-01
Failed to connect to the SMTP server Check the IP address of the (timeout) because the server could SMTP/DNS server. not be found. Check the traffic on the LAN. The IP address for the SMTP Check the machine settings server is not stored in the such as the SMTP port setting, machine. DNS server setting, and so on. The DNS IP address is not registered. Network not operating correctly. SMTP server operating incorrectly. Contact the network administrator. Confirm correct SMTP server settings and operation. Contact the network administrator. Confirm correct SMTP server settings and operation. Contact the network administrator. Confirm correct SMTP server settings and operation. Contact the network administrator. Free space on the HDD of the SMTP server. Check that the mail address is correct. Contact the network administrator. Check that the e-mail the user intended to send exists on the SMTP server. Contact the network administrator. Confirm correct SMTP server settings and operation. Contact the network administrator. Confirm correct SMTP server settings and operation.
14-02
14-03
14-04
14-05 14-06
SMTP Server HDD Full SMTP Server hard disk full. (452) User Not Found on SMTP Server (551) The user does not exist locally.
14-07
14-08
IFAX
SM
14-10 14-11
14-12
14-13 14-30
14-31
14-32 14-33
14-50
SM
IFAX
14-60 14-61
Send Cancel Failed Notification Mail Send Failed for All Destinations
No action required. Correct the mail address for the PC. Contact the network administrator. Check the other error codes to determine if other errors occur at the same time. Register the name of the POP3/IMAP4 server. Register the e-mail account, user name, and password.
15-01
POP3/IMAP4 Server Not Registered POP3/IMAP4 Mail Account Information Not Registered Mail Address Not Registered DCS Mail Receive Error Connection Error
15-02
At startup, the system detected that the IP address of the POP3/IMAP4 server has not been registered in the machine. The POP3/IMAP4 mail account has not been registered. The mail address has not been registered. Error other than 15-11 to 15-18.
15-12
Authorization Error
15-13
15-14 15-15
Register the e-mail account and e-mail address. Update the firmware, update the server software. The DNS or POP3/IMAP4 server Contact the network could not be found: administrator. The IP address for DNS or Check that the DNS address is POP3/IMAP4 server is not stored correct. in the machine. Check that the POP3/IMAP4 The DNS IP address is not IP addresses are correct. registered. Confirm correct operation of Network not operating correctly. the network. POP3/IMAP4 send authorization Contact the network failed: administrator: Incorrect IFAX user name or Check that the IFAX user password. name and password are correct. Access was attempted by another device, such as the PC. Determine whether another device of the same account POP3/IMAP4 settings incorrect. attempted access at same time. Check that the POP/IMAP4 settings are correct. Occurs only during manual reception. No action required. The next Transmission cannot be received due transmission can be received as to insufficient buffer space. The soon as the other application buffer is being used for mail send or releases the buffer area. Scan-to-Email. The mail header is not standard Advise the sender to send e-mails format. For example, the Date line in the standard format. description is incorrect. The e-mail is not in standard format. Advise the sender to send e-mails There is no boundary between parts in the standard format. of the e-mail, including the header.
IFAX
SM
15-17
15-41
15-42
15-62
15-63
SM
IFAX
15-71 15-73
15-74
15-80
15-81
No action required. When destinations are used and a space opens in the buffer, the transmission will be received.
15-91
As the send to check both the transfer destination and the final destination. When destinations open, the transmission will be received.
15-92
15-93 15-94
15-95
Expand SAF memory. Ask the sender to break up the file and send the parts separately. Transaction could not complete due Initialize memory. If the problem to a malfunction of SAF memory. persists, replace the MBU. The machine rejected an incoming e- Ask the sender to correct the mail for transfer request, because the ID code. ID code in the incoming e-mail did Set IFAX SW03 Bit 3 to 1. not match the ID code registered in the machine. The machine rejected an incoming e- Inform the transfer requester that mail for transfer because the transfer this machine does not support the function was unavailable. transfer station function.
IFAX
SM
TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
1.
2.
Check that PC can connect with the machine LAN settings in the machine
3.
1.
2.
3.
E-mail server
Check that the LAN cable is connected to the machine. Check that the LEDs on the hub are lit. Check that other devices connected to the LAN can communicate through the LAN. Check the network Is the IP address settings on the PC. registered in the TCP/IP properties in the network setup correct? Check the IP address with the administrator of the network. Use the ping command At the MS-DOS prompt, on the PC to contact the type ping then the IP machine. address of the machine, then press Enter. Check the LAN Use the Network parameters function in the User Tools. Check if there is an IP If there is an IP address address conflict with other conflict, inform the PCs. administrator. Use the Network Check the LAN parameters function in the User Tools. Check if there is an IP If there is an IP address address conflict with other conflict, inform the PCs. administrator. Make sure that the Ask the administrator to machine can log into the check. e-mail server. Check that the account and password stored in the server are the same as in the machine. Make sure that the client Ask the administrator to devices which have an check. account in the server can Send a test e-mail with send/receive e-mail. the machines own number as the destination. The machine receives the returned email if the communication is performed successfully. Make sure that the PC Ask the administrator to can log into the e-mail check. server. Check that the account and password stored in the server are the same as in the machine.
SM
IFAX
TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Communication Route 2. Item E-mail server Action Make sure that the client devices which have an account in the server can send/receive e-mail. Remarks Ask the administrator to check. Send a test e-mail with the machines own number as the destination. The machine receives the returned email if the communication is performed successfully.
3.
4.
Router settings
Make sure that the e-mail address is actually used. Check that the e-mail address contains no incorrect characters such as spaces. Use the ping command to Ask the administrator of contact the router. the server to check. Check that other devices connected to the router can sent data over the router. Check whether e-mail can Inform the administrator be sent to another of the LAN. address on the same network, using the application e-mail software. Check the error e-mail message.
IFAX
SM
'WARNING
Never adjust a bit switched marked DFU or Japan Only," as this may cause the machine to malfunction or to operate in a manner that is not accepted by local regulations. Such bits are for use only in other areas, such as Japan. NOTE: Default settings for bit switches are not listed in this manual. Refer to the System Parameter List print out.
SM
When mail is sent, there is no negotiation with the receiving machine at the destination, so the sending machine cannot make a selection for the receiving capabilities (original width setting) of the receiving machine. The original width selected with this switch is used as the RX machines original width setting, and the original is reduced to this size before sending. The default is A4. If the width selected with this switch is higher than the receiving machine can accept, the machine detects this and this causes an error. Bit 7: Not Used.
IFAX
10
SM
Bit 6 Reserved
Bit 5 Reserved
Bit 3 Reserved
When mail is sent, there is no negotiation with the receiving machine at the destination, so the sending machine cannot make a selection for the receiving capabilities (resolution setting) of the receiving machine. The resolution selected with this switch is used as the RX machines resolution setting, and the original resolution is converted before sending. The default is both 200 x 100 and 200 x 200 are selected. If the resolution set with this switch is higher than the receiving fax can accept, the machine detects this and this causes an error. Bit 7: mm/inch This setting selects mm/inch conversion for mail transmission. 0: Off (No conversion) 1: On (Conversion) When on (set to 1), the machine converts millimeters to inches for sending mail. There is no switch for converting inches to millimeters. Note: Unlike G3 fax transmissions which can negotiate between sender and receiver to determine the setting, mail cannot negotiate between terminals; the mm/inch selection is determined by the sender fax. Only two choices are available for transmission: inch statements and inch images, or inch statements and mm images. When this switch is Off (0): Images scanned in inches are sent in inches. Images scanned in mm are sent in mm. Images received in inches are transmitted in inches. Images received in mm are transmitted in mm. When this switch is On (1): Images scanned in inches are sent in inches. Images scanned in mm are converted to inches. Images received in inches are transmitted in inches. Images received in mm are converted to inches.
SM
11
IFAX
IFAX
SP 1102 2
IFAX SW 01 Bits 0~ 6: Original Line Resolution of TX Attachment File This setting sets the maximum resolution of the original that the destination can receive. 0: Not selected 1: Selected Note: If more than one of these three bits is set to 1, the higher resolution has priority. For example, if both Bit 3 and Bit 2 are set to 1 then the resolution is set for 300 x 300 (Bit 3).
SP 1102 3
IFAX SW 02 Bit 0: RX Text Mail Header Processing This setting determines whether the header information is printed with text e-mails when they are received. 0: Prints only text mail. 1: Prints mail header information attached to text mail. When a text mail is received with this switch On (1), the From address and Subject address are printed as header information. When a mail with only binary data is received (a TIFF-F file, for example), this setting is ignored and no header is printed. Bit 1: Output from Attached Document at E-mail TX Error This setting determines whether only the first page or all pages of an e-mail attachment are printed at the sending station when a transmission error occurs. This allows the customer to see which documents have not reached their intended destinations if sent to the wrong e-mail addresses, for example. 0: Prints 1st page only. 1: Prints all pages. Bits 2~3: Text String for Return Receipt This setting determines the text string output for the Return Receipt that confirms the transmission was received normally at the destination. 00: Dispatched Sends from PC mail a request for a Return Receipt. Receives the Return Receipt with dispatched in the 2nd part: Disposition: Automatic-action/MDN-send automatically; dispatched The dispatched string is included in the Subject string. 01: Displayed Sends from PC mail a request for a Return Receipt. Receives the Return Receipt with displayed in the 2nd part: Disposition: Automatic-action/MDN-send automatically; displayed The displayed string is included in the Subject string. 10: Reserved 11: Reserved Note: A mail requesting a Return Receipt sent from an IFAX with this switch set to 00 (for dispatched) received by Microsoft Outlook 2000 may cause an error. If any setting other than displayed (01) causes a problem, change the setting to 01 to enable normal sending of the Return Receipt. Bits 4~6: Not Used. Bit 7: Image Resolution of RX Text Mail This setting determines the image resolution of the received mail. 0: 200 x 200 1: 400 x 400 Note: The 1 setting requires installation of the Function Upgrade Card in order to have enough SAF (Store and Forward) memory to receive images at 400 x 400 resolution.
IFAX
12
SM
SP 1102 5
IFAX SW 04 Bit 0: Subject for Delivery TX/Memory Transfer This setting determines whether the RTI/CSI registered on this machine or the RTI/CSI of the originator is used in the subject lines of transferred documents. 0: Puts the RTI/CSI of the originator in the Subject line. If this is used, either the RTI or CSI is used. Only one of these can be received for use in the subject line. 1: Puts the RTI/CSI registered on this machine in the Subject line. When this switch is used to transfer and deliver mail to a PC, the information in the Subject line that indicates where the transmission originated can be used to determine automatically the destination folder for each e-mail. Bits 1~7: Not Used IFAX SW 05 Bit 0: Mail Addresses of SMTP Broadcast Recipients Determines whether the e-mail addresses of the destinations that receive transmissions broadcasted using SMTP protocol are recorded in the Journal. For example: 1st destination + Total number of destinations: 9 in the Journal indicates a broadcast to 9 destinations. 0: Not recorded 1: Recorded Bits 1~7: Not Used IFAX SW 06 Not Used
SP 1102 6
SP 1102 7
SP 1102 8
IFAX SW 07 Not Used IFAX SW 08 Bits 0~7: Memory Threshold for POP Mail Reception This setting determines the amount of SAF (Store and Forward) memory. (SAF stores fax messages to send later for transmission to more than one location, and also holds incoming messages if they cannot be printed.) When the amount of SAF memory available falls below this setting, mail can no longer be received; received mail is then stored on the mail server. 00-FF (0 to 1024 KB: HEX) Note: The hexadecimal number you enter is multiplied by 4 KB to determine the amount of memory.
SP 1102 9
SM
13
IFAX
IFAX
SP 1102 4
SP 1102 10
IFAX SW 09 Bits 0~3: Not Used Bits 4~7: Restrict TX Retries This setting determines the number of retries when connection and transmission fails due to errors. 01-F (1-15 Hex) IFAX SW 0A Not Used. IFAX SW 0B Not Used.
SP 1102 11
SP 1102 12
SP 1102 13
SP 1102 14
SP 1102 15
SP 1102 16
IFAX SW 0F Bit 0: Delivery Method for SMTP RX Files This setting determines whether files received with SMTP protocol are delivered or output immediately. 0: Off. Files received via SMTP are output immediately without delivery. 1: On. Files received via SMTP are delivered immediately to their destinations. Bits 1~7: Not Used
IFAX
14
SM
User Name
ASC: 64 bytes
6A002E
Password
ASC: 64 bytes
6A00EE
6A01AE 6A01B2
2 bytes
6A0232
SM
15
INTERNET FAX
IFAX
16
SM
INTERNET FAX
These functions are not supported by e-mail transmission: Immediate Transmission Chain Dial On Hook Dial Manual Dial JBIG Transmission Batch Transmission ECM (Error Correction Mode) These functions are not supported by e-mail reception: Memory Lock Reception Preventing nuisance faxes by destination
SM
17
IFAX
IFAX
The following functions are supported with standard fax transmission, but not with Internet faxing.
Internet
IFAX
Router LAN
IFAXD601.WMF
Data Formats The scanned data is converted into a TIFF-F formatted file (only MH compression can be used).
The fields of the e-mail and their contents are as follows:
Field From Reply To To Bcc Subject Content Type Content Transfer Encoding Message Body Content Mail address of the sender Destination requested for reply Mail address of the destination Backup mail address From CSI or RTI (Fax Message No. xxxx) Multipart/mixed Attached files: image/tiff Base 64, 7-bit, 8-bit, Quoted Printable MIME-converted TIFF-F (MIME standards specify how files are attached to e-mail messages)
IFAX
18
SM
Errors An error report is generated if an error occurs during communication between the machine and the SMTP server. However, it is possible that the sender will not receive reports of errors that occurred between the SMTP server and the receiving terminal.
The interval between attempts to resend mail to the same destination when an SMTP error occurs is the same as for G3 fax transmission. To view what happens when an error occurs when the machine is receiving, refer to the Mail Reception section.
Results The transmission result is listed in the Journal. The file list for e-mail transmissions is created in the same way as for G3 memory transmissions. The TTI for the mail message includes the word Mail at the head of the information in the TTI column. Selectable Options These options are available for selection: With the default settings, the scan resolution can be either standard or detail. Inch-mm conversion before TX depends on IFAX SW01 Bit 7. Detail resolution will be used if Super Fine resolution is selected, unless Fine resolution is enabled with IFAX SW01. The requirements for originals (document size, scan width, and memory capacity) are the same as for G3 fax memory tx. The default compression is TIFF-F format. IFAX SW00: Acceptable paper widths for sending IFAX SW09: Maximum number of attempts to the same destination Secure Internet Transmission
To transmit e-mail via the Internet more securely, use SMTP authentication, and POP before SMTP for IFAX. SMTP Authentication: SMTP Authentication requires user authentication before they can access the server. This prevents unauthorized access to the server. To use SMTP authentication, your server must support CRAM-MD5, PLAIN, or LOGIN. The account name and password specified in the Mail Server settings are used for SMTP authentication. Other account names and passwords cannot be specified. To set up SMTP Authentication: User Tools> System Settings> File Transfer> SMTP Authentication POP Before SMTP: Prevents unauthorized access to the SMTP server and requires users to access and log onto the POP3 server before sending e-mail. To set up POP Before SMTP: User Tools> System Settings> File Transfer> POP Before SMTP
SM
19
IFAX
IFAX
SMTP Server
IFAX
This machine supports three types of e-mail reception: POP3 (Post Office Protocol Ver. 3.) IMAP4 (Internet Messaging Access Protocol) SMTP (Simple Mail Transfer Protocol)
IFAX
20
SM
Setting Method
The following settings are required for SMTP receiving: The IFAX must be registered as an SMTP server in the MX record of the DNS server, and the address of the received mail must specify the IFAX. Enable SMTP reception: User Tools> System Settings> File Transfer> Reception Protocol Even if the MX record on the DNS server includes the IFAX, mail cannot be received with SMTP until SMTP reception is enabled: However, if SMTP reception is selected and the machine is not registered in the MX record of the DNS server, then either IMAP4 or POP3 is used, depending on the setting: User Tools> System Settings> File Transfer> Reception Protocol
SM
21
IFAX
SMTP Reception Characteristics Expanded RX mail delivery: The Off Ramp Gateway feature allows expansion for RX mail delivery to a G3 fax. The machine transfers incoming mail is sent to the G3 fax specified by the local part. For example, in a destination address specified as: [email protected]
the local part is 0454778907. A POP3/IMAP4 server is not required: For example, in an environment where there is only a UNIX server or in an intranet environment where Notes is used for mail, mail received from outside is handled via the SMTP gateway. Immediacy of response is slightly better: There is no interval in the acquisition of mail as with POP3/IMAP4, thus slightly improving the response time. Easier error handling: When an error occurs with POP3/IMAP4, the receiving terminal sends an error mail back to the sender in order to inform them that an error has occurred. With SMTP mail reception, however, in almost all cases the SMTP server sends the error mail to the sender.
IFAX
22
SM
Overview
DNS
SMTP
SMTP
IFAX
IFAX
R
Switching Station
IFAXD901.WMF
SM
23
IFAX
Example: fax=#[email protected]
Example: fax=#**[email protected]
Mail Delivery Conditions 1) The machine must be set up for SMTP mail delivery: User Tools> Facsimile Features> E-mail Settings> SMTP RX File Delivery Settings 2) If the user wishes to limit this feature so that the machine will only deliver mail from designated senders, the machines Auth. E-mail RX feature must be selected (User Tools> Facsimile Features> E-mail Settings> SMTP RX File Delivery Settings). 3) If the SMTP RX File Delivery Setting is set to 0 to prohibit SMTP receiving, and if there is mail designated for delivery, then the machine responds with an error. (User Tools> Facsimile Features> E-mail Settings> SMTP RX File Delivery Settings) 4) The fax= setting does not distinguish between upper and lower case letters. 5) More than one destination cannot be specified in the mail address. A Group counts as 1 destination. 6) If the quick dial, speed dial, or group dial entry is incorrect, the mail transmission is lost, and the IFAX issues an error to the SMTP server and outputs an error report.
IFAX
24
SM
Auth. E-mail RX
In order to limit access to mail delivery with IFAX, the addresses of senders must be limited using the Access Limit Entry. Only one entry can be registered. 1) Access Limit Entry For example, to limit access to @IFAX.ricoh.co.jp: [email protected] [email protected] [email protected] Matches and is delivered. Does not match and is not delivered. Does not match and is not delivered.
IFAX
2) Conditions The length of the Access Limit Entry is limited to 127 characters. If the Access Limit Entry address and the mail address of the incoming mail do not match, the incoming mail is discarded and not delivered, and the SMTP server responds with an error. However, in this case an error report is not output. If the Access Limit Entry address is not registered, and if the incoming mail specifies a delivery destination, then the mail is delivered unconditionally.
SM
25
IFAX
Handling Mail Reception Errors Errors during POP3/IMAP4 procedures When an error of this type occurs, the machine stops receiving and the message stays in the server. An error report is output. After a prescribed interval, the machine calls the server and starts to receive, starting with the interrupted message. If there is an incomplete received message in memory, it will be erased. Abnormal files When an error of this type occurs, the machine stops receiving and commands the server to erase the message. Then the machine prints an error report and sends information about the error by e-mail to the sender address (specified in the From or Reply-to field of the message). If there is an incomplete received message in the machine memory, it will be erased.
The machine prints an error message when it fails to send the receive error notification after a certain number of attempts. The following types of files are judged to be abnormal if one or more of the following are detected: 1. Unsupported MIME headers. Supported types of MIME header
Header Content-Type Charset Content-Transfer-Encoding Supported Types Multipart/mixed, text/plain, message/rfc822 Image/tiff US-ASCII, ISO 8859 X. Other types cannot be handled, and some garbage may appear in the data. Base 64, 7-bit, 8-bit, Quoted Printable
2. MIME decoding errors 3. File format not recognized as TIFF-F format 4. Resolution, document size, or compression type cannot be accepted
Remaining SAF capacity error The machine calls the server but does not receive e-mail if the remaining SAF capacity is less than a certain value (the value depends on IFAX Switch 08. The email will be received when the SAF capacity increases (for example, after substitute reception files have been printed). The error handling method for this type of error is the same as for Abnormal files.
If the capacity of the SAF memory drops to zero during reception, the machine operates in the same way as when receiving an abnormal file (refer to Abnormal files above).
IFAX
26
SM
Printing Received Mail To print received e-mail: The machine detects whether it has received a TIFF-F format image, then prints it. Text in US ASCII or ISO 8859 X format can also be printed. When a line of text is longer than the paper width, the excess data will be truncated and lost. Multi-part Messages When a multi-part e-mail message contains several text parts and binary files, the message will be divided by boundaries, and each portion will be printed separately. If the machine cannot determine where the boundary is, it will print an error report, and then send error information e-mail back to the sender. Manual e-mail reception
The manual e-mail reception function can be stored in a Quick Operation Key. When the key is pressed, the machine calls the POP3/IMAP4 server immediately. The timer for automatic e-mail reception is not reset when the machine calls the POP3/IMAP4 server manually. Here is an example of the sequence Automatic e-mail reception interval: 30 minutes. The machine calls the POP3 server (automatic e-mail reception) 10 minutes later, the user calls the POP3 server (manual e-mail reception) The machine will call the POP3 server again automatically after 20 minutes. Secure Internet Reception APOP. Passwords are encrypted when e-mail is received, making it safer than POP3 authentication (clear text), which is not encrypted. APOP requires a POP server that supports APOP. IMAP-AUTH (Mail Reception). If the IMAP Server supports the AUTHENTICATE command (CRAM-MD5, PLAIN, or LOGIN confirmation), then higher-level security confirmation can be implemented for users logging in. To enable password encryption and higher level security: User Tools> System Settings> File Transfer> POP3/IMAP4 Settings> Encryption (set to On)
SM
27
IFAX
IFAX
SMT P Server
IFAXD913.WMF
The machine can send the same message to several destinations in one operation. Some destinations can be G3 faxes and others can be e-mail. For the G3 fax transmissions, each address has to be dialed separately. However, all e-mail addresses can be sent with the message to the SMTP server in one transmission. The SMTP server then sends the message to each destination. The following example for broadcasting to three e-mail destinations and two G3 fax destinations shows how G3 fax messages are each sent individually. However, the e-mail destinations are all sent to the server at the same time. Order of inputting the addresses at the operation panel G3 fax (1) - mail (1) - G3 fax (2) - mail (2) - mail (3) Order of transmission G3 fax (1) - mail (1), (2), (3) - G3 fax (2) The SMTP server cannot broadcast the message if the message contents included individual information for each terminal in the transmitted data (such as a label insertion). If this type of feature is used, the machine sends the e-mails to the server one by one. With the default settings, up to 500 destinations (including both e-mail and G3 fax) can be dialed for one broadcast. The maximum number of e-mail destinations in a broadcast depends on the limitations of the mail server.
IFAX
28
SM
!
--Entry Condition 1. CSI (RTI) 2. RTI 3. CSI 4. None 1. CSI (RTI) 2. RTI From 3. CSI 4. None RTI or CSI of the station designated for delivery RTI or CSI of sender Mail address of sender Mail address of sender
"
CSI not registered RTI not registered CSI, RTI not registered
#
Fax Message No. + File No. Normal: Return Receipt (dispatched). You can select displayed with IFAX SW02 Bits 2 and 3. Error: Return Receipt (processed/error)
Confirmation of Reception
CSI not registered RTI not registered CSI, RTI not registered Mail delivery Mail sending from G3 memory Memory sending SMTP receiving and delivery (Off Ramp Gateway)
From
---
IFAXD919.WMF
SM
29
IFAX
OK
OK
IFAXD922.WMF
IFAXD923.WMF
[A] The asterisk ($) [A] indicates that the entry is not specified.
IFAXD924.WMF
IFAX
30
SM
Internet
Server R outer Modem
%
IFAX R eception Confirmation O ptioin O n SF2@ dom1g.ricoh.co.jp
R
M ail (R equest receive respone)
&
IFAX
s_tadasi@ abcde.ne.jp
%
Time 10:17AM AD DR ESS
s_tadasi@ abcde.ne.jp
(
IFAX T X M anagem ent R eport C onfirmation (TX M anagement R eport)
'
IFAX
'
Time 10:18AM AD D RESS
SF2@ dom1g.ricoh
(
Time 10:17AM AD D RESS
s_tadasi@ abcde.ne.jp
IFAXD920.WMF
SM
31
Date X-Mailer MIME-Version Content-Type To Message-ID From Subject X-Mozilla-status X-Mozilla-Status2 X-UIDL
: : : : : : : : : : :
This is a Return Receipt for the mail that you sent to [email protected] Final Receipt: rfc822:fuser_01#dom1g.ricoh.co.jp Original Message ID: <[email protected] Disposition: automatic action/MDN-send-automatically: dispatched Respond Mail Text
IFAX
32
SM
Handling Reports
1. Sending a Request for a Return Receipt by Mail After the mail sender transmits a request for a return receipt, the mail senders journal is annotated with two hyphens (--) in the Result column and a Q in the Mode column. 2. Mail Receipt (Request for Receipt Confirmation) and Sending Mail Receipt Response After the mail receiver sends a response to the request for a return receipt, the mail receivers journal is annotated with two hyphens (--) in the Result column and an A in the Mode column. 3. Receiving the Return Receipt Mail After the mail sender receives a return receipt, the information in the mail senders journal about the receipt request is replaced, i.e. the journal is annotated with OK in the Result column. When the return receipt reports an error, the journal is annotated with an E in the Result column. The arrival of the return receipt is not recorded in the journal as a separate communication. Its arrival is only reported by the presence of OK or E in the Result column. If the mail address used by the sender specifies a mailing list (i.e., a Group destination; the machine sends the mail to more than one location. See How to set up Mail Delivery), the Result column of the Journal is updated every time a return receipt is received. For example, if the mailing list was to 5 destinations, the Result column indicates the result of the communication with the 5th destination only. The results of the communications to the first 4 destinations are not shown. Exceptions: If one of the communications had an error, the Result column will indicate E, even if subsequent communications were OK. If two of the communications had an error, the Journal will indicate the destination for the first error only.
SM 33 IFAX
Report Sample
DATE MAY. 5 TIME 10:15 10:16 10:17 10:19 ADDRESS fuser_01@dom1g. ricoh. co. fuser_01@dom1g. ricoh. co. MODE Mail SM TIME 0'09" PAGE 2 1 2 1 RESULT --OK --
s_tadashi@dom1g. ricoh. co. Mail SMQ 0'09" m_masataka@dom1g. ricoh. co. Mail SMA 0'05"
IFAXD921.WMF
IFAX
34
SM
4.4.1 OVERVIEW
SM
IFAXD925.WMF
5. Resolution: 200 x 100, 200, 200 x 400, and 400 dpi are supported. (200 x 400 and 400 dpi can be restricted by environment.) 6. Paper Size: A4, B4, A3, Letter, and Legal are supported. (Paper size can be affected by status of paper trays.) 7. User Agent Media: Availability of cut paper is indicated. Shown below is an example of the Media Accept Features field.
(&(image-file-structure=TIFF-minimal) (MRC-mode=0) (color=Binary) (image-coding=[MH,MR,MMR]) (| (& (dpi=200) (dpi-xyratio=[200/100,1,200/400]) ) (& (dpi=400) (dpi-xyratio=1) ) ) (size-x<=2970/254) (paper-size=[A4,B4,A3,letter,legal]) (ua-media=stationery) )
IFAX
36
SM
Exception Handling
If one or two of Image Coding, Resolution, and Paper Size are not defined (if only one or two of them are defined), the local machine registers the defined parameters. Undefined parameters are set to the default () 4.4.2). If multiple combinations are defined for Image Coding, Resolution, and Paper Size (for example, "200/400 dpi for A4" and "200 dpi for A3"), the local machine interprets them in the following order: 1) Paper Size: The local machine regards all paper sizes as supported. 2) Resolution: The local machine regards the common parameters as supported. In the case of the above example ("200/400 dpi for A4" and "200 dpi for A3"), "200 dpi" is regarded as supported. 3) Image Coding: The local machine regards the common parameters as supported.
SM
37
IFAX
SPECIFICATIONS
SPECIFICATIONS
1. IFAX SPECIFICATIONS
Type Fax Unit and Printer/Scanner Unit Connectivity Local area network Ethernet 100base-Tx/10base-T Connection 100base-Tx/10base-T direct connection Resolution Main scan: 200 dpi Sub scan: 400 dpi, 200 dpi, 100 dpi NOTE: To use 200 x 400 dpi, IFAX SW01 Bit 2 must be set to "1." Transmission Time 1 s (through a LAN to the server) Condition: ITU-T #1 test document (Selerexe Letter) MTF correction: OFF TTI: None Resolution: 200 x 100 dpi Communication speed: 10 Mbps Correspondent device: E-mail server Line conditions: No terminal access Document Size Maximum message width is A4/LT. Note: To use B4 and A3 width, IFAX SW00 Bit 1 (B4) and/or Bit 2 (A3) must be set to 1. E-mail File Format Single/multi-part MIME conversion Image: TIFF-F (MH) format only Protocol (Supported by TCP/IP protocol) Transmission: IETF RFC821 SMTP procedure Reception: IETF RFC1725 POP3 procedure IETF RFC2026 IMAP4 procedure Data rate 100 Mbps(100base-Tx) 10 Mbps (10base-T)
IFAX
38
SM
Trademarks Microsoft, Windows, and MS-DOS are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and /or other countries. PostScript is a registered trademark of Adobe Systems, Incorporated. PCL is a registered trademark of Hewlett-Packard Company. Ethernet is a registered trademark of Xerox Corporation. Other product names used herein are for identification purposes only and may be trademarks of their respective companies. We disclaim any and all rights involved with those marks.
PRINTER/SCANNER B622
TABLE OF CONTENTS
1. INSTALLATION................................................................................1 2. TROUBLESHOOTING .....................................................................2
2.1 CONTROLLER ERRORS............................................................................. 2 2.2 LEDS AND TEST POINTS ........................................................................... 2
3. SERVICE TABLES...........................................................................3
3.1 SERVICE PROGRAM MODE....................................................................... 3 3.1.1 ENABLING AND DISABLING SERVICE PROGRAM MODE .............. 3 Entering the SP mode.............................................................................. 3 Exiting the Service Mode ......................................................................... 3 3.2 PRINTER SERVICE MODE ......................................................................... 4 3.2.1 SERVICE MODE TABLE..................................................................... 4 3.2.2 BIT SWITCH PROGRAMMING ........................................................... 4 3.2.3 SP MODES RELATED TO PRINTER CONTROLLER ........................ 5 3.3 SCANNER SERVICE MODE........................................................................ 6 3.3.1 SCANNER PROGRAM MODE TABLE................................................ 6 3.4 FIRMWARE UPDATE PROCEDURE........................................................... 7 3.5 POWER-ON SELF TEST ............................................................................. 7 3.6 SELF DIAGNOSTIC TEST ........................................................................... 7 3.7 USER PROGRAM MODE ............................................................................ 7
System Requirements............................................................................ 14 4.5.2 IEEE1394 .......................................................................................... 14 4.5.3 BLOCK DIAGRAM............................................................................. 15 4.5.4 PIN ASSIGNMENT ............................................................................ 15 4.5.5 REMARKS ABOUT THIS INTERFACE KIT....................................... 16 4.5.6 TROUBLESHOOTING NOTES ......................................................... 16 4.6 IEEE 802.11B (WIRELESS LAN) ............................................................... 17 4.6.1 SPECIFICATIONS............................................................................. 17 LED Indicators ....................................................................................... 17 4.6.2 TRANSMISSION MODES ................................................................. 18 Ad Hoc Mode ......................................................................................... 18 Infrastructure Mode................................................................................ 18 4.6.3 SECURITY FEATURES .................................................................... 19 Using the SSID in Ad hoc mode ............................................................ 19 4.6.4 WIRELESS LAN TROUBLESHOOTING NOTES .............................. 20 Communication Status........................................................................... 20 Channel Settings ................................................................................... 20 Troubleshooting Procedure.................................................................... 21 4.7 BLUETOOTH.............................................................................................. 22 4.7.1 SPECIFICATIONS............................................................................. 22 4.7.2 BLUETOOTH PROFILES .................................................................. 23 4.7.3 BLUETOOTH SECURITY FEATURES.............................................. 23 4.8 USB ............................................................................................................ 24 4.8.1 SPECIFICATIONS............................................................................. 24 4.8.2 USB 1.1/2.0 ....................................................................................... 24 4.8.3 USB CONNECTORS......................................................................... 25 4.8.4 PIN ASSIGNMENT ............................................................................ 25 4.8.5 REMARKS ABOUT USB ................................................................... 26 Related SP Mode................................................................................... 26
SPECIFICATIONS...............................................................................27
1 GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS....................................................................... 27 1.1 PRINTER.............................................................................................. 27 1.2 SCANNER ............................................................................................ 27 2 SOFTWARE ACCESSORIES ....................................................................... 28 2.1 PRINTER.............................................................................................. 28 PRINTER DRIVERS .............................................................................. 28 UTILITY SOFTWARE ............................................................................ 28 2.2 SCANNER ............................................................................................ 29 SCANNER DRIVER............................................................................... 29 SCANNER UTILITIES............................................................................ 29 3 MACHINE CONFIGURATION ....................................................................... 30 3.1 SYSTEM COMPONENTS .................................................................... 30
B622
ii
SM
INSTALLATION
1. INSTALLATION
Please refer to section 1 of the main unit service manual.
B622
CONTROLLER ERRORS
2. TROUBLESHOOTING
2.1 CONTROLLER ERRORS
Refer to section 4. of the main unit service manual for descriptions on SC code information because the GW architecture includes controller SC codes in the main unit SC code table.
B622
SM
3. SERVICE TABLES
3.1 SERVICE PROGRAM MODE !CAUTION
Before accessing the service menu, do the following: Confirm that there is no print data in the printer buffer (the Data In LED must not be lit or blinking). If there is data in the buffer, wait until all data has been printed.
!CAUTION
Never turn off the main power switch when the power LED is lit or flashing. To avoid damaging the hard disk or memory, press the operation power switch to switch the power off, wait for the power LED to go off, and then switch the main power switch off. The main power LED ( ) lights or flashes while the platen cover or ARDF is open, while the main unit is communicating with a facsimile or the network server, or while the machine is accessing the memory for reading or writing data.
SM
B622
Sw#1 3. Adjust the bit switch using the following keys. Bit0 [] []: Move to the next bit. [Escape]: Exit without saving changes. [Enter]: Exit and save changes. The left digit on the display is bit 7 and the right digit is bit 0. 4. Press [Enter] to save changes and exit.
00000000 _
Bit Switch 1
Bit Switch 01 - Not used (do not change any of these settings)
Bit Switch 2
Bit Switch 02 No Description 0-2 Not used PDL Sniffing 3 Function Do not change the setting. PDL Sniffing with Multiple PDLs 0: Enabled (default) 1: Disabled Do not change the setting.
4-7
Not used
B622
SM
Bit Switch 3
Bit Switch 03 - Not used (do not change any of these settings)
Bit Switch 4
Bit Switch 04 - Not used (do not change any of these settings)
Bit Switch 5
Bit Switch 05 - Not used (do not change any of these settings)
Bit Switch 6
Bit Switch 06 - Not used (do not change any of these settings)
Bit Switch 7
Bit Switch 07 - Not used (do not change any of these settings) Printer/ Scanner B622 B622
Bit Switch 8
Bit Switch 08 - Not used (do not change any of these settings)
5801
5907 7832
SM
1005*
Erase Margin
For the settings of the image quality, see the copier SP-mode table.
B622
SM
In addition to the power-on self test, you can set the machine in a more detailed diagnostic mode to test other components and conditions. It requires a loop-back connector (P/N: G0219350). 1. Turn off the machine and attach the loop-back connector to the parallel interface. 2. Turn on the machine while pressing the ! key and the ( key together. 3. The machine prints the diagnostic report automatically. Refer to the copier service manual for how to check the error codes (SP 7832).
SM
B622
Option
PS3 LAN USB
IEEE 1394
SD Card I/F
PICCOLO
CPU
PCI I/F
BICU
B622D901.WMF
This machine uses the RA2K architecture. To enable the printer features, install the printer option SD Card on the controller. Main components: CPU: TOSHIBA TMPR4955BFG-300 PICCOLO: RA2K architecture ASIC. It controls all the functions of the controller board. Flash ROM: 16 MB Flash ROM for the system program SDRAM: On board 64 MB, DIMM 128 MB (resident) NVRAM: Stores the controller settings LAN interface USB 2.0 interface SD Card: Printer/Scanner program Optional components: PostScript3 DIMM IEEE1394 interface Bluetooth interface Wireless LAN interface IEEE1284 interface
B622 8 SM
CONTROLLER FUNCTIONS
Tray 1
Tray 2
LCT (Optional)
Tray 3 (Optional)
Tray 4 (Optional)
B622D907.WMF
Tray Lock
If Tray Lock is enabled for a tray, the controller skips the locked tray in the tray search process. The Tray Lock setting can be specified by selecting No for the Apply Auto Paper Select setting in the Paper Size Setting screen in the user tools. (User Tools/ System Settings/ Paper Size Settings) The by-pass feeder cannot be locked.
SM
B622
Auto Continue
OFF
Immediately
1 minute
5 minute
10 minute
and so on
15 minute
B622D908.WMF
B622
10
SM
CONTROLLER FUNCTIONS
Output Tray Selected If an output tray is specified by the driver, it overrides the default tray setting in the user tools. If the machine cannot print to the selected output tray, it prints to the default paper output tray. If the mailbox unit is installed, paper larger than B4 cannot be printed to the standard (internal) tray. If paper overflow is detected at the selected output tray, the controller stops printing until the overflow detector goes off. Sequential Stacking
When the nine-tray mailbox is selected as the output tray and Printer Default is specified as the output tray in the driver, the machine automatically sends the output to the top tray (1st tray). When that tray fills up, the machine sends the output to the next tray. This feature is called Sequential Stacking. If a tray becomes full and paper is detected in the next tray, the machine displays an error and stops printing. When paper in the next tray is removed, the machine automatically resumes printing to the next tray. If all trays become full (overflow detected in all trays), the machine displays an error and stops printing. This time, all paper in all trays must be removed.
Top tray (1st tray)
2nd tray
3rd tray
8th tray
SM
11
B622
Image Processing
BICU
Image Compression
RAM
Controller
Network I/F
File
Server
B622D902.WMF
The user can select the following modes from the LCD. 1) Delivery only After image processing and image compression, all image data for the job are stored in the printer controller RAM using TIFF file or PDF file format (binary picture processing). The type of TIFF or PDF format used depends on the users scanner settings. When delivery mode is selected, the controller creates a file which contains the destination and page information, then the controller sends the file to a server. 2. Twain Mode After image processing and image compression, the data (TIFF or PDF) is sent
Image Scanning
SBU
Image Processing
BICU
Image Compression
Controller
Network I/F
Image
PC
B622D903.WMF
B622
12
SM
NETWORK INTERFACE
SM
13
B622
4.5.2 IEEE1394
IEEE1394, also known as FireWire (a name patented by Apple), is an easy-to-use peer-to-peer networking technology allowing speeds of up to 400 Mbps. The current standard contains the following features, which are supported in most devices: Hot swapping (cables can be connected and disconnected while the computer and other devices are switched on) Peer-to-peer networking (no hub required) No terminator or device ID is required, unlike SCSI Automatic configuration of devices upon start-up, or plug and play. Real-time data transfer at 100, 200, and 400 Mbps Common connectors for different devices
B622D911.WMF
The cable length is limited to 4.5 m (15ft). However, up to 16 cables and 63 devices can be connected to an IEEE1394 network. IEEE1394 cables can be either 4-pin (data only) or 6-pin (data and power). IEEE1394 allows either 6-pin or 4-pin connectors. However, this machine only uses the 6-pin connectors. The machine has two 6-pin ports.
B622
14
SM
IEEE1394 INTERFACE
EEPROM
PHY TSB41AB2
Link TSB12LV23A
Controller
B622D912.WMF
PHY: Physical layer control device Link: Link layer control device EEPROM: 256-byte ROM
B622D913.WMF
Pin No. 1 2 3 4 5 6
Signal Description Cable Power GND Receive strobe Transmit data Receive data Transmit strobe
SM
15
B622
B622
16
SM
IEEE802.11b Speed Distance 11 Mbps 140 m (153 yd.) 5.5 Mbps 200 m (219 yd.) 2 Mbps 270 m (295 yd.) 1 Mbps 400 m (437 yd.) TCP/IP, Apple Talk, NetBEUI, IPX/SPX 2.4GHz (divided over 14 channels, 2400 to 2497 MHz for each channel)
The wireless LAN cannot be active at the same time as the Ethernet LAN. The following user tool setting determines which LAN is active: System Settings Interface Settings Network - LAN Type.
LED Indicators
LED LED 1 (Green) LED 2 (Orange) Description Link Status Power Distribution ON Linked Power On OFF No Link Power Off
SM
17
B622
Ad Hoc Mode
The ad hoc mode allows communication between each device (station) in a simple peer-to-peer network. In this mode, all devices must use the same channel to communicate. In this machine, the default transmission mode is ad hoc mode and the default channel is 11. First, set up the machine in ad hoc mode and program the necessary settings, even if the machine will be used in the infrastructure mode. To switch between ad hoc and infrastructure modes, use the following user tool: Host Interface Menu - IEEE802.11b - Comm Mode
B622D914.WMF
Infrastructure Mode
The infrastructure mode allows communication between each computer and the printer via an access point equipped with an antenna and wired into the network. This arrangement is used in more complex topologies. The wireless LAN client must use the same SSID (Service Set ID) as the access point in order to communicate.
Access Point
B622D915.WMF
B622
18
SM
SM
19
B622
Communication status can be measured only when the infrastructure mode is being used.
Channel Settings
If a communication error occurs because of electrical noise, interference with other electrical devices, etc., you may have to change the channel settings. To avoid interference with neighboring channels, it is recommended to change by 3 channels. For example, if there are problems using channel 11 (default), try using channel 8.
25MHz 25MHz
Channel MHz
1 2,412
6 2,437
10
11 2,462
12
13
B622D916.WMF
B622
20
SM
Troubleshooting Procedure
If there are problems using the wireless LAN, check the following. 1) Check the LED indicator on the wireless LAN card. 2) Check if IEEE802.11b is selected in the following user tool: Host Interface menu - Network Setup - LAN Type. 3) Check if the channel settings are correct. 4) Check if the SSID and WEP are correctly set. If infrastructure mode is being used, 1) Check if the MAC address is properly set. 2) Check the communication status. If the communication status is poor, bring the machine closer to the access point, or check for any obstructions between the machine and the access point. If the problem cannot be solved, try changing the channel setting.
SM
21
B622
4.7 BLUETOOTH
4.7.1 SPECIFICATIONS
Bluetooth wireless provides radio links between mobile computers, mobile phones and other portable handheld devices. Bluetooth contains the following features: Cheaper compared to the IEEE802.11b wireless LAN. Many protocols for infrared transmission (IrDA) can be used with Bluetooth. A Bluetooth device can connect to other Bluetooth devices without any settings. Standard applied: Bluetooth 1.1 (Bluetooth Special Interest Group) Data transfer rates: 1 Mbps Bandwidth: 2.4GHz Frequency Hopping Spread Spectrum (FHSS) Piconet: Bluetooth devices communicate with each other device in the ad hoc mode. This network is called a "Piconet. A Piconet may contain a maximum of 8 Bluetooth devices. There is one master device and seven slave devices in a Piconet. The master device controls the hopping frequency and timing, as well as storing the ID codes of the slave devices. The master and slave devices can be swapped. Once the master device leaves the Piconet, a slave device becomes the new master. Machines with the Bluetooth option become potential slave devices to connect to the PC. FHSS (Frequency Hopping Spread Spectrum): The Bluetooth device divides 2402 to 2480 MHz into 79 channels of 1 MHz width, and changes the channel 1600 times per second. If other devices in the LAN are using the same radio band, Bluetooth can avoid interference from the other devices.
B622D917.WMF G081D925.WMF
B622
22
SM
BLUETOOTH
SM
23
B622
4.8 USB
4.8.1 SPECIFICATIONS
USB connectivity is provided as an option for this machine.
Interface: Data rates: USB 1.1, USB 2.0 480 Mbps (high speed), 12 Mbps (full speed), 1.5 Mbps (low speed) High speed mode is only supported by USB 2.0.
B622
24
SM
USB
B622D919.WMF
B622D918.WMF
2 1 3 4
B622D906.WMF
SM
25
B622
Related SP Mode
USB Settings in the printer engine service mode. Data rates can be adjusted to full speed fixed (12 Mbps). This switch may be used for troubleshooting if there is a data transfer error using the high speed mode (480 Mbps). Data rates can also be adjusted using the UP mode USB Setting in the Host Interface in the System menu. This mode can be accessed only when the Enter, Escape, then Menu keys are pressed to enter the UP mode.
B622
26
SM
SPECIFICATIONS
SPECIFICATIONS
1. GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
1.1 PRINTER
Maximum 18 ppm (A4/LT LEF): B122/B123 model Maximum 15 ppm (A4/LT LEF): B121 model PCL6/PCL5e PostScript 3 (option) RPCS (Refined Printing Command Stream) - an original Ricoh PDL) 600 dpi (PCL 6/PCL5e/PS3/RPCS) 300 dpi (PCL6 PCL5e/PS3) 200 dpi (RPCS) PCL: 35 Intellifonts 10 True Type fonts PS3: 136 fonts (24 Type 2 fonts, 112 Type 14 fonts) Ethernet (100 Base-TX/10 Base-T) (standard) Bi-directional IEEE1284 parallel x 1 (option) IEEE1394 (option) TCP/IP 128 MB See the copier service manual. Printing Speed: Printer Languages:
Resolution:
Resident Fonts:
Host Interfaces:
1.2
SCANNER
Main scan/Sub scan 600 dpi Twain Mode: 100 ~ 600 dpi E-mail/Network Delivery Scanner: 100 dpi, 200 dpi, 300 dpi, 400 dpi, 600 dpi 25 spm for TWAIN 43 spm for Delivery mode (A4L, ADF mode) Ethernet (100 Base-TX/10 Base-T for TCP/IP), IEEE 1394, IEEE 802.11b (Wireless LAN) Binary: TIFF (MH, MR, MMR)
SM
27
B622
SPECIFICATIONS
2. SOFTWARE ACCESSORIES
2.1 PRINTER
The printer drivers and utility software are provided on one CD-ROM. An auto-run installer allows you to select which components to install.
PRINTER DRIVERS
Printer Language PCL 6 PCL 5e PS3 RPCS Windows 95/98/ME Yes Yes Yes Yes Windows NT4.0 Windows 2000 Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Macintosh No No Yes No
NOTE: 1) The printer drivers for Windows NT 4.0 are only for the Intel x86 platform. There is no Windows NT 4.0 printer driver for the PowerPC, Alpha, or MIPS platforms. 2) The PS3 drivers are all genuine AdobePS drivers, except for Windows 2000, which uses Microsoft PS. A PPD file for each operating system is provided with the driver.
UTILITY SOFTWARE
Software Agfa Font Manager (Win 95/98/ME, NT4, 2000) SmartNetMonitor for Admin (Win 95/98/ME, NT4, 2000) SmartNetMonitor for Client (Win 95/98/ME, NT4, 2000)
1394 Utility (Win 2000) DeskTopBinder V2 Lite (Win 95/98/ME, NT4, 2000) LAN-Fax M1 (Win 95/98/ME, NT4, 2000) Address Book (Win 95/98/ME, NT4, 2000) Printer Utility for Mac
Description A font management utility with screen fonts for the printer. A printer management utility for network administrators. NIB setup utilities are also available. A printer management utility for client users. Peer-to-peer printing utility and parallel/recovery printing functions are included. A utility for removal IEEE 1394 printers. A utility for document management PC LAN FAX driver A utility for PC LAN FAX. This software provides several convenient functions for printing from Macintosh clients.
B622
28
SM
SPECIFICATIONS
2.2
SCANNER
The scanner driver and utility software are provided on one CD-ROM.
SCANNER DRIVER Network Twain Driver for Win95/98/ME/NT3.51/NT4.0/2000 SCANNER UTILITIES Scan Router V2 Lite (Cherry-Lite) for Win95/98/ME/NT4.0/2000 Desk Top Binder V2 Lite (Plumeria-Lite) for Win95/98/ME/NT4.0/2000
SM
29
B622
SPECIFICATIONS
3. MACHINE CONFIGURATION
3.1 SYSTEM COMPONENTS
[A]
[B]
[C]
[D] [E]
B622V901.WMF
Item Controller Box Printer/Scanner unit RAM DIMM PostScript 3 IEEE 1394 IEEE 1284 Wireless LAN Bluetooth
Remarks Required to install the printer/scanner unit Distributed with the printer/scanner unit
B622
30
SM
The Service Manual pages listed below must be replaced with the pages supplied.
SERVICE MANUAL
Updated Information (Settings) Updated Information (Service Program Mode 5307) New Information (Setting Daylight Savings Time)
MFP EXPANSION
Rev. 04/2004
1.12.4 SETTINGS
Step 10MFP Settings and Time Settings
1. Turn the main switch on. 2. Start the SP mode. 3. Select SP5-801-001 and execute the initialization. 4. Turn the main switch off and on. 5. Start the SP mode. Select SP5-302-002 and specify the time zone. For example, EST = -300, CST = -360, MST = -420 or PST = -480.
6.
7. Select SP5-307-001, 003, and 004 and specify the daylight-saving-time settings. ( 5.1.18)
5.1.7. When installing to MFP Expansion, the BICU (Engine) NVRAM NOTE: settings are moved from SP5-801 to SP5-998-001. After adding the MFP Expansion performing SP5-801-001 will not RAM CLEAR the BICU settings.
B121/B122/B123
1-40
SM
Rev. 04/2004
5307 3 5307 4
Summer Time Summer Time On/Off Enables or disables the daylight saving time settings in SP5-307-3 and 4. OFF = 0, ON = 1 Summer Time Start ( 5.1.18) Specifies the start of the daylight saving time. Summer Time End ( 5.1.18) Specifies the end of the daylight saving time.
5404* 5404 1
PM Alarm Interval PM Alarm Interval (Printout) [0 ~ 9999 / 0 / 0K copies/step] Specifies when the PM alarm occurs. PM Alarm Original Count Alarm [0 = Off / 1 = On] Enables or disables the original count alarm.
5504* 5504 1
Jam Alarm Sets the alarm to sound for the specified jam level (document misfeeds are not included). [0~3 / 3 / 1 step] 0: Zero (Off) 1: Low (2.5K jams) 2: Medium (3K jams) 3: High (6K jams)
5505* 5505 1
Error Alarm [0 ~ 255 / 20 / 1 hundred sheets/step] Specifies the number of paper (in hundred) used as the error alarm level. The error alarm starts if 5 SC codes (or more) are generated before the copier prints the specified number of paper. When the copier has printed the specified number of paper, the SC code counter (of this SP) is cleared to zero.
5507* 5507 1 5507 3 5507 128 5507 132 5507 133 5507 134 5507 141 5507 142 5507 160 5507 164 5507 166 5507 172
Supply Alarm Paper Supply Alarm Toner Supply Alarm Interval :Others Interval :A3 Interval :A4 Interval :A5 Interval :B4 Interval :B5 Interval :DLT Interval :LG Interval :LT Interval :HLT
0: Off, 1: On, DFU 0: Off, 1: On, DFU [00250 ~ 10000 / 1000 / 1 Step] DFU
B121/B122/B123
5-42
SM
Rev. 04/2004
Reading Data
W1 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1: Detected W2 0 0 1 1 1 0 0 1 1 L1 0 1 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 L2 0 1 0 0 1 0 1 0 0 Paper Size NA 11" x 17" 81/2" x 51/2" LEF 81/2" x 11" SEF 81/2" x 14" 11" x 81/2" LEF 11" x 17" 51/2" X 81/2" SEF
B121S921.WMF
Digit Position Jan. = 01, Feb. =02, etc. 7 Month: 01 through 12 6 5 Week of the Month: 1 through 5 1st week =1, 2nd week =2, 3rd week = 3, etc. Sun.= 0, Mon. = 1, Tue. = 2, etc. 4 Day of the Week: 0 through 7 00 = Midnight, 01 = 1 AM, 02 = 2 AM through 3 Hours: 23 = 11 PM 2 1 Start and Stop 1hour 0 minutes For SP5307-3, this must always be 10. For SP5307-4, this value must always be 00. 0 Example- April 4, 2004 DST is turned ON and October 31, 2004 DST is turned OFF: 04/04 2:00 AM DST is turned ON- 4100210 (7digits) There is no leading 0. See 2-1 below. 1- SP5-307-001: Change 0(=OFF) to 1(=ON) 2- SP5-307-003(Summer time start): 2-1. Enter 04 as month of April. (4 will be displayed. The leading 0 will not be displayed.) 2-2. Enter 1 (=1st week) and 0 (=Sunday) 2-3. Enter 02 (=2:00 AM) 2-4. Enter 10 (=1 hour 0 minute) 3- SP5-307-004(Summer time end): 10/31 2:00 AM DST is turned OFF: 10500200 (8 digits) 3-1. Enter 10 as month of October. (10 will be entered.) 3-2. Enter 5 (=5th) and 0 (=Sunday) 3-3. Enter 02 (=2:00 AM) 3-4. Enter 00. Remember to turn the main switch OFF and ON when the message is displayed.
SM
5-89
B121/B122/B123
Service Tables
5.1.18